International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1....

79
INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: “Encyclopaedia of the Occult Sciences”; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson Press; London; 1960; p. 48. 2. ADAMS, Sally; “The Supreme Adventure” (Robert Crookall); Books Reviews; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 41; N. 709; September, 1961; pp. 158, 159. 3. ADGMT; “Dicionário de Doutrina Espírita”; 304 pp.; glos. 297-304; 18.5 cm; pb.; Grupo Espírita Regeneração; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1963; pp. 46-48, 71-73. 4. ADINAD-DALA; “Dialogos Metafísicos”; 124 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; Author’s Edition; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1963; pp. 101-104. 5. ADOUM, Jorge (Pseud.: Mago Jefa); “Cosmogenesis segun la Memoria de la Naturaleza”; pref. A. Harb. M.; 92 pp.; bibl. 90; 20 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1980; pp. 29, 32, 33, 40, 42, 43; eds.: Sp., Port. 6. ADOUM, Jorge (Pseud.: Mago Jefa); “20 Dias no Mundo dos Mortos”; 134 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; pb.; Comissão Divulgadora J. A.; Santos Dumont, MG; Brazil; July, 1978; pp. 1-134. 7. AGEE, Doris; “Edgar Cayce on ESP”; Editor: Hugh Lynn Cayce; 224 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Paperback Library; New York; May, 1969; pp. 40-47. 8. AJAYA, Swami (Pseud. for Allan Weinstock); Organizator; “Vivendo com os Mestres do Himalaia: Experiências Espirituais de Swami Rama”; transl. Octavio Mendes Cajado; 432 pp.; illus.; glos. 430 - 432; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981; pp. 238, 317, 399-401, 406-409. 9. AKSAKOF, Alexander Nikolayevich; “Animismo e Espiritismo”; transl. C. S.; 712 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; H. Garnier, Livreiro-Editor; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1903; pp. XXXVIII, XXXIX, 511-574; eds.: Ger., Fr., Port. (Mini-library). 10. ALD, Roy; “The Man Who Took Trips”; 246 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Delacorte Press; New York; 1971; pp. 18, 151-153, 196. 11. ALEXANDRIAN; “Histoire de la Philosophie Occulte”; 390 pp.; index of names; 24 cm; pb.; Éditions Seghers; Paris; 1983; pp. 29, 274, 288-293, 310, 312-317; eds.: Fr., Port. 12. ALFONSO, Eduardo; “La Religion de la Naturaleza: Cosmologia Transcendente”; 376 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1976; pp. 342-346. 13. ALIANÇA; Editora; “Curso Básico de Espiritismo”; 172 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Edi tora Aliança; S. Paulo; Brazil; March, 1981; pp. 148-153. 14. ALLGEIER, Kurt; “Du hast Schon einmal Gelebt”; 222 pp.; bibl. 221-223; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 2nd ed.; Wilhelm Goldmann Verlag; München; West Germany; Dezember, 1981; pp. 117, 126, 135-140. 15. ALMEIDA, João Ferreira de (Translator); “Bíblia: O Velho e o Novo Testamento”; 1.194 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; 49th print.; Imprensa Bíblica Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; Eccles. 12:6; I Cor. 15:44; II Cor. 12:2-4; eds.: Heb., Eng., Fr., Port. and others. 16. ALVARADO, Carlos; “ESP and Out -of-Body Experiences: A Review of Spontaneous Studies”; Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 14; N. 4; July-August, 1983; bibl.; pp. 11-13. 17. ALVARADO, Carlos; “Phenomenological Differences Between Natural and Enforced Out-of-Body Experiences: A Re-analysis of Crookalls Findings”; Theta; Durham; North Carolina; Magazine; Vol. 9; 1981; pp. 9-11. 18. ALVERGA, Alex Polari de; “O Livro das Mirações”; Autobiography; 346 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Rocco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1984; pp. 127-129, 138-140, 214, 215, 271, 272, 280, 281, 288- 292, 300, 301, 312. 19. ALVERY, Robert; “Out of the Body Experiences”; pref. Harry Edwards; 118 pp.; Regency Press; London; 1975; pp. 1-118. 20. ALVISI, Gabriella; “As Vozes dos Vivos de Ontem”; transl. M. de Campos; pref. Giorgio Di Simone; 258 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Publicações Europa-América; Mira-Sintra; Portugal; no date; pp. 21, 130- 133. 21. AMADOU, Robert; “Parapsicologia: Ensaio Histórico e Crítico”; prol. José Herculano Pires; pref. J. Van Lennep; postf. J. Carvalhal Ribas; 422 pp.; glos. 403-412; index of names, 413-418; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editora Mestre Jou; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1969; pp. 404, 405; eds.: Fr., Sp., Port.

Transcript of International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1....

Page 1: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY

1. ABBOT, A. E.: “Encyclopaedia of the Occult Sciences”; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson Press; London;

1960; p. 48.

2. ADAMS, Sally; “The Supreme Adventure” (Robert Crookall); Books Reviews; Journal of the Society

for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 41; N. 709; September, 1961;

pp. 158, 159.

3. ADGMT; “Dicionário de Doutrina Espírita”; 304 pp.; glos. 297-304; 18.5 cm; pb.; Grupo Espírita

Regeneração; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1963; pp. 46-48, 71-73.

4. ADINAD-DALA; “Dialogos Metafísicos”; 124 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; Author’s Edition; Buenos Aires;

Argentina; 1963; pp. 101-104.

5. ADOUM, Jorge (Pseud.: Mago Jefa); “Cosmogenesis segun la Memoria de la Naturaleza”; pref. A.

Harb. M.; 92 pp.; bibl. 90; 20 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1980; pp. 29,

32, 33, 40, 42, 43; eds.: Sp., Port.

6. ADOUM, Jorge (Pseud.: Mago Jefa); “20 Dias no Mundo dos Mortos”; 134 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; pb.;

Comissão Divulgadora J. A.; Santos Dumont, MG; Brazil; July, 1978; pp. 1-134.

7. AGEE, Doris; “Edgar Cayce on ESP”; Editor: Hugh Lynn Cayce; 224 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.;

Paperback Library; New York; May, 1969; pp. 40-47.

8. AJAYA, Swami (Pseud. for Allan Weinstock); Organizator; “Vivendo com os Mestres do Himalaia:

Experiências Espirituais de Swami Rama”; transl. Octavio Mendes Cajado; 432 pp.; illus.; glos. 430-432; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981; pp. 238, 317, 399-401, 406-409.

9. AKSAKOF, Alexander Nikolayevich; “Animismo e Espiritismo”; transl. C. S.; 712 pp.; illus.; 18 cm;

hb.; H. Garnier, Livreiro-Editor; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1903; pp. XXXVIII, XXXIX, 511-574; eds.:

Ger., Fr., Port. (Mini-library).

10. ALD, Roy; “The Man Who Took Trips”; 246 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Delacorte Press; New York;

1971; pp. 18, 151-153, 196.

11. ALEXANDRIAN; “Histoire de la Philosophie Occulte”; 390 pp.; index of names; 24 cm; pb.; Éditions

Seghers; Paris; 1983; pp. 29, 274, 288-293, 310, 312-317; eds.: Fr., Port.

12. ALFONSO, Eduardo; “La Religion de la Naturaleza: Cosmologia Transcendente”; 376 pp.; illus.; 19.5

cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1976; pp. 342-346.

13. ALIANÇA; Editora; “Curso Básico de Espiritismo”; 172 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Aliança; S.

Paulo; Brazil; March, 1981; pp. 148-153.

14. ALLGEIER, Kurt; “Du hast Schon einmal Gelebt”; 222 pp.; bibl. 221-223; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 2nd

ed.; Wilhelm Goldmann Verlag; München; West Germany; Dezember, 1981; pp. 117, 126, 135-140.

15. ALMEIDA, João Ferreira de (Translator); “Bíblia: O Velho e o Novo Testamento”; 1.194 pp.; illus.;

18 cm; hb.; 49th print.; Imprensa Bíblica Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; Eccles. 12:6; I Cor.

15:44; II Cor. 12:2-4; eds.: Heb., Eng., Fr., Port. and others. 16. ALVARADO, Carlos; “ESP and Out-of-Body Experiences: A Review of Spontaneous Studies”;

Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 14; N. 4; July-August, 1983; bibl.;

pp. 11-13.

17. ALVARADO, Carlos; “Phenomenological Differences Between Natural and Enforced Out-of-Body

Experiences: A Re-analysis of Crookalls Findings”; Theta; Durham; North Carolina; Magazine; Vol.

9; 1981; pp. 9-11.

18. ALVERGA, Alex Polari de; “O Livro das Mirações”; Autobiography; 346 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

Editora Rocco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1984; pp. 127-129, 138-140, 214, 215, 271, 272, 280, 281, 288-

292, 300, 301, 312.

19. ALVERY, Robert; “Out of the Body Experiences”; pref. Harry Edwards; 118 pp.; Regency Press;

London; 1975; pp. 1-118.

20. ALVISI, Gabriella; “As Vozes dos Vivos de Ontem”; transl. M. de Campos; pref. Giorgio Di Simone;

258 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Publicações Europa-América; Mira-Sintra; Portugal; no date; pp. 21, 130-

133.

21. AMADOU, Robert; “Parapsicologia: Ensaio Histórico e Crítico”; prol. José Herculano Pires; pref. J.

Van Lennep; postf. J. Carvalhal Ribas; 422 pp.; glos. 403-412; index of names, 413-418; 21 cm; pb.;

2nd ed.; Editora Mestre Jou; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1969; pp. 404, 405; eds.: Fr., Sp., Port.

Page 2: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

22. AMADOU, Robert; “Revues”; Revue Métapsychique; Paris, Bimonthly; Numbers 29, 30; Mai-Août,

1954; pp. 226-228.

23. AMBELAIN, Robert; “O Vampirismo: Da Lenda ao Real”; transl. Ana Silva e Brito; 230 pp.; illus.; 20

cm; pb.; Livraria Bertrand; Amadora; Portugal; 1978; pp. 29-81.

24. ANCILLI, Ermanno; “Diccionario de Espiritualidad”; transl. Joan Llopis; 3 Vol.; 2.106 pp.; Vol. II:

726 pp.; Vol. III: 650 pp.; Systematic index; 24 cm; hb.; dj.; Editorial Herder; Barcelona; Spain;

1983/1984; Vol. I: 730 pp.; p. 264.

25. ANDERSON, Rodger I.; “Contemporary Survival Research: a Critical Review”; Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 12; N. 5; September-October, 1981; pp. 8-13.

26. ANDERSON, Walt; “Segredos Revelados: Práticas do Budismo Tibetano”; transl. Luiz Horácio da

Matta; 216 pp.; illus.; glos. 205, 206; 21 cm; pb.; Livraria Francisco Alves Editora; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; 1983; pp. 133-135.

27. ANDRADE, Hernani Guimarães; “Espírito, Perispírito e Alma”; pref. Ney Prieto Peres; XX + 246 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 231-238; index of names; alph.; 23 cm; cart.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1984;

pp. 99, 110-117, 121-127, 131-160, 183-188, 210, 216, 226 (See Numbers 149; 150;

607-610; 1000).

28. ANDRADE, Hernani Guimarães; “A Matéria Psi”; 74 pp.; bibl. 70-73; 18.5 cm; pb.; Casa Editora O

Clarim; Matão, SP; Brazil; March, 1981; p. 44.

29. ANDRADE, Hernani Guimarães; “Morte, Renascimento, Evolução: Uma Biologia Transcendental”;

pref. Osmard Andrade Faria; XVIII + 172 pp.; illus.; bibl. 156-161; index of names; alph.; 23 cm; pb.;

Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1983; pp. 67-69, 89-92.

30. ANDRADE, Hernani Guimarães; “Projeções da Consciência” (Vieira); Section

“Revisão de Livro”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo, SP; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; illus.; Yr. VIII; N. 89;

August, 1981; p. 6.

31. ANDRADE, Herbaldo Lima e; “O Espírito que Deixou o Corpo Durante o Sono”; Kabala; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. I; N. 2; 18 cm; September, 1954; pp. 18-24, 32.

32. ANDRADE, José Hermógenes de; “O Yoga e os Poderes Paranormais”; Anais do III Congresso

Nacional de Parapsicologia e Psicotrônica; Abrap; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 24 cm; pb.; July, 1982; 13

pp. (pp. 57-70); pp. 59, 62 (See N. 715).

33. ANDRÉA, Jorge – dos Santos; “Correlações Espírito-Matéria”; 56 pp.; illus.; bibl. 49; 21 cm; pb.;

Editora Samos; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1984; p. 25.

34. ANDRÉA, Jorge – dos Santos; “Palingênese, a Grande Lei”; 154 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Author’s Edition; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; pp. 144-148.

35. ANDREAE, Christine; “Seances & Spiritualists”; 160 pp.; illus.; bibl. 151-153; alph.; 20.5 cm; hb.;

dj.; J. P. Lippincott Co.; Philadelphia; U. S. A.; 1974; pp. 21, 89-96, 101.

36. ANDREAS, Peter, and KILIAN, Caspar; “A Ciência Fantástica”; transl. Trude Von Lascham Solstein;

208 pp.; illus.; bibl. 206-208; 20 cm; pb.; Edições Melhoramentos; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1976; pp. 29, 38-

59, 87, 92, 97, 115, 141, 188; eds.: Eng., Ger., Port.

37. ANDREWS, Valerie; “The Psychic Power of Running”; 202 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Thorsons

Publishers; Great Britain; 1979; pp. 6, 11, 121, 122.

38. ANGLADA, Vicente Beltrán; “La Estructuracion Devica de las Formas”; 224 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

Editorial Eyras; Madrid; Spain; 1982; pp. 80-82. 39. ANGLADA, Vicente Beltrán; “Mis Experiencias Espirituales”; 190 pp.; 21 cm; cart.; Luis Carcamo,

Editor; Madrid; Spain; 1982; pp. 25-27, 63-66, 73-76.

40. ANGOFF, Allan, and BARTH, Diana; Editors; “Parapsychology and Anthropology” (E. J. Dingwall);

XX + 328 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; hb.; Parapsychology Foundation; New York; 1974; pp. 241-243, 257-261.

41. ANIEVAS, Joaquim; “Um Jovem Parapsicólogo Americano”; Revista de Parapsicologia; S. Paulo,

SP; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. 1; N. 6; July, 1973; illus.; pp. 20-22.

42. ANJOS, Luciano dos, and MIRANDA, Hermínio Correa de; “Crônicas de Um e de Outro: De

Kennedy ao Homem Artificial”; pref. Abelardo Idalgo Magalhães; 286 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1975; pp. 69, 82, 83, 92, 93, 162-164, 184, 193, 226.

43. ANJOS, Rose dos; “Você é Espírito”; 94 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Reflexos Editora; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil;

June, 1982; p. 45.

44. ANÔNIMO; “Aum, Signos del Agni Yoga”; 204 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires;

Argentina; 1951; pp. 64-66.

Page 3: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

45. ANONYMOUS; “The Double Projection”; Fate; Magazine; Evanston, Ill.; U.S.A.; Vol. 6; N. 2;

February, 1953; p. 60.

46. ANONYMOUS; “The Unseen World: Communications With It”; VIII + 216 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; James

Burns; London; 1847; pp. 163-180.

47. ANTUNES, João; “Hipnologia Transcendental”; 224 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Livraria Classica Editora;

Lisboa, Portugal; 1913; pp. 163-171.

48. AOM; “Desdobramentos”; Booklet; Copy; 8 pp.; 31 cm; Ascensionada Ordem Mística; Curitiba, PR;

Brazil; s. d.; p. 7. 49. ARAUJO, Humberto Leite de; “Barsanulfo, Sua Vida, Seu Exemplo”; 20 pp.; 15 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Lar

Irmão Francisco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 01, May, 1982; pp. 12, 13.

50. ARAUJO, Maria de Lourdes; “Luz! Símbolo da Fé!”; 106 pp.; 20.5 cm; hb.; Irmãos Pongetti, Editores;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1950; pp. 26, 27.

51. ARMOND, Edgard; “Desenvolvimento Mediúnico Prático”; 80 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Livraria Allan

Kardec Editora; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; p. 70.

52. ARMOND, Edgard; “O Estranho Caso de Rôse Ramires”; 148 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.;

3rd ed.; Editora Aliança; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1979; pp. 137-141.

53. ARMOND, Edgard; “Mediunidade”; 212 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 15th ed.; Livraria Allan Kardec Editora; S.

Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 14, 39, 49-51, 72-77, 87, 127, 195, 208, 209.

54. ARMOND, Edgard; “Mediunidade: Síntese”; 122 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Livraria Allan Kardec Editora; S.

Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 22, 23.

55. ARMOND, Edgard; “Na Semeadura”; 2 Vol.; 320 pp.; bibl. 151; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Aliança; S.

Paulo; Brazil; 1975/1977; Vol. II: pp. 77-79, 82, 112, 123-128, 143.

56. ARMSTRONG, Neville; Editor; “Harvest of Light: Approaches to the Paranormal”; Anthology;

introd. Paul Beard; 258 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Neville Spearman; London; 1976; pp. 87-92.

57. ASH, Brian; “Encyclopédie Visuelle de la Science-Fiction”; transl. Jean Pierre Galante; 352 pp.; illus.; alph.; 26 cm; cart.; Albin Michel; Paris; 1979; pp. 205-208.

58. ASHBY, Robert H.; “The Case for Survival; An Interview With William Roll”; Theta; Durham; North

Carolina; U. S. A.; Magazine; Quarterly; N. 45; Summer, 1975; pp. 4-9.

59. ASHBY, Robert H.; “The Guidebook for the Study of Psychical Research”; introd. Renée Haynes; 158

pp.; glos. 144-157; bibl. 34-89; 22 cm; pb.; Rider and Co.; London; 1972;

pp. 21, 145, 151, 156, 157.

60. ASHISH, Madhava; “Man, Son of Man; In the Stanzas of Dzyan”; XVI + 352 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm;

hb.; dj.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill.; U. S.A.; 1970; pp. 333, 334.

61. ATIENZA, Juan G.; “La Gran Manipulación Cósmica”; 280 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Ediciones Martínez Roca;

Barcelona; Spain; 1981; pp. 259, 260.

62. ATLAN, Jacques; “Etude Sur les Cinq Livres de Carlos Castaneda”; Renaître 2000; Paris; Magazine;

Bimonthly; 122nd Yr.; New series; N. 15; November-December, 1979;

pp. 204-212.

63. AZEVEDO, José Lacerda de; “Mediunidade Reprimida”; Desobsessão; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil;

Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XXXI; N. 373; March, 1979; pp. 12-14.

64. AZEVEDO, Juan Rocha de; “Fascinantes Secretos Psiquicos”; prol. Rodolfo Perdomo Bica; 176 pp.;

illus.; 20 cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1983; pp. 44-47. 65. BABAJIANANDA (Pseud. for Roger Pierre Feraudy); “Serões do Pai Velho: O Catecismo de

Umbanda”; 212 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978; p. 36.

66. BACHEMAN, William; “The Steinerbooks Dictionary of the Psychic, Mystic,

Occult”; 252 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Rudolf Steiner Publications; Blauvelt, N. Y.; U. S. A.;

1973; pp. 20, 29.

67. BADHAM, Paul, and BADHAM, Linda; “Immortality or Extinction?”; 146 pp.; bibl. 142, 143; alph.;

21.5 cm; hb.; The Macmillam Press; Hong Kong; 1982; pp. 12-15, 71-89.

68. BAEZA, Tomas; “La Reencarnacion”; 192 pp.; 192 pp.; 17 cm; pb.; Editorial Bruguera; Barcelona;

Spain; Julio, 1975; pp. 52, 53.

69. BAKER, Douglas M.; “Practical Techniques of Astral Projection”; 96 pp.; illus.; bibl. 94; 21.5 cm;

pb.; 2nd print.; The Aquarian Press; London; 1978; pp. 1-96 (Mini-library).

70. BALANOVSKI, Eduardo; “Los Fenómenos Paranormales”; 220 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Gedisa;

Barcelona; Spain; February, 1982; pp. 19, 115.

Page 4: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

71. BALZAC, Honoré de; “Louis Lambert”; Novel; pref. Raymond Abellio; 176 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.;

Éditions Gallimard; Paris; 1980; pp. 32, 71-73; eds.: Fr., Port., etc.

72. BALZAC, Honoré de; “Usula Mirouët”; Novel; transl. Gomes da Silveira; introd. Paulo Rónai; in “A

Comédia Humana”; Vol. V; XXXIV + 206 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Editora Globo; Porto Alegre, RS;

Brazil; 1953; pp. 66-71.

73. BANCROFT, Anne; “Twentieth Century - Mystics & Sages”; XVI + 344 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.;

dj.; Heinemann; London; 1976; pp. 311, 312.

74. BANERJEE, Hamendras Nat; “Vida Pretérita e Futura”; transl. Sylvio Monteiro; 120 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editorial Nórdica; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 39-41.

75. BANKS, Frances Mary; “The Frontiers of Revelation: An Empirical Study in the Psychology of

Psychic and Spiritual Experience”; 232 pp.; Max Parrish; London; 1962;

pp. 110-115.

76. BARADUC, Hippolyte; “La Force Vitale”; illus.; 224 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Paul Ollendorff, Éditeur;

Paris; 1897; pp. 211-216.

77. BARBANELL, Maurice; “This is Spiritualism”; 224 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.;

5th print.; Psychic Press; London; 1983; pp. 25, 120, 121, 206.

78. BARBOKA, Geoffrey A.; “H. P. Blavatsky, Tibet and Tulku”; XXIV + 476 pp.; illus.; bibl. 437-446;

alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; 1st print.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Adyar; Madras; India; 1974; pp.

330-342, 424.

79. BARDENS, Dennis; “Mysterious Worlds”; 222 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; W. H. Allen; London; 1970; pp.

47, 137-162.

80. BARDON, Franz; “Iniciacion al Hermetismo”; transl. Manuel Algora Corbi; pref. Otti V.; 406 pp.;

illus.; 21 cm; cart.; Luis Carcamo, Editor; Madrid; Spain; 1982; pp. 317-326, 383-388.

81. BARHAM, Allan; “Strange to Relate”; pref. Arthur J. Ellison; introd. Victor

Goddard; XII + 128 pp.; illus.; bibl. 124; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Colin Smythe, Gerards Cross; Great Britain; 1984; pp. 86-93.

82. BARKAS, Thomas P.; “Outlines of Investigations into Modern Spiritualism”; VIII + 160 pp.; 18.5 cm;

hb.; Frederick Pitman; London; 1862; pp. 22, 87, 96, 97.

83. BARRETO, Djalma Lúcio Gabriel; “O Alienista, o Louco e a Lei”; 140 pp.; bibl. 135-139; 21 cm; pb.;

Editora Vozes; Petrópolis, RJ; Brazil; 1978; pp. 67-69.

84. BARROS, Sílvia Lúcia C. Vasconcellos; “Do Desdobramento à Projeção: O Que Mudou?”; Folha

Espírita; S. Paulo, SP; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 99; June, 1982; p. 5.

85. BARROS, Sílvia Lúcia C. Vasconcellos; “Experiências Fora do Corpo Físico”; Jornal Espírita; S.

Paulo, SP; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. VIII; N. 87; illus.; September, 1982; p. 10.

86. BARROS, Sílvia Lúcia C. Vasconcellos; “Novas Perspectivas de Waldo Vieira”; Revista Internacional

do Espiritismo; Matão, SP; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. LVII; N. 4; 26.5 cm; May, 1982; p. 126.

87. BARTZ, Heinrich; “Astrale Schwebezustände”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine;

Monthly; Yr. 21; N. 8; August, 1970; p. 751.

88. BARTZ, Heinrich; “Träume sind nicht nur Gehirnfunktionen”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 22; N. 7; July, 1971; pp. 657, 658.

89. BASTOS, Demétrio Pável; “Médium, Quem é, Quem não é”; pref. M. B. Tamassia; 108 pp.; illus.; 19

cm; pb.; Instituto Maria, Departamento Editorial; Juiz de Fora, MG; Brazil; 1981; pp. 35, 57, 58, 74-77.

90. BATES, E. Katherine; “Our Living Dead”; Kegan Paul; London; 1917; p. 12.

91. BATES, E. Katherine; “Seen and Unseen”; XVI + 324 pp.; London; 1907; p. 120.

92. BATTERSBY, Henry Francis Prevost; “Man Outside Himself: The Methods of Astral Projection”;

introd. Leslie Shepard; 102 pp.; bibl. 101, 102; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; 2nd print.; University Books; New

Jersey; U. S. A.; August, 1973; pp. 1-102 (Mini-library).

93. BAUMANN, Elwood D.; “They Travel Outside Their Bodies”; 10 + 118 pp.; illus.; bibl. 113, 114;

alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Franklin Watts; New York; 1980; pp. 1-117 (Mini-library).

94. BAYLESS, Raymond; “Animal Ghosts”; pref. Robert Crookall; 188 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; University

Books; New York; 1970; pp. 70-73.

95. BAYLESS, Raymond; “Apparitions and Survival of Death”; pref. D. Scott Rogo; 206 pp.; bibl. 149,

150; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; University Books; New York; 1973; pp. 79, 148-164, 204-220.

96. BAYLESS, Raymond; “Experiences of a Psychical Research”; 246 pp.; 20.5 cm; hb.; dj.; University

Books; New Hyde Park; N. Y.; 1972; pp. 152, 153.

Page 5: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

97. BAYLESS, Raymond; “Life at Death”; Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 12; N. 2; March-

April, 1981; pp. 13-15.

98. BAYLESS, Raymond; “The Other Side of Death”; introd. Robert Crookall; 192 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; dj.;

University Books; New York; 1971; pp. 7-10, 24, 25, 32, 67, 95-132, 143, 146, 152-161, 182.

99. BEARD, Paul; “Living On: A Study of Altering Consciousness After Death”; 202 pp.; alph.; 20 cm;

hb.; dj.; George Allen & Unwin; London; 1980; pp. 34-36.

100. BEAUCIE, Albert La; “Les Nouveaux Horizons Scientifiques de la Vie”; 238 pp.; 18 cm; hb.;

Bibliothèque Universelle Beaudelot; Paris; 1907; pp. 53, 54. 101. BECKER, C. B.; “The Failure of Saganomics: Why Bird Models Cannot Explain Near-Death

Phenomena”; Anabiosis; Magazine; Vol. 2; 1982; pp. 102-109.

102. BECKER, Raymond de; “Las Maquinaciones de la Noche”; transl. J. Herrero; 432 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

pocket; Plaza & Janes; Barcelona; Spain; September, 1977; pp. 401-403.

103. BEDFORD, James, and KENSIGTON, Walt; “El Experimento Delpasse: Un Descubrimiento en el

Reino entre la Vida y la Muerte”; transl. Michael Faber-Kaiser; 328 pp.; bibl. 327; 22 cm; pb.;

Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1976; pp. 15, 186-190.

104. BÉLIARD, Octave; “Sorciers, Rêveurs et Démoniaques”; 272 pp.; illus.; bibl.

265-267; 18 cm; pb.; Librairie Alphonse Lemerre; Paris; 1920; pp. 55-60.

105. BELLINE; “Anthologie de L’Au-delà”; pref. Frédéric Royer; 390 pp.; bibl. 383-386; 21.5 cm; pb.;

Éditions Robert Laffont; Paris; 1978; pp. 334-339, 361, 362.

106. BELLINE; “Anthologie de L’Au-delà; 2: Domaine Anglophone”; 278 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Éditions

Robert Laffont; Paris; 1981; pp. 91-94.

107. BELOFF, John; “New Directions in Parapsychology”; XXVI + 174 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The

Scarecrow Press; Metuchen; N. J.; U. S. A.; 1975; pp. 149-152, 159, 160.

108. BENAVIDES, Rodolfo; “En la Noche de los Tiempos”; Novel; 260 pp.; bibl. 259, 260; 19.5 cm; pb.;

6th ed.; Editores Mexicanos Unidos; Mexico, D. F.; 1971; p. 46. 109. BENAVIDES, Rodolfo; “...Entonces Seremos Dioses”; Novel; 340 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editores

Mexicanos Unidos; Mexico, D. F.; 1967; pp. 12, 27-35, 56-60, 113, 123, 131-133, 152, 157, 170, 178-

193, 198, 199, 211, 229-233, 309, 317, 323-333.

110. BENAVIDES, Rodolfo; “Experiencias Paranormales”; 328 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Editorial Diana; Mexico,

D. F.; Junio, 1981; pp. 20, 25, 26, 91-103, 121-123.

111. BENAVIDES, Rodolfo; “Rumbos Humanos”; Novel; 390 pp.; bibl. 389, 390; illus.; 20 cm; pb.; 5th

ed.; Editores Mexicanos Unidos; Mexico, D. F.; Febrero, 1971; pp. 10-12, 14, 40.

112. BAZETT, L. M.; “Beyond the Five Senses”; Basil Blackwell; London; 1946.

113. BENDER, Hans; “Unser Sechster Sinn”; 176 pp.; illus.; bibl. 175; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Wilhelm

Goldmann Verlag; München; West Germany; 1982; pp. 167-173.

114. BENDIT, Laurence; “The Mirror of Life and Death”; 200 pp.; 17.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; The Theosophical

Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1968; pp. 76, 87, 94.

115. BÉNEZECH, Alfred; “Les Phénomènes Psychiques et la Question de l’Au-delà”; 394 pp.; 17.5 cm;

hb.; Librairie Fishbacher; Paris; 1912; pp. 24-27, 198, 199.

116. BENNETT, Alfred Gordon; “Focus on the Unknown”; XII + 260 pp.; illus.; bibl. 259, 260; 21 cm; hb.;

dj.; Rider and Co.; London; 1953; pp. 187, 188, 207, 248-257.

117. BENNETT, Colin; “Practical Time Travel”; 96 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd ed. rev.; Samuel Weiser; New York; 1980; pp. 28, 29; eds.: Eng., Port.

118. BENNETT, John G.; “Witness”; Autobiography; epil. por Elizabeth Bennett;

X + 384 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Turnstone Press; Wellingborough; Northamptonshire; Great Britain;

1983; pp. 3-6, 10, 261, 283.

119. BENTOV, Itzhak; “Stalking the Wild Pendulum: On the Mechanics of Consciousness”; XVI + 238

pp.; illus.; bibl. 237; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 3rd print.; Bantam Books; New York; 1981; pp. 3, 77, 116,

117, 126-142.

120. BERENDT, Heinz C.; “Parapsicologia”; transl. and introd. Antonio Sanchez Arjona; 192 pp.; illus.;

glos. 170-176; bibl. 177-185; index of names; alph.; 21 cm; cart.; Ediciones Morata; Madrid; Spain;

1976; pp. 113, 120-124; eds.: Ger., Sp.

121. BERG, Philip S.; “Reincarnation: The Wheels of a Soul”; pref. Kenneth R. Clark; 224 pp.; glos. 203-

213; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; Research Centre of Kabbalah; New York; 1984; pp. 70, 71, 80, 81, 145.

122. BERGIER, Jacques; “Você é Paranormal”; transl. Álvaro Cabral; 6 + 114 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Livraria

Eldorado Tijuca; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1972; pp. 28, 29.

Page 6: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

123. BERGSON, Henri; “L’Énergie Spirituelle”; 228 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Librairie Félix Alcan; Paris; 1920;

pp. 65-89.

124. BERNARD, Raymond; “Novas Mensagens do Sanctum Celestial”; transl. Aurora

P. de Carvalho; 348 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; Editora Renes; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1974; pp. 203-216.

125. BERNARDES JR., Lannes J.; “Espiritualismo Evolucionista”; 180 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; Author’s Edition;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1966; pp. 134-136.

126. BERTHE, R. P.; “Saint Alphonse de Liguori”; Biography; 2 Vol.; XVI + 1.448 pp.; illus.; 24 cm; hb.;

Librairie de la Sainte-Famille; Paris; 1906; Tome Second: pp. 359-363. 127. BERTRAND, I.; “La Sorcellerie”; 64 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Librairie Blond; Paris; 1912; pp. 27-59.

128. BESANT, Annie Wood; “O Caminho do Discipulado”; transl. E. Nicoll; 114 pp.; glos. 113, 114; 19.5

cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1983; pp. 69, 74, 97, 105.

129. BESANT, Annie Wood; “O Homem e Seus Corpos”; transl. Mário de Alemquer; 146 pp.; 19 cm; pb.;

Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1976; pp. 21, 35, 40, 41, 52, 62-72, 125, 127, 128, 133, 134.

130. BESANT, Annie Wood; “Lecturas Populares de Teosofía”; transl. Federico Climent Terrer; 156 pp.;

18 cm; pb.; Editorial Teosofica Argentina; Rosario; Argentina; 1970; pp. 134-148; eds.: Eng., Sp.

131. BESANT, Annie Wood; “El Poder del Pensamiento”; transl. José Melián; 180 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; 3rd

ed.; Biblioteca Orientalista; Barcelona; Spain; 1910; pp. 168-173; eds.: Eng., Sp., Port.

132. BESANT, Annie Wood; “Reencarnación”; without translator; 104 pp.; 15 cm; pb.; Federación

Teosofica Interamericana; Rosario; Argentina; 1974; pp. 67-79; eds.: Eng., Sp.

133. BESANT, Annie Wood; “A Sabedoria Antiga”; transl. Eugenio N. de Almeida; 246 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1977; pp. 63-70.

134. BESANT, Annie Wood; “A Study in Consciousness”; XIV + 372 pp.; illus.; alph.; 18 cm; hb.; 7th

print.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Adyar; Madras; India; 1975; pp. 173-188.

135. BESANT, Annie Wood; “Yoga: Ciência da Vida Espiritual”; transl. and pref. Cinira Riedel de

Figueiredo; 126 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1976; pp. 78, 79, 108-111.

136. BLACHER, Richard S.; “To Sleep, Perchance to Dream”; The Journal of the American Medical

Association; Vol. 242; N. 21; 23, November, 1979; p. 229.

137. BLACK, David; “Ekstasy: Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; 244 pp.; bibl. 215-236; alph.; 20.5 cm; pb.;

The Bobbs-Merril Co.; New York; 1975; pp. 1-244 (Mini-library).

138. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “A Postal Survey of OBEs and Other Experiences”; Journal of the Society

for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 52; N. 796; February, 1984; bibl. 242, 243; pp. 225-244.

139. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “Beyond the Body: An Investigation of Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; pref.

Brian Inglis; XVI + 272 pp.; illus.; bibl. 253-264; alph.; 20 cm; pb.; Granada Publishing; London;

1983; pp. I + XVI, 1-272 (Mini-library).

140. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “Birth and the OBE: An Unhelpful Analogy”; The Journal of the American

Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 77; N. 3; July, 1983; bibl. 235, 236; pp. 229-238.

141. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “Have You Ever Had An OBE?: The Wording of the Question”; Journal of

the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 51; N. 791; June, 1982; pp. 292-302.

142. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “Leaving the Body: A Practical Guide to Astral Projection”; Books

Reviews; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 52; N. 797; June, 1984; pp.

316-318. 143. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “On the Extrasomatic Localization of OB Projections”; The Journal of the

American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 75; N. 4; October, 1981; pp. 365, 366.

144. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “Out-of-Body Experiences” (Janet Lee Mitchell); Books Reviews; Journal

of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 51; N. 792; October, 1982; pp. 387-389.

145. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “Out-of-Body Experiences, Lucid Dreams, and Imagery: Two Surveys”; The

Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 76; N. 4; October, 1982; pp.

301-317.

146. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “Parapsychology and Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; introd. A. J. Ellison;

34 pp.; bibl. 31-33; 21 cm; pb.; The Society for Psychical Research; London; July, 1978; pp. 1-34.

147. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “Parapsychology: With or Without the OBE?”; Parapsychology Review;

New York; Vol. 13; N. 6; November-December, 1982; bibl. 7; pp. 1-7.

148. BLACKMORE, Susan J.; “SPR 1981 Conference”; Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 12; N. 6;

November-December, 1981; pp. 19-22.

Page 7: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

149. BLACKSMITH, Lawrence (Pseud. for Hernani Guimarães Andrade); “Algo Mais, Além do

Cérebro?”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo, SP; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 101; illus.; August,

1982; pp. 4, 5 (See N. 27-30).

150. BLACKSMITH, Lawrence (Pseud. for Hernani Guimarães Andrade); “A Mente Através do Espaço”;

Folha Espírita; S. Paulo, SP; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 102; illus.; September, 1982; pp.

4, 5.

151. BLASCO, Ricardo; “El Poder Oculto de la Mente Humana”; 266 pp.; illus.; 19 cm; pb.; Ediciones

Telstar; Barcelona; Spain; 1975; pp. 187, 188, 190-201, 221, 222. 152. BLAVATSKY, Helen Petrovna Hahn Fadéef de; “Dynamics of the Psychic World”; pref. and introd.

Lina Psaltis; XVIII + 132 pp.; bibl. 122, 123; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; The Theosophical Publishing House;

London; 1972; pp. 15, 16, 41, 42.

153. BLAVATSKY, Helen Petrovna Hahn Fadéef de; “Glosario Teosofico”; transl. J. Roviralta Borrell;

introd. Héctor V. Morel; pref. George Robert Stow Mead; 904 pp.; 22.5 cm; hb.;

4th ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977; p. 368.

154. BLAVATSKY, Helen Petrovna Hahn Fadéef de; “Isis Unveiled”; 2 Vol. in 1 book; 1.392 pp.; Vol. I:

XLVI + 628 pp.; Vol. II: X + 708 pp.; illus.; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; 4th print.; The Theosophy Co.; Los

Angeles, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1975; Vol. I: pp. 476-481; Vol. II: pp. 618, 619.

155. BLAVATSKY, Helen Petrovna Hahn Fadéef de; “The Secret Doctrine”; 6 Vol.; 2.630 pp.; alph.; Vol.

6; 24.5 cm; hb.; dj.; The Theosophical Publishing House; India; 1971; Vol. 5: p. 561.

156. BLEIBTREU, John; “Interviews With Oscar Ichazo”; 190 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; Arica Institute Press;

New York; 1982; pp. 6, 47, 131.

157. BLUNSDON, Norman; “A Popular Dictionary of Spiritualism”; pref. Eric W. Stuart; 256 pp.; bibl.

237-256; 20 cm; hb.; Arco Publications; London; 1962; pp. 20, 29, 50, 51, 63, 248.

158. BODDINGTON, Harry; “Materialisations”; 194 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; Psychic Press; London; no

date; pp. VIII, fig. 20. 159. BODDINGTON, Harry; “Mediums Who Leave Their Bodies”; Psychic News; London; Newspaper; N.

89; February 3, 1934; p. 2.

160. BODDINGTON, Harry; “Passing Through Brick Walls”; Psychic News; London; Newspaper; illus.;

10, February, 1934; N. 90; p. 4.

161. BODDINGTON, Harry; “Paying Visits With Astral Bodies”; Psychic News; London; Newspaper; N.

102; 05, May, 1934; p. 2.

162. BODDINGTON, Harry; “Swedenborg’s Visits to the Spirit World and After”; Psychic News; London;

Newspaper; N. 79; 25, November, 1933; p. 8.

163. BODIER, Paul; “Como Desenvolver a Mediunidade”; transl., pref. and glos.: Francisco Klörs

Werneck; 134 pp.; illus.; glos. 121-132; 18.5 cm; pb.; 7th ed.; Editora Eco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

1981; pp. 21, 23, 122, 123, 131.

164. BOIRAC, Émile; “La Psychologie Inconnue”; XIV + 360 pp.; index of names; 21.5 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.;

Librairie Félix Alcan; Paris; 1912; pp. 91, 264-285.

165. BOIS, Jules; “Le Monde Invisible”; 432 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Ernest Flammarion, Éditeur; Paris; no date;

pp. 376-379.

166. BOLEN, James Grayson; “Interview: Charles Theodore Tart”; Psychic; Magazine; Vol. IV; N. 3;

February, 1973; illus.; pp. 6-11. 167. BOND, M. Phyllis; “Beyond the Strange”; Fate; Magazine; Evanston; Ill.; U. S. A.; 158 pp.; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Paperback Library; New York; September, 1971; pp. 75-78.

168. BONIN, Werner F.; “Lexicon Der Parapsychologie und ihrer Grenzgebiete”; VIII + 588 pp.; illus.;

bibl. 553-587; 24 cm; hb.; dj.; Scherz; München; West Germany; 1976; pp. 39, 40, 122, 138, 139, 171,

172, 345, 374, 429, 449, 502; eds.: Ger., Sp.

169. BONO, Ernesto; “Senhor da Yoga e da Mente”; 260 pp.; bibl. 259, 260; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; pp. 180-182.

170. BORD, Janet; “Astral Projection”; 64 pp.; bibl. 62, 63; 18 cm; pb.; The Aquarian Press; London; 1977;

pp. 1-64; eds.: Eng., Sp. (Mini-library).

171. BORGIA, Anthony; “A Vida nos Mundos Invisíveis”; pref. John Anderson; transl. J. Escobar Faria;

210 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Empresa Editora O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1960; pp. 17, 176.

172. BOSC, Ernest; “La Psychologie Devant La Science et Les Savants”; 392 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; 3rd ed.; H.

Daragon, Éditeur; Paris; 1908; pp. 309-315.

Page 8: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

173. BOSC, Mme, Ernest (M. A. B.); “Voyage en Astral ou Vingt Nuits Consécutives des Dégagement

Conscient”; 408 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; Chamuel, Éditeur; Paris; 1896;

pp. 1-408; eds.: Fr., Port. (Mini-library).

174. BOSWELL, Harriet A.; “Master Guide to Psychism”; 224 pp.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Parker Publishing Co.;

West Nyack; New York; October, 1970; pp. 62, 63, 69, 127-141.

175. BOTELHO, Henrique; “Um Caso de Desdobramento”; Vanguarda; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

Newspaper; Daily; Section “Nas Fronteiras do Outro Mundo”; Yr. X; N. 6.531; 12, October, 1932; p.

2. 176. BOUISSOU, Michaël; “The Life of a Sensitive”; transl. Mervyn Savill; 216 pp.; Sidwick & Jackson;

London; 1955; pp. 142-147, 190-196.

177. BOULTON, Peter, and BOULTON, Jane; “Psychic Beam to Beyond” (Lenora Huet); pref. Jane

Boulton; 134 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; De Vorss & Co.; Marina del Rey; Cal.; U. S. A.; 1983; p. 64.

178. BOURDIN, Antoinette; “Entre Dois Mundos”; Novel; transl. Manuel Quintão; 216 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 4th

ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; pp. 20, 49, 137-140.

179. BOURDIN, Antoinette; “Memórias da Loucura”; Novel; transl. Manuel Quintão; 244 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

3rd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; pp. 30, 31, 42, 43, 46, 50, 56, 64,

71, 91, 138.

180. BOURGEAT, J.-G.; “Magie”; 160 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Chamuel, Éditeur; Paris; 1895; pp. 30, 122, 123.

181. BOURGUIGNON, Erika; “Religion, Altered States of Consciousness and Social Change”; Anthology;

X + 390 pp.; illus.; bibl.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Ohio State University Press; Columbus; Ohio; U. S.

A.; 1973; pp. 12, 245.

182. BOWLES, Norma, and HYNDS, Fran; “Psi Search”; 168 pp.; illus.; bibl. 145-147; glos. 153-155;

alph.; 27.5 cm; pb.; Harper & Row, Publishers; New York; 1978; pp. 14, 15, 48-50, 62, 63, 154.

183. BOWYER, Mathew J.; “Encyclopedia of Mystical Terminology”; 136 pp.; illus.; alph.; 24 cm; hb.; dj.;

A. S. Barnes and Co.; New York; 1979; pp. 35, 43, 95, 96. 184. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “Animismo ou Espiritismo?”; transl. Guillon Ribeiro; 296 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd

ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1951; pp. 50-53, 70, 118-168, 287, 289.

185. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “Comunicações Mediúnicas Entre Vivos”; transl. Francisco Klörs Werneck;

pres. José Herculano Pires; 172 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; December, 1978; pp.

23, 25, 27, 33, 39, 40, 47, 57, 63-66, 70, 77, 84, 95, 96, 120-122, 136, 170, 171.

186. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “A Crise da Morte”; transl. and pref. Guillon Ribeiro; 178 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 4th

ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; pp. 29, 30, 159-163.

187. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “O Espiritismo e as Manifestações Psíquicas”; transl. Francisco Klörs Werneck;

118 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Eco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 53-59, 69.

188. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “Fenômenos de Bilocação”; transl. Francisco Klörs Werneck; pref. Carlos

Imbassahy; 152 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Edições Correio Fraterno; S. Bernardo do Campo, SP; Brazil;

February, 1983; pp. 1-152 (Mini-library).

189. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “Fenômenos Psíquicos no Momento da Morte”; transl. and pref. Carlos

Imbassahy; 320 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1927;

pp. 83, 84.

190. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “Les Manifestations Métapsychiques et les Animaux”;

without translator; 194 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Éditions Jean Meyer; Paris; 1926; pp. 37, 87-90. 191. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “Des Manifestations Supranormales Chez les Peuples Sauvages”; without

translator; 166 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Éditions Jean Meyer; Paris; 1927; pp. 36, 63, 115-118, 125-134.

192. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “A Morte e os Seus Mistérios”; transl. and pref. Francisco Klörs Werneck; 168

pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Eco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 125, 126, 131, 133, 135, 154, 162,

167.

193. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “Per la Difesa dello Spiritismo”; 240 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; Società Editrice

Partenopea; Napoli; Italy; 1927; pp. 101-118; eds.: It., Port.

194. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “Les Phénomènes de Hantise”; transl. C. de Vesme; pref.

J. Maxwell; XII + 312 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Librairie Félix Alcan; Paris; 1920; pp. 110-125.

195. BOZZANO, Ernesto; “Xenoglossia: Mediunidade Poliglota”; transl. Guillon Ribeiro; 218 pp.; 18 cm;

hb.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1933; pp. 23-27.

196. BRANDON, Wilfred; “Open the Door”; transcribed by Edith Ellis; XXII + 196 pp.; 20.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

C. & R. Anthony; New York; 1958; pp. 26, 85, 155.

Page 9: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

197. BRAUD, William G.; “Psi Perfomance and Autonomic Nervous System Activity”; The Journal of the

American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 75; N. 1; January, 1981; bibl. 27-35; pp. 1-

35 (p. 5).

198. BREECHER, Maury; “Cientistas: Sair do Corpo não é Sonho Nem Loucura”;

O Globo; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Newspaper; Daily; Yr. LVII; N. 17.640; 14, February, 1982; illus.; p.

28.

199. BRENNAN, J. H.; “Astral Doorways”; 116 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; 4th ed.; The Aquarian Press;

London; 1977; pp. 1-100; eds.: Eng., Sp. (Mini-library). 200. BRENNAN, J. H.; “Reincarnation: Five Keys to Past Lives”; 96 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; The

Aquarian Press; London; 1981; pp. 71-82; eds.: Eng., Port.

201. BRENT, Sandor; “Deliberately Induced Pre-mortem, Out-of-Body Experiences: An Experiential and

Theoretical Approach”; in “Between Life and Death”; Robert Kastenbaum; Springer; New York; 1979.

202. BRET, P. Thomas; “Les Métapsychoses”; 3 Vol.; 972 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; Librairie

J.-B. Baillière et Fils; Paris; 1939-1948; 1st Vol.: pp. 26, 27, 42, 43, 66-98, 134-212.

203. BRET, P. Thomas; “Précis de Métapsychique”; 3 Vol.; 520 pp.; Manual; glos. 29-58; 23.5 cm; hb.;

Librairie J.-B. Baillière et Fils; Paris; 1927-1932; 1st Vol.: pp. 30, 32, 136, 173-176.

204. BRICAUD, Jean; “I Primi Elementi di Occultismo”; transl. Pietro Bornia; 142 pp.; glos. 109-114; bibl.

115-139; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; Casa Editrice Atanor; Todi; Italy; 1922; pp. 51-58.

205. BRITANNICA, Encyclopaedia; 24 Vol.; 24.500 pp.; illus.; bibl. 670; alph.; 27.5 cm; hb.;

Encyclopaedia Britannica; Chicago; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1964; Vol. 18: p. 670.

206. BRITTAIN, Annie; “Twixt Earth and Heaven”; 190 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; illus.; Rider & Co.; London;

1935; pp. 45-93.

207. BRO, Hermon Hartzell; “Edgar Cayce on Religion and Psychic Experience”; pref. Hugh Lynn Cayce;

264 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Warner Books; New York; 1970; pp. 132-147.

208. BROAD, Charlie Dunbar; “Dreaming and Some of its Implications”; Proceedings of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 52; Part 188; February, 1959; pp. 53-78.

209. BROAD, Charlie Dunbar; “Lectures on Psychical Research, Incorporating the Perrott Lectures Given

in Cambridge University in 1959 and 1960”; 450 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; Humanities Press; New York;

1962.

210. BROAD, Charlie Dunbar; “Phantasms of the Living and of the Dead”; Proceedings of the Society for

Psychical Research; London; Vol. 50; Part 183; May, 1953; pp. 51-66.

211. BROWN, Barbara B.; “Supermind: The Ultimate Energy”; XIV + 286 pp.; bibl. 277-279; alph.; 23.5

cm; hb.; dj.; Harper & Row, Publishers; New York; 1980; pp. 211-217.

212. BROWN, Slater; “The Heyday of Spiritualism”; 296 pp.; illus.; bibl.; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; Pocket Books;

New York; 1972.

213. BROWNING, Norma Lee; “The Psychic World of Peter Hurkos”; introd. C. V. Wood Jr.; 238 pp.;

illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Signet Mystic Book; New York; 1971; pp. 46, 54, 112-114, 219.

214. BRUCKER, Karl; “Die Rosenkreuz-Meditation als Weg zum ununterbrochenem Bewusstsein und zur

Einweihung”; Die Andere Welt; Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 20; N. 7; July,

1969; pp. 617-622.

215. BRUNTON, Paul; “A Busca do Eu Superior”; transl. Gilberto Bernardes de Oliveira; 256 pp.; illus.;

19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1978; p. 158. 216. BRUNTON, Paul; “O Egito Secreto”; transl. Zofia de P. Gaffron; 270 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora

Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1976; pp. 67-72, 131, 173, 175-177, 266.

217. BRUNTON, Paul; “A Índia Secreta”; transl. Zofia de P. Gaffron; introd. Francis Younghusband; 298

pp.; illus.; glos. 295-297; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1968;

pp. 86, 87, 93-95, 123, 124, 141-143, 204, 284, 285.

218. BUCKE, Richard Maurice; “Cosmic Consciousness: A Study in the Evolution of the Human Mind”;

XX + 326 pp.; bibl. 319-326; 23 cm; pb.; 3rd print.; The Citadel Press; Secaucus; New Jersey; U. S.

A.; 1977; pp. 7, 8, 60-63; eds.: Eng., Port.

219. BUCKLAND, Raymond, and CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “Amazing Secrets of the

Psychic World”; 202 pp.; 21 cm; cart.; 2nd print.; Parker Publishing Co.; West Nyack; New York;

July, 1977; pp. 152-156.

220. BULFORD, Staveley; “Man’s Unknown Journey”; 222 pp.; illus.; glos. 212-215; bibl. 200; alph.; 21

cm; hb.; 2nd print.; ed. rev.; Rider & Co.; London; May, 1944; pp. 24, 102, 110, 137-157.

Page 10: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

221. BULWER-LYTTON, Edward George Earle; “Zanoni”; Novel; transl. Ricardo Siqueira; 282 pp.; 21

cm; pb.; Livros do Mundo Inteiro; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1972; pp. 150, 202, 203.

222. BUNKER, Dusty; “Dream Cycles”; 230 pp.; illus.; bibl. 225, 226; alph.; 23.5 cm; pb.; Para Research;

Rockport; Massachusetts; U. S. A.; April, 1981; pp. 106-111, 208, 211.

223. BURANG, Theodore; “Tibetan Art of Healing”; transl. and introd. Susan Macintosh;

X + 118 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Watkins Publishing; London; 1974; pp. 17-26.

224. BURT, Cyril; “E. S. P. and Psychology”; introd. Anita Gregory; 180 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Weidenfeld and Nicolson; London; 1975; p. 50. 225. BURT, Cyril; “Jung’s Account of his Paranormal Experiences”; Journal of the Society for Psychical

Research; London; Vol. 42; N. 718; December, 1963; pp. 163-180.

226. BUSCH, Wilhelm; “Album”; 464 pp.; illus.; 24 cm; hb.; Rascher Verlag; Zürich; Switzerland; 1945;

pp. 252, 253.

227. BUTLER, W. E.; “Apprenticed to Magic”; 106 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; pb.; The Aquarian Press; London;

1981; pp. 67-74.

228. BUTLER, W. E.; “The Magician: His Training and Work”; 176 pp.; illus.; bibl.

173-176; 21 cm; pb.; 4th print.; Wilshire Book Co.; North Hollywood; Cal.; U.S.A.; 1969;

pp. 114-121.

229. BUTTLAR, Johannes V.; “Caminho para a Eternidade”; transl. Trude von Laschan Solstein Arneitz;

194 pp.; illus.; bibl. 187-193; 20 cm; pb.; Edições Melhoramentos; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1976; pp. 33-36,

107-110.

230. BYSE, Charles; “Swedenborg”; Biography; 5 Vol.; 1.706 pp.; illus.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Georges Bridel &

Cie. Éditeurs; Lausanne; Switzerland; 1911-1913; Vol. 1: pp. 115, 116.

231. CAJADO, Gilmen Maia; “Passeando Fora do Corpo Físico”; Luzerna Sobre o Alqueire; Duque de

Caxias, RJ; Brazil; Newspaper; Yr. VI; N. 71; September-October, 1983, p. 1.

232. CALLE, Ramiro A.; “Ananda: El Yogui Errante”; 202 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1980; pp. 52, 53, 164, 168, 169.

233. CALLE, Ramiro A.; “Verdad y Mentira de “El Tercer Ojo”; 224 pp.; illus.; bibl. 221, 222; 21 cm; pb.;

Editorial Eyras; Madrid; Spain; 1980; pp. 10, 15, 18, 22, 195, 201.

234. CALMET, Augustine; “The Phantom World: The Philosophy of Spirits, Apparitions, etc.”; editor

Henry Christmas; 2 Vol.; Vol. I: XXXII + 378 pp.; Vol. II: VI + 362 pp.;

R. Bentley; London; 1850.

235. CAMAYSAR, Rosabis; “Consciência Cósmica”; 286 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Editora

O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 86-88, 98, 99.

236. CAMAYSAR, Rosabis; “Magia do Sertão”; 194 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Empresa Editora

Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1940; pp. 161-178.

237. CAMPBELL, Jean; “Dreams Beyond Dreaming”; 152 pp.; bibl. 151; 21.5 cm; pb.; Unilaw Library

Book; Virginia Beach; Norfolk; U. S. A.; 1980; pp. 20-27, 76.

238. CAMPIGNY, H.-M. de; “Les Traditions et les Doctrines Ésotériques”; 254 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Editions

Astra; Paris; Février, 1946; pp. 61-108.

239. CAMPOS, Alberto; “El Enigma de la Muerte y la Vida de Ultratumba”; 304 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; A.

Marzo; Barcelona; Spain; 1931; pp. 76-90.

240. CANNON, Alexander; “The Shadow of Destiny: The Power of Karma”; 176 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.; The Aquarian Press; London; February, 1970; pp. 41, 55, 118, 119, 121-126.

241. CARDILLO, Edmundo; “Fantasmas do Ocultismo”; 120 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Edibace; S. Paulo; Brazil;

1972; pp. 99-119.

242. CARDILLO, Edmundo; “As Máscaras da Morte”; 94 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Brasbiblos;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1972; pp. 35, 36.

243. CARNEIRO, Victor Ribas; “ABC do Espiritismo”; 198 pp.; glos. 192, 193; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Federação Espírita do Paraná; Curitiba, PR; Brazil; 1977; pp. 83, 84.

244. CARPENTER, Edward; “The Art of Creation”; George Allen & Unwin; London; 1904; p. 18.

245. CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “Higher Psychical Development”; XII + 294 pp.; illus.;

glos. 290; alph.; 22 cm; pb.; The Aquarian Press; London; 1978; pp. 153, 266-289.

246. CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “Modern Psychical Phenomena”; XVI + 332 pp.; illus.;

index of names; 20.5 cm; hb.; Dodd, Mead and Co.; New York; 1919; pp. 146-154.

Page 11: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

247. CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “Phantasms of the Dead or True Ghost Stories”; 246

pp.; illus.; glos. 11, 12; bibl. 245, 246; 20 cm; hb.; American Universities Publishing Co.; New York;

1920; pp. 40-43, 46-50.

248. CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “A Primer of Psychical Research”; 118 pp.; 19 cm; hb.;

dj.; Ives Washburn Publishers; New York; 1932; pp. 32-35, 46.

249. CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “Psychic Oddities”; 184 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Rider and

Co.; London; 1952; pp. 22, 127-134.

250. CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “Psychical Phenomena and the War”; X + 364 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Dodd, Mead and Co.; New York; 1919; pp. 172, 173, 190, 191, 201-203.

251. CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “Your Psychic Powers and How to Develop Them”;

XVIII + 358 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Newcastle Publishing Co.; California;

U. S. A.; 1975; pp. 47, 138, 229-235, 241, 245.

252. CARTON, Paul; “La Science Occulte et les Sciences Occultes”; 460 pp.; illus.; alph.; 23.5 cm; cart.;

reed.; Librairie Le François; Paris; 1976; pp. 106, 224, 225, 295, 303, 304,

309-320, 326, 337, 341, 344, 345, 361, 369, 408.

253. CARVALHO, Sebastião de; “Waldo Vieira e a Projeciologia”; Reencarnação; Porto Alegre, RS;

Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. XXXIV; N. 417; November, 1982; pp. 14, 15.

254. CASSOLI, P.; “Esiste la Bilocazione?”; Rivista Metapsichica; Milano; Italy; Installment I; 1954.

255. CASTANEDA, Carlos César Salvador Arana; “A Erva do Diabo”; transl. Luzia Machado da Costa;

246 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.; 10th ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 121-126, 208.

256. CASTANEDA, Carlos César Salvador Arana; “The Fire From Within”; 296 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.;

Simon and Schuster; New York; 1984; pp. 79, 122, 123, 136, 155, 156, 174-184, 208, 209, 212, 215,

216, 219, 220, 271, 272, 274-276, 287, 288.

257. CASTANEDA, Carlos César Salvador Arana; “Journey To Ixtlan: The Lessons of Don Juan”; 282 pp.;

18 cm; pocket; pb.; Penguin Books; London; 1979; pp. 167-169; eds.: Eng., Ger., Port., etc. 258. CASTANEDA, Carlos César Salvador Arana; “O Presente da Águia”; transl. Vera Maria Whately; 262

pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; October, 1981; pp. 9, 20-24, 46-48, 93-110,

112-120, 124-133, 190-211.

259. CASTANEDA, Carlos César Salvador Arana; “O Segundo Círculo do Poder”; transl. Luzia Machado

da Costa; 238 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 84, 155,

203.

260. CASTANEDA, Carlos César Salvador Arana; “A Separate Reality: Further Conversations With Don

Juan”; 270 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Penguin Books; London; 1979;

pp. 104, 130-132; 137, 154; eds.: Eng., Port., etc.

261. CASTANEDA, Carlos César Salvador Arana; “Tales of Power”; 284 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Penguin

Books; London; 1980; pp. 17, 35; eds.: Eng., Port., Fr., etc.

262. CASTELLAN, Yvonne; “Le Spiritisme”; 128 pp.; bibl. 125, 126; 17.5 cm; pb.; Presses Universitaires

de France; Paris; 1954; pp. 24-28; eds.: Fr., Port.

263. CASTRO, Almerindo Martins de ; “Antônio de Pádua”; 160 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1945; pp. 44, 48, 49, 104-111.

264. CASTRO, Almerindo Martins de; “O Martírio dos Suicidas”; 210 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 7th ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; p. 139. 265. CASTRO, Francisco Lyon de; Editor; “O Ocultismo: A Revelação da Ciência dos Magos”; transl.

Maria Leonor Braga Abecassis; 146 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Publicações Europa-América; Mira-Sintra;

Portugal; no date; pp. 48-50.

266. CAVENDISH, Richard; Editor; “Encyclopedia of the Unexplained”; introd. Joseph Banks Rhine; 304

pp.; illus.; bibl. 286-297; 28 cm; pb.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1974;

pp. 37-39.

267. CAVERSAN, Ariovaldo, and ANDRADE, Geziel; “O Pós-morte Visto por Ernesto Bozzano e

Raymond A. Moody Jr.”; Reformador; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 101; N. 1.851;

June, 1983; pp. 9-11.

268. CAYCE, Hugh Lynn; Editor; “The Edgar Cayce Reader”; 188 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Warner Books;

New York; 1974; pp. 120-128.

269. CAYCE, Hugh Lynn; “Faces of Fear”; VIII + 198 pp.; illus.; bibl. 190-193; alph.; 17.5 cm; pocket;

pb.; Berkley Books; New York; February, 1982; pp. 72-76, 79,80.

Page 12: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

270. CERCHIO Firenze 77; “Dai Mondi Invisibili: Incontri e Colloqui”; 242 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.;

Edizioni Mediterranee; Roma; Italy; 1977; pp. 35, 36.

271. CERVIÑO, Jayme; “Além do Inconsciente”; 188 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio

de Janeiro; Brazil; 1968; pp. 95.

272. CHAMPLIN, Russel Norman; “Evidências Científicas Demonstram que Você Vive Depois da Morte”;

276 pp.; bibl. 273-276; 21 cm; pb.; Nova Época Editorial; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981;

pp. 33, 34, 91, 97, 163-211, 231-263.

273. CHAPLIN, J. P.; “Dictionary of the Occult and Paranormal”; 180 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Dell Publishing Co.; New York; December, 1976; p. 14.

274. CHARRIÈRE, Henri; “Papillon”; Novel; pres. Jean-Pierre Castelnau

& Jean-François Revel; 698 pp.; illus.; 16.5 cm; pocket; pb.; Robert Laffont; Paris; 1982;

pp. 337-339; eds.: Fr., Eng., Port.

275. CHAUVIN, Rémy; “La Parapsychologie: Quand L’Irrationnel Rejoin la Science”; 210 pp.; illus.; bibl.

201-206; 23 cm; pb.; Hachette; Paris; 1980; p. 106.

276. CHEETHAM, Erika; “As Profecias de Nostradamus”; transl. Áurea Weissenberg; 514 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

10th ed.; Editora Nova Fronteira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 149, 150, 218.

277. CHEVREUIL, L.; “On Ne Meurt Pas”; 318 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Jouve & Cie., Éditeurs; Paris; no date; pp.

139-159.

278. CHEVREUIL, L.; “Le Spiritisme dans L’Église”; 316 pp.; index of names; 19 cm; pb.; Jouve & Cie.,

Éditeurs; Paris; 1922; pp. 206-218.

279. CHIESA, Carlos Luis; “Origen del Espiritismo y su Doctrina”; 408 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Editorial

Constancia; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1946; pp. 46-48, 82, 83.

280. CHINMOY, Sri; “Death and Reincarnation”; 142 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.; Agni Press; Jamaica; N. Y.;

U. S. A.; 1974; pp. 3-5.

281. CHRISTIAN, Johann (Pseud. for Gilberto Campista Guarino); “Um Fato Estranho”; Obreiros do Bem; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. II; N. 20; May, 1975; pp. 4, 5 (See N. 656).

282. CHRISTIE-MURRAY, David; “Psychic Voyages” (Stuart Holroyd); Books Reviews; Journal of the

Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 49; N. 773; September, 1977; p. 620.

283. CHRISTOPHER, Milbourne; “Esp, Seers & Psychics”; X + 268 pp.; illus.; bibl.

251-257; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Thomas Y. Crowell Co.; New York; 1970; pp. 213-220.

284. CHU, Paul E.; “Life Before Birth, Life on Earth, Life After Death”; IV + 194 pp.; bibl. 192, 193; 17.5

cm; pb.; 2nd print.; World View Press; Fort Lee, New Jersey; U. S. A.; June, 1976; pp. 169-173.

285. CIRNE, Leopoldo; “Doutrina e Prática do Espiritismo”; 2 Vol.; 734 pp.; 22 cm; hb.; Tipografia do

Jornal do Commercio; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1920; Vol. I: pp. 221-234.

286. CLARIE, Thomas C.; “Occult Bibliography”; 454 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press;

Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1978; N. 17, 25, 104, 318, 319, 320, 580, 620, 626, 688, 882, 1129, 1295,

1296, 1396, 1498, 1584, 1764.

287. COBLENTZ, Stanton A.; “Light Beyond: The Wonderworld of Parapsychology”; 206 pp.; alph.;

Cornwall Books; East Brunswick, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1982.

288. CODD, Clara M.; “La Eterna Sabiduria de la Vida”; 244 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Editorial Orion; Mexico, D.

F.; 1977; pp. 143-152.

289. CODDINGTON, Mary; “A Energia Curativa”; transl. Neide Camera Loureiro Pinto; pref. William Gutman; 218 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; p. 48.

290. COHEN, Daniel; “ESP: The Search Beyond the Senses”; 188 pp.; illus.; glos.

175-178; bibl. 179, 180; alph.; hb.; dj.; Harcourt Brace Jovanovich; New York; 1973;

pp. 158-161, 176.

291. COLEMAN, Stanley M.; “The Phantom Double: Its Psychological Significance”; British Journal of

Medical Psychology; Vol. 14; Part 3; N. 254; 1934; bibl. 273; pp. 254-273.

292. COLLINS, Mabel; “O Despertar”; transl. Cinira Riedel de Figueiredo; 124 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.;

Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1964; pp. 13, 23-26, 55-59, 63-68, 72, 76, 77, 100, 107-110,

117.

293. COLLISON-MORLEY, Lacy; “Greek and Roman Ghost Stories”; VIII + 80 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.;

Argonaut, Publishers; Chicago; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1968; pp. 45-53.

294. COLTON, Ann Ree; “Ethical ESP”; introd. Jonathan Murro; 368 pp.; glos. 352-361; alph.; 21.5 cm;

hb.; dj.; Arc Publishing Co.; Glendale, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1971; pp. 156, 157.

Page 13: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

295. CONANT, Frances Ann; “Mrs. J. H. Conant, 1831-1875”; Biography; Notes: Allen Putnam; 322 pp.;

illus.; William White; Boston; Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1873.

296. CONTI, Massimo; “Testemunhas do Outro Mundo”; Manchete; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Magazine;

Weekly; N. 1.270; 21, August, 1976; illus.; pp. 124, 125.

297. CONWAY, David; “Magic: An Occult Primer”; 286 pp.; illus.; Jonathan Cape; London; 1972.

298. CONYBEARE, Irene; “Die Schöpferische Kraft des Denkens und Fühlens”; Die Andere Welt;

Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 20; N. 12; December, 1969; illus.; pp. 1066-1069.

299. COOK, Emily Williams; “Beyond the Body: An Investigation of Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; Books Reviews; Anabiosis - The Journal for Near-Death Studies; Vol. 4; N. 1; Spring, 1984; pp. 97-

104.

300. COOKE, Aileen H.; “Out of the Mouth of Babes: E. S. P. in Children”; pref. John D. Pearce-Higgins;

192 pp.; bibl. 187-190; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; James Clarke & Co.; London; 1968; 19-30, 36-45, 151.

301. COQUET, Michel; “Les Çakras: L’Anatomie Occulte de L’Homme”; 262 pp.; illus.; bibl. 257, 258; 22

cm; pb.; Dervy-Livres; Paris; 1982; pp. 216, 219.

302. CORGNOL, Christian de; “Los Sanadores Filipinos”; transl. J. A. Bravo; 176 pp.; illus.; glos. 169-

175; 20 cm; pb.; Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1979; p. 169.

303. CORLISS, William R.; “Strange Minds: A Sourcebook of Unusual Mental Phenomena”; 286 pp.;

Sourcebook Project; Glen Arm, Md.; U. S. A.; 1976.

304. CORNILLIER, Pierre-Émile; “La Prédiction de L’Avenir”; XII + 112 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Librairie Félix

Alcan; Paris; 1926; pp. 14, 85-88.

305. CORNILLIER, Pierre-Émile; “La Survivance de L’Ame et Son Évolution Après la Mort”; 580 pp.;

alph.; 22 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Imprimerie Bussiére; Paris; 1921; pp. 142, 143, 406, 407.

306. CORVALÁN, Graciela N. Vico; “Dialogo a Fondo con Carlos Castaneda”; Mutantia; Buenos Aires;

Argentina; Magazine; Bimonthly; N. 10; 1/1982; illus.; pp. 52-81.

307. COSTA, Carlos A. de Araujo; “O Paranormal e Seus Mistérios”; pref. Apio Campos; 154 pp.; illus.; glos. 149-152; bibl. 61, 93, 133; 21 cm; pb.; Gazeta do Interior; Castanhal; Pará; Brazil; 1981; p. 149.

308. COSTA, Vitor Ronaldo de Souza; “Apometria: Técnica Magnética de Pesquisas Espirituais”; Jornal

Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. 9; N. 104; February, 1984; illus.; bibl.;

p. 4.

309. COSTE, Albert; “Fenômenos Psíquicos Ocultos”; without translator; pref. Medeiros e Albuquerque;

LXXX + 228 pp.; illus.; 17.5 cm; hb.; H. Garnier, Livreiro-Editor; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1903;

pp. 77-79.

310. COUTO, Sousa; “Fenômeno de Exteriorização Anímica Obtido em Lisboa”; Estudos Psíquicos;

Lisboa; Portugal; Magazine; Monthly; N. 4; September, 1905; pp. 74, 75.

311. COXHEAD, David, and HILLER, Susan; “Dreams: Visions of the Night”; 96 pp.; illus.; bibl. 96; 28

cm; pb.; Avon Books; New York; 1976; pp. 23, 92, 93; eds.: Eng., Fr.

312. COXHEAD, Nona; “Mindpower”; 270 pp.; illus.; bibl. 243-255; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Penguin

Books; New York; 1979; pp. 10, 62, 116-128; eds.: Eng., It., Fr., Sp.

313. CRAWFORD, Quantz; “Methods of Psychic Development”; 102 pp.; illus.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Llewellyn

Publications; St. Paul; Minnesota; U. S. A.; 1978; pp. 63-69.

314. CRESPIGNY, Philip de; “This World and Beyond”; pp. 258; Cassell and Co.; London; 1934.

315. CROLARD, Jean-Francis; “Renaître Après la Mort”; 190 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Éditions Robert Laffont; Paris; Novembre, 1979; pp. 39, 40, 53; eds.: Fr., Port.

316. CROOKALL, Robert; “An Infant’s Perceptions of a Death”; Journal of the Society for Psychical

Research; London; Vol. 42; N. 717; September, 1963; pp. 124-126.

317. CROOKALL, Robert; “Astral Projection”; Fate; Magazine; Evanston, Ill.; U.S.A.; September, 1970;

pp. 67-73.

318. CROOKALL, Robert; “Astral Travelling”; Correspondence; Journal of the Society for Psychical

Research; London; Vol. 42; N. 717; September, 1963; pp. 147, 148.

319. CROOKALL, Robert; “Astral Travelling: Review of “The Enigma of Out-of-Body Travel” (Susy

Smith); International Journal of Parapsychology; Vol. VIII; N. 3; Summer, 1966.

320. CROOKALL, Robert; “Casebook of Astral Projection”; XVI + 160 pp.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; University

Books; Secaucus, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1972; pp. I-XVI, 1-160.

321. CROOKALL, Robert; “Der Austritt des Astralkörpers”; transl. E. G. Johns; Esotera; Freiburg; West

Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 22; N. 11; November, 1971;

pp. 1006-1011.

Page 14: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

322. CROOKALL, Robert; “Dreams” of High Significance”; 90 pp.; glos. 71-77; alph.; 23 cm; pb.;

Darshana International; Moradabad; India; 1974; pp. 1-90.

323. CROOKALL, Robert; “During Sleep: The Possibility of “co-operation” between the Living and the

Dead”; introd. Leslie Shepard; XVI + 102 pp.; bibl. 99-102; 20 cm; hb.; dj.; University Books;

Secaucus, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1974; pp. 1-4, 94, 95.

324. CROOKALL, Robert; “Ectasy: The Release of the Soul From the Body”; 164 pp.; Darshana

International; Moradabad; India; 1975.

325. CROOKALL, Robert; “Events on the Threshold of the After-Life”; introd. Cyril Atkinson; VIII + 236 pp.; illus.; bibl. 204-223; alph.; 24.5 cm; hb.; Darshana International; Moradabad; India; 1967; pp. 2-

198.

326. CROOKALL, Robert; “The Interpretation of Cosmic & Mystical Experiences”; pref. J. D. Pearce-

Higgins; XII + 176 pp.; glos. 155-157; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; James Clarke

& Co.; Cambridge; Great Britain; 1969; pp. 3-157.

327. CROOKALL, Robert; “Intimations of Immortality”; XVI + 142 pp.; James Clarke and Co.; London;

1965; pp. I-XVI, 1-142.

328. CROOKALL, Robert; “Journey Into Death”; Fate; Magazine; Evanston, Ill.;

U. S. A.; Vol. 16; N. 6; June, 1963.

329. CROOKALL, Robert; “The Jung-Jaffé View of Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; 134 pp.; The World

Fellowship Press; Great Britain; 1970; pp. 1-134.

330. CROOKALL, Robert; “The Mechanisms of Astral Projection”; VIII + 136 pp.; bibl. 120-125; 26 cm;

Darshana International; Moradabad; India; 1968; pp. 1-136.

331. CROOKALL, Robert; “More Astral Projections: Analysis of Case Histories”; XX + 154 pp.; 21.5 cm;

hb.; dj.; The Aquarian Press; London; 1964; pp. 1-154.

332. CROOKALL, Robert; “The Next World and the Next: Ghostly Garments”; XXII

+ 152 pp.; alph.; 18.5 cm; hb.; dj.; The Theosophical Publishing House; London; 1966; pp. 5, 6, 9, 10, 118-122, 129.

333. CROOKALL, Robert; “Out-of-the Body Experiences: A Fourth Analysis”; 224 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.;

University Books; New York; 1970; pp. 1-224.

334. CROOKALL, Robert; “Out-of-the-Body Experiences and Cultural Traditions”; Journal of the Society

for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 44; N. 737; September, 1968;

pp. 358-362.

335. CROOKALL, Robert; “Out-of-Body Experiences and Survival”; Cases 383-544; The World

Fellowship Press; Great Britain; 1970.

336. CROOKALL, Robert; “Psychic Breathing”; 96 pp.; glos. 91, 92; 22 cm; pb.; The Aquarian Press;

London; 1979; pp. 24-31, 48-68.

337. CROOKALL, Robert; “The Reluctant but Psychic Psychiatrist”; Two Worlds; London; Magazine;

Monthly; 81st Year; N. 3898; November, 1968; pp. 336-340.

338. CROOKALL, Robert; “The Study and Practice of Astral Projection”; 234 pp.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.;

University Books; New York; 1966; pp. 1-234 (Mini-library).

339. CROOKALL, Robert; “The Supreme Adventure”; XXX + 258 pp.; illus.; glos. XVII-XXIV; alph.; 22

cm; hb.; dj.; 2nd ed.; The Attic Press; Great Britain; 1975; pp. 18-21,

105-112, 115, 116, 129, 174, 175, 178, 198, 251. 340. CROOKALL, Robert; “The Techniques of Astral Projection”; 112 pp.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; The Aquarian

Press; London; 1977; pp. 1-112.

341. CROOKALL, Robert; “They Leave Their Bodies and Float in the Air”; Two Worlds; London;

Magazine; Monthly; 82nd Year; N. 3901; February, 1969; pp. 61-63.

342. CROOKALL, Robert; “Wenn die Seele ihre Fesseln Abstreift”; transl. L. Langenwalder; Esotera;

Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 21; N. 9; September, 1970; pp. 781-783.

343. CROOKALL, Robert; “What Happens When You Die”; 196 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Colin Smythe;

London; 1978; pp. 1-196.

344. CROUZET, Jean-Philippe; “Les Merveilles du Spiritisme”; 572 pp.; illus.; fig. 17, 23, 34-37; bibl.

543; 22 cm; pb.; Nouvelles Éditions Debresse; Paris; 1971; pp. 73, 78, 80, 88-96, 103, 108, 120, 123,

199-204, 238, 239, 254, 255, 398-404, 429-431, 528, 539 (Mini-library).

345. CROWE, Catherine; “Les Cotés Obscurs de la Nature”; transl. Z.; pref. Albert Rochas; 512 pp.; 21.5

cm; hb.; P.-G. Leymarie, Éditeur; Paris; 1900; pp. 126, 127, 160-213.

Page 15: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

346. CROWELL, Eugene; “The Spirit World”; 198 pp.; Colley & Rider; Boston; Massachusetts; U. S. A.;

1879.

347. CROWLEY, Aleister (Pseud. for Edward Alexander Crowley); “The Confessions of Aleister

Crowley”; pref. Kenneth Grant; introd. John Symonds; 960 pp.; illus.; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1979; pp. 224, 225, 260, 445, 517, 525, 694, 913.

348. CROWLEY, Aleister (Pseud. for Edward Alexander Crowley); “Magick”; introd. John Symonds and

Kenneth Grant; XIV + 512 pp.; illus.; glos. 119-122; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Routledge & Kegan Paul;

London; 1979; pp. 265, 266, 337. 349. CROWLEY, Aleister (Pseud. for Edward Alexander Crowley); “Magick Without Tears”; introd. Karl

J. Germer; pref. Israel Regardie; epil. Christopher S. Hyatt; XVI + 528 pp.; illus.; alph.; 22 cm; pb.;

3rd print.; Falcon Press; Phoenix, AZ; U. S. A.; June, 1982; pp. 18, 19, 22, 191, 245, 375, 388, 389.

350. CUMMINS, Geraldine Dorothy; “Mind in Life and Death”; introd. Raynor

C. Johnson; epil. David Russell; 270 pp.; glos. 261-263; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; The Aquarian Press;

London; 1956; pp. 88-90, 93, 97, 99, 249, 250.

351. CUMMINS, Geraldine Dorothy; “The Road to Immortality”; 196 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Psychic Press;

London; 1967; pp. 79, 80.

352. CUMMINS, Geraldine Dorothy; “Travellers in Eternity”; comp. E. B. Gibbes; pref. Eric Parker; 204

pp.; Psychic Press; London; 1948; pp. 171, 177.

353. CUNO, John Christian; “Memoirs on Swedenborg”; Biography; transl. Claire

E. Berninger; editor and pref. Alfred Acton; XXII + 180 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; The Academy Book Room;

Bryn Athyn, PA; U. S. A.; 1947; pp. 12, 13, 44, 58, 60, 61, 66; eds.: Ger., Eng.

354. CURRIE, Ian; “You Cannot Die”; 288 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Methuen; New York; 1978; pp. 9-12,

35, 71-111, 136-161.

355. CURTI, Rino; “Mediunidade em Ação”; 176 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Edições Feesp;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1983; pp. 16-18. 356. DAILEY, Abram Hoagland; “Mollie Fancher, the Brooklin Enigma”; XIV + 262 pp.; illus.; 20.5 cm;

hb.; Brooklin; U. S. A.; 1894.

357. DALE, Laura A.; WHITE, Rhea Amelia; and MURPHY, G.; “A Selection of Cases from a Recent

Survey of Spontaneous ESP Phenomena”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical

Research: New York; Vol. 56; 1962; pp. 3-47.

358. DALLAS, H. A.; “Communications from the Still Incarnate at a Distance from the Body”; Occult

Review; London; Magazine; Vol. 40; 1924; pp. 26-32.

359. DALLAS, H. A.; “Visions of Dying in the Ninth and Nineteenth Centuries”; Light; London;

Magazine; Vol. XLIII; 1923; p. 309.

360. DALLAS, Mary Kyle; “The Freed Spirit”; XII + 232 pp.; 18.5 cm; C. B. Reed; New York; 1894.

361. DALMOR, E. R.; “Quien Fue y Quien Es en Ocultismo”; 604 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos

Aires; Argentina; 1970; pp. 290, 291, 442.

362. DANE, Christopher; “Psychic Travel”; 192 pp.; Popular Library; New York; 1974.

363. DANE, L.; “Astral Travel: A Psychological Overview”; The Journal of Altered States of

Consciousness; U. S. A.; Vol. 2; 1976; pp. 249-258.

364. DANIÉLOU, Alain; “Yoga, Méthode de Réintégration”; 212 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; L’Arche; Paris;

1973; pp. 193, 194. 365. D’ARBÓ, Prof. (Pseud.); “La Parapsicologia... en Profundidad”; 248 pp.; illus.; glos. 199-244; 22 cm;

hb.; dj.; Plaza & Janes; Barcelona; Spain; March, 1979; pp. 127, 128, 133, 152, 161, 166, 167, 200,

202, 206, 207.

366. D’ARGONNEL, Oscar; “Não Há Morte”; 222 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Author’s Edition; Rio de

Janeiro; Brazil; 1920; pp. 129-147.

367. DASSIER, Adolphe; “Essai Sur L’Humanité Posthume et le Spiritisme”; 308 pp.; 17 cm; hb.; Librairie

J.-B. Baillière et Fils; Paris; 1883; pp. 272-287.

368. DAVID-NEEL, Alexandra; “Tibete: Magia e Mistério”; introd. Aaron Sussman; transl. Maria Judith

Martins; 294 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Hemus Livraria Editora; S. Paulo; Brazil; August, 1972;

pp. 46, 47, 263.

369. DAVIDS, Rhys; “What is Your Will?”; Rider & Co.; London; pp. 67, 218.

370. DAVIES, Owen; Editor; “The Omni Book of the Paranormal & the Mind”; introd. Frank Kendig; 430

pp.; 17.5 cm; pocket; pb.; Kensigton Publishing; New York; no date; pp. 285, 295.

Page 16: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

371. DAVIS, Andrew Jackson; “The Great Harmonia”; 3 Vol.; 1.200 pp.; illus.; 19 cm; hb.; 8th ed.; The

Austin Publishing Co.; Los Angeles, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1923; Vol. II: pp. 8, 9,

15-24, 61.

372. DAVY, Charles; “Towards a Third Culture”; Faber & Faber; London; 1961;

p. 112.

373. DAVY, John; “Há Vida Após a Morte?”; Manchete; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Magazine; Weekly; N.

1442; 8, December, 1979; pp. 28-33.

374. DAVY, John; “The Woman Who “Left” her Body”; The Observer; Newspaper; Great Britain; 13, October, 1968; p. 6.

375. DAWSON-SCOTT, C. A.; “From Four Who Are Dead”; Arrowsmith; London; 1926; pp. 13-19.

376. DAY, Harvey; “Occult Illustrated Dictionary”; IV + 156 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; dj.; Oxford University Press;

New York; 1976; pp. 11, 12.

377. DEJEAN, Georges; “A Nova Luz”; transl. and introd. Guillon Ribeiro; 248 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; dj.;

Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1937; pp. 89, 90.

378. DE LA MARE, Walter; “Behold this Dreamer!”; Anthology; 714 pp.; 24 cm; hb.; dj.; Alfred A. Knoff;

New York; 1939; pp. 411-426.

379. DELACOUR, Jean-Baptiste; “Aus den Jenseits Zurück”; pref. A. Resch; 144 pp.; bibl. 143; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Th. Knaur; München; West Germany; 1973; pp. 7-142.

380. DELANEY, Walter; “Ultra-Psicônica”; transl. Miécio Araújo Jorge Honkis; 286 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 262-264.

381. DELANNE, François Marie Gabriel; “A Alma é Imortal”; transl. Guillon Ribeiro; 314 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

4th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978; pp. 15, 49,

86-119, 135, 168, 203-210, 255-265.

382. DELANNE, François Marie Gabriel; “Les Apparitions Matérialisées des Vivants & des Morts”; 2

Vol.; 1.370 pp.; illus.; 22.5 cm; hb.; Librairie Spirite; Paris; 1909; pp. 144-521 (Mini-library). 383. DELANNE, François Marie Gabriel; “Comptu Rendu du Congrès Spirite et Spiritualiste International

1900”; 732 pp.; 23.5 cm; hb.; Societé Française d’Étude des Phénomènes Psychiques; Paris; 1902; pp.

79-87.

384. DELANNE, François Marie Gabriel; “Recherches Sur la Médiumnité”; XII + 516 pp.; illus.; 17.5 cm;

hb.; Librairie Des Sciences Psychiques; Paris; 1902; pp. 315-317, 320-323.

385. DELANNE, François Marie Gabriel; “Reencarnação”; transl. Carlos Imbassahy; 324 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.;

Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1940; pp. 100, 101, 204-207.

386. DE MILLE, Richard; Editor; “The Don Juan Papers: Further Castaneda Controversies”; Anthology;

526 pp.; illus.; bibl. 489-510; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; 2nd print.; Ross-Erikson Publishers; Santa Barbara;

Cal.; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 85, 220-225, 276, 419, 420.

387. DENIS, Léon; “Cristianismo e Espiritismo”; without translator; 330 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; 4th ed.;

Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1941; pp. 315, 316.

388. DENIS, Léon; “Depois da Morte”; transl. João Lourenço de Sousa; 334 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.; 10th

ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978; pp. 177, 178.

389. DENIS, Léon; “No Invisível”; transl. Leopoldo Cirne; 456 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; 5th ed.; Federação Espírita

Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1946; pp. 140-167.

390. DENIS, Léon; “O Problema do Ser, do Destino e da Dor”; without translator; 404 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.; 11st ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; pp. 75-99.

391. DENNING, Melita, & PHILLIPS, Osborne; “The Llewellyn Practical Guide to Astral Projection”; 240

pp.; illus.; glos. 237-239; 20.5 cm; pb.; Llewellyn Publications; U. S. A.; 1979; pp. 1-240; eds.: Eng.,

Sp. (Mini-library).

392. DEPASCALE, Alfonso, y RINALDINI, Manio; “Diccionario de Metapsiquismo-Espiritismo”; 150

pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.; Author’s Editions; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1927; pp. 9, 10, 17, 27, 92.

393. DESMOND, Shaw; “After Sudden Death”; 128 pp.; 16.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Andrew Dakers; London;

December, 1939; pp. 53, 54, 57, 79.

394. DESMOND, Shaw; “Reincarnation For Everyman”; 244 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Rider and Co.; London; no

date; pp. 189, 192-198.

395. DESMOND, Shaw; “You Can Speak With Your Dead”; 104 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Rider & Co.; London;

1945; p. 34.

396. DETHLEFSEN, Thorwald; “Das Leben nach dem Leben”; 272 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 4th ed.;

Wilhelm Heyne Verlag; München; West Germany; 1977; pp. 158-161, 167, 171, 172.

Page 17: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

397. DEVORE, Nicholas; “Enciclopedia Astrologica”; transl. Héctor V. Morel; 414

pp.; 23 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977; p. 328.

398. DICKENS, Charles; “Três Espíritos do Natal”; transl. Wallace Leal V. Rodrigues; 156 pp.; illus.; 18

cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Casa Editora O Clarim; Matão, SP; Brazil; 1975; pp. 46, 47, 68, 96, 110, 115.

399. DIGEST, Reader’s; “Into the Unknown”; 352 pp.; alph.; bibl. 342, 343; alph.; 27.5 cm; hb.; dj.; The

Reader’s Digest Association; New York; 1981; pp. 246, 270-283, 338.

400. DIGEST, Reader’s; “Mysteries of the Unexplained”; 320 pp.; illus.; bibl. 307-310; alph.; 27.5 cm; hb.;

dj.; The Reader’s Digest Association; New York; 1982; pp. 166, 168, 175, 227; eds.: Eng., Port. 401. DIGEST, Sélection Du Reader’s; “L’Europe Des Sociétés Secrètes”; 384 pp.; illus.; glos. 344-383; 31

cm; hb.; Sélection Du Reader’s Digest; Paris; Novembre, 1980; pp. 334, 336, 337, 342, 347.

402. DILLON, Douglas, and DILLON, Barbara; “An Explosion of Being”; 224 pp.; bibl. 211-213; alph.; 23

cm; pb.; Parker Publishing Co.; West Nyack, N. Y.; U. S. A.; 1984; pp. 55, 56, 110, 113, 114, 116,

126, 165, 173, 174, 202, 203.

403. DINGWALL, Eric J.; Editor; “Abnormal Hypnotic Phenomena”; VIII + 174 pp.; illus.; bibl. 159-164;

index of names; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; J. & A. Churchill; London; 1968; pp. 93, 96.

404. DINGWALL, Eric John, and LANGDON-DAVIES, John; “The Unknown is it Nearer?”; 174 pp.;

alph.; 18.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Cassel & Co.; London; 1956; pp. 9, 29, 30.

405. DOLIS, Rosangela Maria; “Viagens no Tempo”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N.

139; April, 1984; illus.; bibl.; pp. 36-43.

406. DONAHUE, James J.; “Dream Reality: The Conscious Creation of Dream & Paranormal Experience”;

ed. rev.; Bench Press; Oakland, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1979; pp. 68-70.

407. DONAHUE, James J.; “Enigma: Psychology, the Paranormal and Self-Transformation”; 200 pp.; glos.

167-170; bibl. 171-193; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Bench Press; Oakland; Cal.;

U. S. A.; 1979; pp. 6, 7, 13, 16-21, 25, 48, 63, 64, 70, 74, 77-79, 89, 97-111, 129, 150, 168, 169.

408. DOSTOIEVSKI, Fiodor; “O Sósia”; Novel; transl. Corália Rêgo Lins; 200 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Casa Editora Vecchi; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1943; pp. 43, 58, 59, 62, 68.

409. DOUGLAS, Alfred; “Extra-Sensory Powers”; 392 pp.; illus.; bibl. 379-385; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

The Overlook Press; New York; 1977; pp. 16, 323-332, 340, 341.

410. DOWDING, Hugh; “Lychgate”; 128 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; dj.; 2nd print.; Rider and Co.; London;

September, 1945; pp. 42, 52, 60.

411. DOYLE, Arthur Conan; “História do Espiritismo”; transl. and introd. Júlio Abreu Filho; pref. José

Herculano Pires; 500 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1960;

pp. 36, 66, 294.

412. DRAGAUD, J.; “Parapsicologia Através de Perguntas e Respostas”; 92 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.;

Edições de Ouro; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; pp. 53-55, 78, 79.

413. DRIESCH, Hans; “Psychical Research”; transl. Theodore Berterman; XVI + 176 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; G.

Bell & Sons; London; 1933; pp. 138-146.

414. DRURY, Nevill; “Don Juan, Mescalito and Modern Magic”; X + 230 pp.; illus.; bibl. 222-225; alph.;

21.5 cm; pb.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1978; pp. 6, 11-13, 17-44, 54, 57, 58, 59-61, 70, 78,

146, 155; eds.: Eng., Sp.

415. DRURY, Nevill; “Inner Visions: Explorations in Magical Consciousness”; 142 pp.; illus.; bibl. 133-

138; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1979; pp. 4, 27, 45, 124. 416. DRURY, Nevill; “The Path of the Chameleon”; 160 pp.; illus.; bibl.; alph.; Spearman; London; 1973.

417. DRURY, Nevill; “The Shaman and the Magician”; pref. Michael Harner; XIV

+ 130 pp.; illus.; bibl. 119-126; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1982; pp. 27,

29, 32, 43, 44, 46, 48, 94, 96, 98.

418. DRURY, Nevill, and TILLET, Gregory; “The Occult Sourcebook”; X + 236 pp.; illus.; index of

names; alph.; 23.5 cm; pb.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1978; pp. IX, 95-99.

419. DUBANT, Bernard, et MARGUERIE, Michel; “Castaneda: La Voie du Guerrier”; 100 pp.; illus.; 21.5

cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Guy Trédaniel; Paris; 1982; pp. 76-80.

420. DUBANT, Bernard, et MARGUERIE, Michel; “Castaneda: Le Sant dans l’Inconnu”; 138 pp.; illus.;

21.5 cm; pb.; Guy Trédaniel; Paris; 1982; pp. 76-78.

421. DUBOR, Georges de; “Les Mystères de L’Hypnose”; XII + 336 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Perrin et Cie.,

Librairies-Éditeurs; Paris; 1920; pp. 269-305.

422. DUBUGRAS, Elsie; “O Aprendizado pela Reencarnação”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine;

Monthly; N. 118-A; July, 1982; illus.; pp. 31-37.

Page 18: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

423. DUBUGRAS, Elsie; “O Ataque Invisível das Forças Psíquicas”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine;

Monthly; N. 125; February, 1983; illus.; pp. 49-54.

424. DUBUGRAS, Elsie; “Bons e Maus Contatos com Seres de Outra Dimensão”; Planeta; S. Paulo;

Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 120; September, 1982; illus.; pp. 106-112.

425. DUBUGRAS, Elsie; “O Desdobramento”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 48;

September, 1976; pp. 6-17.

426. DUBUGRAS, Elsie; “O Desdobramento Versus Autoscopia”; Revista Internacional do Espiritismo;

Matão, SP; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. LIV; N. 12; January, 1980; pp. 369, 370. 427. DUBUGRAS, Elsie; “O Juiz Estava Vivo em Pernambuco mas Apareceu “Materializado” na Suíça”;

Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 77; February, 1979; illus.;

pp. 59-61.

428. DUBUGRAS, Elsie; “As Várias Maneiras de Viajar Fora do Corpo”; Planeta;

S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 66; March, 1978; illus.; pp. 60-63.

429. DUBUGRAS, Elsie, and ARAIA, Eduardo; “A Segura Expansão das Ciências do Paranormal”;

Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 120; September, 1982; illus.; pp. 41-54.

430. DUCHATEL, Ed., et WARCOLLIER, R.; “Les Miracles de la Volonté”; pref. Émile Boirac; 244 pp.;

21.5 cm; hb.; Hector et Henri Durville, Éditeurs; Paris; no date; pp. 112-124.

431. DUMAS, André; “Le Corps Subtil et ses Problèmes”; Renaître 2000; Paris; Magazine; Bimonthly;

124th Yr.; New series; N. 25; November-December, 1981; pp. 197-202.

432. DUMAS, André; “La Science de L’Ame”; pref. Léon Périn; 434 pp.; glos. 9, 10; bibl. 415-430; 18 cm;

Éditions Ocia; Paris; 1947; pp. 212-230; eds.: Fr., It.

433. DU POTET, Jules Denis Sennevoy; “Traité Complet de Magnétisme Animal”; VIII + 632 pp.; 21.5

cm; hb.; 8th ed.; Librairie Félix Alcan; Paris; 1930; pp. 549-562.

434. DUPOUY, Edmond; “Sciences Occultes et Physiologie Psychique”; VIII + 312 pp.; illus.; 17.5 cm;

hb.; Société D’Éditions Scientifiques; Paris; 1898; pp. 79, 93, 127-129, 140-150. 435. DURVILLE, Hector; “Desdobramento do Corpo Humano ou Exteriorização do Duplo”; Estudos

Psíquicos; Lisboa; Portugal; Magazine; Monthly; N. 8; January, 1908; pp. 150, 169, 192, 210, 230.

436. DURVILLE, Hector; “Le Fantôme des Vivants: Anatomie et Physiologie de L’Ame”; 356 pp.; illus.;

18 cm; hb.; Librairie du Magnetisme; Paris; Mai, 1909; pp. 1-356 (Mini-library).

437. DURVILLE, Hector; “Magnétisme Personnel”; 314 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; Hector & Henri Durville,

Éditeur; Paris; 1912; pp. 39-61; eds.: Fr., Port.

438. DURVILLE, Hector; “New Experiments With Phantoms of the Living”; Annals of Psychical Science;

Vol. 7; 1908; pp. 464-470.

439. DURVILLE, Hector; “Pour Dédoubler le Corps Humain”; Henri Durville, Imprimeur-Éditeur; Paris;

1922.

440. DURVILLE, Hector; “Télépathie Télépsychie”; 250 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Henri Durville,

Imprimeur-Éditeur; Paris; 1919; pp. 103-109.

441. DURVILLE, Hector, et JAGOT, Paul C.; “Histoire Raisonnée du Magnétisme et du Psychisme

Pratique”; 488 pp.; illus.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Hector et Henri Durville, Éditeurs; Paris; 1914; pp. 22, 23.

442. DURVILLE, Henri; “Los Misterios Iniciaticos”; 184 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editorial Orion; Mexico,

D.F.; 1979; pp. 134-137.

443. DUSEN, Wilson Van; “Caminhos do Mundo Interior”; transl. Cesar Tozzi; 222 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 215-217.

444. DYCHTWALD, Ken; “Corpomente”; transl. Maria Sílvia Mourão Neto; pres. Anna Veronica

Mautner; 280 pp.; illus.; bibl. 267-278; 21 cm; pb.; Summus Editorial; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1984;

pp. 233, 249-254.

445. EAGLE, White; “Spiritual Unfoldment”; 144 pp.; alph.; 19 cm; hb.; dj.; The White Eagle Publishing

Trust; London; April, 1978; p. 41.

446. EASLIC, Hassie Annelle; “Extra Sensory Perception: What Does it Signify?”; 72 pp.; 20.5 cm; hb.;

dj.; Vantage Press; New York; 1973; pp. 39, 40.

447. EAST, John N. (Pseud.); “Man the Immortal”; introd. W. Y. Evans-Wentz; pref. Geraldine Cummins;

232 pp.; bibl. 231; The Psychic Press; London; 1960.

448. EAST, John N. (Pseud.); “The Mystical Life” (J. H. M. Whiteman); Books Reviews; Journal of the

Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 41; N. 708; June, 1961;

pp. 83, 84.

Page 19: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

449. EASTMAN, Margaret; “Astral Projection: A Record of Out-of-the-Body Experiences” (Oliver Fox);

Books Reviews; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 42; N. 717; September,

1963; pp. 138-140.

450. EASTMAN, Margaret; “Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; Proceedings of the Society for Psychical

Research; Vol. 53; Part 193; December, 1962; pp. 287-309.

451. EASTON, Stewart C.; “Man and World in the Light of Anthroposophy”; VIII

+ 536 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; 2nd ed. rev.; The Anthroposophic Press; New York; 1982; pp. 145, 146.

452. EBEID, Raouf; “Fenômenos da Saída do Corpo”; Original Árabe; Private Translation; 222 pp.; illus.; bibl. 210-217; 21 cm; pb.; Dar El-Fekr El-Arabi; Cairo; Egypt; 1975;

pp. 1-222; ed. only Arab.

453. EBON, Martin; “The Evidence for Life After Death”; 178 pp.; bibl. 175, 176; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; New

American Library; New York; August, 1977; pp. 1, 4, 12, 24-36, 44, 45, 50, 66, 71-76, 86-94, 97, 100,

110-138, 168, 169, 173; eds.: Eng., Port.

454. EBON, Martin; Editor; “Fenomenos Parapsicológicos: Misticismo y Reencarnación”; transl. Maria E.

I. de Fischman; 192 pp.; 17.5 cm; pocket; pb.; Ediciones Hormé; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977; pp.

104-108.

455. EBON, Martin; “Miracles”; 8 + 200 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; New American Library; New York;

December, 1981; pp. 111-114, 175, 182, 183.

456. EBON, Martin; “Psychic Warfare: Threat or Illusion?”; 6 + 282 pp.; bibl. 262-272; alph.; 23 cm; hb.;

dj.; Mc Graw-Hill Book Co.; New York; 1983; pp. 16, 17.

457. EBON, Martin; “The Signet Handbook of Parapsychology”; 520 pp.; illus.; glos. 509-512; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Signet Book; New York; 1978; pp. 173-200, 466-482.

458. EBON, Martin; “They Knew the Unknown”; 256 pp.; bibl. 249-251; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Signet

Book; New York; September, 1972; pp. 22, 23, 41-43, 105, 106, 192, 200; eds.: Eng., Port.

459. EDGE, Hoyt L.; “Rejointer to Dr. Wheatley’s Note On “Do Spirits Matter?”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 70; N. 4; October, 1976; 402-407.

460. EDMONDS, I. G.; “D. D. Home: O Homem que Falava com Espíritos”; transl. Nair Lacerda; 130 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 129; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1983; pp. 30-32.

461. EDMUNDS, H. Tudor; Editor; “Psychism and the Unconscious Mind”; XVI + 254 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

2nd ed.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1974; p. 40.

462. EDSALL, F. S.; “O Mundo dos Fenômenos Psíquicos”; transl. and pref. J. Gervásio de Figueiredo;

212 pp.; glos. 209-212; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 90, 93, 205,

206.

463. EDWARDS, Frank; “Strange World”; XVI + 238 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 7th print.; Bantam Books;

New York; no date; pp. 108-113, 165-168.

464. EDWARDS, Frank; “Stranger Than Science”; X + 182 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Bantam Books; New

York; June, 1967; pp. 144-146.

465. EDWARDS, Frank; “Strangest of All”; 176 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; New American Library; New

York; May, 1974; pp. 99-101.

466. EEDEN, Frederick van; “A Study of Dreams”; Proceedings of the Society for Psychical Research;

London; Vol. 26; 1913; pp. 431-461.

467. EGLOFFSTEIN, P. P. F. V.; “Ein Bilokationserlebnis von Seltener Klarheit”; Die Andere Welt; Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 19; N. 11; November, 1968; pp. 1018-1020.

468. EGLOFFSTEIN, P. P. F. V.; “Im Lande des Grossen Glücks”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 23; N. 9; September, 1972; pp. 815-818.

469. EGLOFFSTEIN, P. P. F. V.; “Unterricht in Bilokation?”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 23; N. 12; December, 1972; illus.; pp. 1103-1106.

470. EHRENWALD, Jan; “Correspondence: Dr. Ehrenwald Explains”; Parapsychology Review; New

York; Vol. 12; N. 6; November-December, 1981; pp. 26, 27.

471. EHRENWALD, Jan; “The ESP Experience: A Psychiatric Validation”; XII + 308 pp.; illus.; bibl. 289-

298; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Basic Books, Publishers; New York; 1978; pp. 76, 151-161, 190, 233-

236; eds.: Eng., Fr.

472. EHRENWALD, Jan; “Out-of-the Body Experiences and the Denial of Death”; The Journal of Nervous

and Mental Disease; Baltimore; Maryland; U. S. A.; Vol. 159; N. 4; Serial N. 1103; October, 1974;

bibl. 233; pp. 227-233.

Page 20: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

473. EISENBUD, Jule; “The World of Ted Serios”; 368 pp.; illus.; bibl. 348-357; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.;

William Morrow & Co.; New York; 1967; pp. 231, 232, 235; eds.: Eng., Ger.

474. EL-AOWAR, Mahab; “Parapsicanálise: Uma Teoria da Paranormalidade”; 198 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

Edições Achiamé; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 6, 97-101, 183, 184.

475. ELIADE, Mircea; “El Chamanismo y las Técnicas Arcaicas del Éxtasis”; transl. Ernestina de

Champourcin; 484 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Fondo de Cultura Económica; Mexico,

D. F.; 1976; pp. 117-120, 240, 279, 281.

476. ELIADE, Mircea; “The Two and the One”; transl. J. M. Cohen; 224 pp.; alph.; 20.5 cm; pb.; The University of Chicago Press; Chicago; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1979; pp. 66-75, 183, 184.

477. ELIADE, Mircea; “Yoga Inmortalidad y Libertad”; transl. Susana de Aldecoa; 412 pp.; 20 cm; pb.;

Editorial La Pleyade; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977; pp. 65, 66, 98.

478. ELLISON, Arthur J.; “Some Recent Experiments in Psychic Perceptivity”; Journal of the Society for

Psychical Research; London; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 41; N. 713; September, 1962; pp. 355-365.

479. EMMONS, Charles F.; “Chinese Ghost and ESP”; 298 pp.; glos. 286-288; bibl. 277-285; alph.; hb.;

The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen; N. J.; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 44, 45, 47, 171, 267, 269, 270.

480. ENGEL, Herbert H. G.; “Der Sphärenwanderer”; 236 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Ansata-Verlag;

Interlaken; Schweiz; 1981; pp. 1-236 (Mini-library).

481. E. P.; “Mensagens Rosa-crucianas”; 296 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1978; pp. 288-295.

482. ERNEST, Victor H.; “Eu Falei com Espíritos”; transl. Luiz Aparecido Caruso; pres. John H. Houser;

76 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editora Mundo Cristão; S. Paulo; Brazil;1981; p. 15.

483. ERNY, Alfred; “O Psiquismo Experimental”; without translator; 228 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;1953; pp. 79-81, 91-101.

484. ESPASA-CALPE; Editors; “Enciclopedia Universal Ilustrada”; 106 (one hundred and six) Vol.; 24.5

cm; hb.; Espasa-Calpe; Madrid; Spain; 1920 / 1980; Tome XVIII: VIII + 1.456 pp.; p. 476. 485. ESPÉRANCE, Elisabeth d’ (Pseud. for Juliet Anne Theodore Heurtley Hart-Davies); “Shadow Land”;

introd. Alexander Nikolayevich Aksakof; XXII + 414 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; George Redway; London;

1897; pp. 355-367; eds.: Eng., Fr., Ger., Port.

486. ESTRELLA, Décio; “Nuvens Negras”; Tribuna Umbandista; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Yr.

XXVII; N. 307 / 313; January-July, 1981; pp. 1, 3.

487. EUSTÁQUIO, Centro Espírita Irmão; Directors; “Curso de Conscientização Mediúnica”; 256 pp.; 3

Installments; illus.; bibl. 173, 174; 31 cm; pb.; Centro Espírita Irmão Eustáquio; Salvador, BA; Brazil;

1983; pp. 82-84.

488. EUSTÁQUIO, Centro Espírita Irmão; Directors; “Espiritismo: Visão Integrada da Vida”; 96 pp.; 22

cm; pb.; Centro Espírita Irmão Eustáquio; Salvador, BA; Brazil; 1982; pp. 66, 67, 70.

489. EUSTÁQUIO, Centro Espírita Irmão; Directors; “Quem Somos”; pref. Edson Nunes da Silva; pres.

Regina Braga Moreira Caldas; 98 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Centro Espírita Irmão Eustáquio; Salvador,

BA; Brazil; 1976; pp. 14, 15, 51, 52.

490. EVANS, W. H.; “O Misterioso Mundo dos Sonhos”; Estudos Psíquicos; Lisboa; Portugal; Magazine;

Monthly; 25th Yr.; N. 3; March, 1964; pp. 90-92.

491. EVANS-WENTZ, Walter Y.; “Yoga Tibetano y Doctrinas Secretas”; transl. Hector V. Morel; pref. R.

R. Marett; 408 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1980; pp. 293, 294.

492. EVIN, Simone; “A Comunhão dos Santos”; transl. Izidoro Duarte Santos; Estudos Psíquicos; Lisboa;

Portugal; Magazine; Monthly; 31st Yr.; N. 11; November, 1970; pp. 322, 323.

493. EYSENCK, Hans Jürgen, and SARGENT, Carl; “Explaining the Unexplained: Mysteries of the

Paranormal”; 192pp.; illus.; bibl. 188, 189; alph.; 25 cm; hb.; dj.; Weindenfeld and Nicolson; London;

1982; pp. 155-162.

494. FARDWEL, Willian; “La Supervivencia”; 238 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Rafael Caro Raggio, Editor; Madrid;

Spain; August, 1929; pp. 15-70.

495. FARIA, Osmar Andrade; “Parapsicologia: Panorama Atual das Funções Psi”; pref. Hernani Guimarães

Andrade; 376 pp.; illus.; bibl. 345-357; 22.5 cm; pb.; Livraria Atheneu; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981;

pp. 76-78, 290, 322, 323.

496. FARRAR, Stewart; “Lo Que Hacen las Brujas”; 222 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Ediciones Martínez

Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1977; pp. 190-199.

Page 21: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

497. FARRÈRE, Claude; “L’Autre Côté... Contes Insolites”; 248 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Ernest Flammarion,

Éditeur; Paris; 1928; pp. 26-30, 36, 37, 47.

498. FARTHING, Geoffrey; “Exploring the Great Beyond: A Survey of the Field of the Extraordinary”; XII

+ 214 pp.; glos. 208-214; bibl. 203-207; 21 cm; pb.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton,

Ill.; U. S. A.; 1978; pp. 157-159, 212.

499. FASE; Editors; “Século XX: Ciência e Futurologia”; 308 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Editora Fase; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; 1982; pp. 231-234.

500. FAVRE, François; Anthology; “Les Apparitions Mysterieuses”; 318 pp.; illus.; bibl. 316-318; 24 cm; pb.; Claude Tchou; Paris; Novembre, 1978; pp. 18-27.

501. FEDERACION Espiritista Internacional; “Libro Resumen del V Congresso Espiritista Internacional”;

384 pp.; illus.; 24 cm; hb.; Tipografia Cosmos; Barcelona; Spain; Septiembre, 1934; p. 322.

502. FEDERMANN, R., and SCHREIBER, H.; “Testemunhos do Ocultismo”; transl. Attilio Cancian; 286

pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora e Distribuidora Líder; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 18, 19, 244, 245.

503. FEESP; Editor; “Pontos da Escola de Médiuns: Ensino Teórico”; pref. Edgard Armond; Tome III; 116

pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 6th ed.; Edição Feesp; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1972; pp. 114, 115.

504. FEITOSA, Fenelon Alves; “Naná, os Espíritos e seus Fenômenos”; 260 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Jocal;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981; pp. 150-153, 168, 169.

505. FENWICK, Agnes M.; “My Journey Into God’s Realm of Light”; Exposition Press; New York; 1974;

64 pp.

506. FEOLA, José; “PK: Mind Over Matter”; introd. Mulford Quickert Sibley; 176 pp.; illus.; glos. 163-

167; bibl. 169-171; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Dillon Press; Minneapolis; Minnesota;

U. S. A.; 1975; pp. 59,163.

507. FERGUSON, John; “Encyclopaedia of Mysticism and the Mystery Religious”; 228 pp.; illus.; bibl.

217-227; 24 cm; pb.; Thames and Hudson; London; 1976; p. 28.

508. FERNANDES, Diamantino Coelho; “As Forças do Bem”; 188 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; 7th ed.; Livraria Freitas Bastos; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1982; pp. 82, 83, 108, 109, 117, 118, 121, 145,

146, 152, 167.

509. FERREIRA, Mário; “Espiritismo Revelação Centenária, Parapsicologia Ciência Moderna”; pref.

Francisco Carlos de Castro Neves; pres. Eurípedes de Castro; 140 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editora

Bels; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil; 1976; pp. 49, 51.

510. FESENMEYER; “Bordeland: Life Between Life and Death”; 132 pp.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; Regency Press;

London; 1967; pp. 48-60.

511. FEUERSTEIN, Georg; “The Essence of Yoga; A Contribution to the Psychohistory of Indian

Civilization”; pref. Algis Mickunas; 224 pp.; illus.; bibl. 215-219; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Rider and Co.;

London; 1974; p. 126.

512. FERGUSON, Robert A.; “Telemetria Psíquica”; transl. Maria Lucia Sarquis Aiex; 222 pp.; illus.; 21

cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 166-182.

513. FIELDING-OULD, Fielding; “The Wonders of the Saints in the Light of Spiritualism”; introd. Lady

Gleuconner; 128 pp.; 19 cm; J. M. Watkins; London; 1919.

514. FIGANIÉRE, Frederico Francisco Stuart de – Mourão; “Submundo, Mundo e Supramundo”; introd.

Edmundo Cardillo; 298 pp.; illus.; glos. 17-21; 20.5 cm; hb.; Editora Três;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1973; pp. 235-238, 242. 515. FIGUIER, Louis; “Depois da Morte”; transl. Ferreira de Araújo; 384 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm; hb.; H.

Garnier, Livreiro-Editor; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1902; pp. 136, 137.

516. FINOTTI, Paulo; “Ressurreição”; prol. Mário Ferreira; 132 pp.; bibl. 129-131; 20.5 cm; pb.; Gráfica e

Editora Edigraf; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1972; pp. 83, 84, 105, 106.

517. FIORE, Charles, and LANDSBURG, Allan; “Death Encounters”; 200 pp.; bibl. 195-197; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Bantam Books; New York; July, 1979; pp. 5, 7, 19-22, 27-30,

35-57, 94, 100, 159-170, 188.

518. FIORE, Edith; “Já Vivemos Antes”; transl. Maria Luísa Ferreira da Costa; 226 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

Publicações Europa-América; Lisboa; Portugal; no date; pp. 205, 208, 215; eds.: Eng., Fr., Port.

519. FISCHER, Reinhard; “Raumfahrt der Seele: Erlebnisse im Umkreis der Mentalprojektion”; 270 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 270; 19.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Verlag Hermann Bauer; Freiburg; West Germany; 1975; pp. 19-200

(Mini-library).

520. FISICHELLA, Anthoni J.; “Metapsychics: the Science of Life”; introd. Brad Steiger; XXX + 284 pp.;

illus.; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Llewellyn Publications; St. Paul, Minnesota; U. S. A.; 1984; pp. 14, 42, 218.

Page 22: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

521. FITTIPALDI, Bártolo; Editor; “Quando será Conhecida a Verdade Sobre o Sonho?”; Enigmas da

Humanidade; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; N. 3; 1984; pp. 51-56.

522. FLAMMARION, Camille; “O Desconhecido e os Problemas Psíquicos”; transl. Arnaldo São Thiago; 2

vol.; 520 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; Vol. I:

pp. 90-93, 96, 107-199; Vol. II: pp. 159-203, 272; eds.: Fr., It., Port.

523. FLAMMARION, Camille; “Estela”; Novel; transl. Almerindo Martins de Castro; 332 pp.; 18 cm; hb.;

Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1950; pp. 60, 61, 202-205, 266.

524. FLAMMARION, Camille; “A Morte e o Seu Mistério”; without translator; 3 Vol.; 1.048 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1982; Vol. I: pp. 80-85, 124, 125,

232, 233; Vol. II: pp. 38-88, 110-152; Vol. III: pp. 117-125, 131; eds.: Fr., It., Port.

525. FLAMMARION, Camille; “Urânia”; Novel; transl. Almerindo Martins de Castro; 198 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

4th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; pp. 113-120.

526. FODOR, Nandor; “Algumas Incógnitas da Vida”; without translator; Estudos Psíquicos; Lisboa;

Portugal; Magazine; Monthly; 23rd Yr.; N. 3; March, 1962; pp. 66-70.

527. FODOR, Nandor; “Between Two Worlds”; XIV + 298 pp.; bibl. 127-129; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Parker

Publishing Co.; West Nyack, N. Y.; U. S. A.; 1964; pp. 116-119, 170-172.

528. FODOR, Nandor; “Encyclopaedia of Psychic Science”; pref. Oliver Lodge; introd. Leslie A. Shepard;

XL + 416 pp.; 25 cm; hb.; dj.; 3rd print.; University Books; New York; November, 1969; pp. 100-105.

529. FODOR, Nandor; “The Haunted Mind”; 314 pp.; alph.; 20 cm; hb.; dj.; Helix Press; New York; 1959;

pp. 173-185.

530. FODOR, Nandor; “Mind Over Space”; 222 pp.; 20.5 cm; hb.; dj.; The Citadel Press; New York; 1962;

pp. 28, 74-76.

531. FODOR, Nandor; “New Approaches to Dream Interpretation”; XVI + 368 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.;

University Books; New York; 1951; pp. 184-187.

532. FOIN, Raoul; “Les Mystères qui nos Entourent”; 180 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Omnium Littéraire; Paris; 1967; pp. 119-148.

533. FONTAINE, Pierre; “La Magie Chez les Noirs”; pref. Fernand Divoire; 178 pp.; illus.; bibl. 175; 21

cm; pb.; Éditions Dervy; Paris; Juin, 1949; pp. 71-79.

534. FONTCUBERTA, Antonio Blay; “Relajación y Energía”; 296 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

2nd ed.; Elicien; Barcelona; Spain; 1976; pp. 173-182.

535. FORD, Arthur; “Bericht vom Leben nach dem Tode”; without translator; 304 pp.; index of names;

21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Scherz; München; West Germany; 1972; pp. 220, 221, 292.

536. FORD, Arthur; “Nothing so Strange”; Autobiography; with Margueritte Harmon Bro; 250 pp.; alph.;

21 cm; Harper & Row Publishers; New York; 1958; pp. 159-162.

537. FORD, Arthur; “Unknown but Known”; 176 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; The New American

Library; New York; November, 1969; pp. 52-56.

538. FORMAN, Joan; “The Mask of Time”; 256 pp.; illus.; glos. 254.; bibl. 252-254; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.;

dj.; 2nd print.; MacDonald and Jane’s Publishers; London; 1979; pp. 154, 155, 213, 236, 241, 254.

539. FORMIGA, Eurícledes, and MONTEIRO, Eduardo Carvalho; “Motoqueiros no Além”; 150 pp.; illus.;

glos. 148, 149; 18.5 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Instituto de Difusão Espírita; Araras, SP; Brazil; September,

1983; pp. 49, 51, 52.

540. FORTUNE, Dion (Pseud. for Violet M. Firth); “Psychic Self-Defense”; 210 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; 17th print.; The Aquarian Press; London; 1977; pp. 13, 28, 36-40, 42, 48-53, 58, 63-65, 98-100, 145, 148,

154-156, 160, 164, 208; eds.: Eng., Sp.

541. FORTUNE, Dion (Pseud. for Violet M. Firth); “The Training and Work of an Initiate”; 126 pp.; 21.5

cm; pb.; 2nd print.; The Aquarian Press; London; 1981; pp. 80, 105, 106, 126; eds.: Eng., Sp.

542. FOSTER, Gloria M.; “Traum, Hellsehen oder Astralwanderung?”; transl. E. M. Körner; Esotera;

Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 24; N. 1; January, 1973; p. 71.

543. FOX, Oliver (Pseud. for Hugh G. Callaway); “The Pineal Doorway: A Record of Research”; Occult

Review; London; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 31; N. 4; April, 1920.

544. FOX, Oliver (Pseud. for Hugh G. Callaway); “Astral Projection: A Record of Out-of-the-Body

Experiences”; pref. John C. Wilson; 160 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; The Citadel Press; Secaucus, N. J.;

U. S. A.; 1962; pp. 1-160 (Mini-library).

545. FRANCO, Divaldo Pereira; “Nas Fronteiras da Loucura”; 252 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Livraria

Espírita Alvorada Editora; Salvador, BA; Brazil; 1984; pp. 12, 36-39, 41, 45-49, 54, 70, 71, 100, 101,

Page 23: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

108, 109, 122, 131-133, 142-148, 178, 179, 187, 191-194, 196-201, 203,

208-211, 216-222, 240, 241.

546. FRANCO, Divaldo Pereira; “Nos Bastidores da Obsessão”; 282 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

2nd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1976; pp. 11, 25, 31, 35, 63-65, 76, 105,

110, 120, 130, 133, 135, 136, 139, 273.

547. FRANCO, Divaldo Pereira; “Painéis da Obsessão”; 270 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Livraria Espírita

Alvorada Editora; Salvador, BA; Brazil; 1984; pp. 28, 40, 41, 44, 60, 67, 91, 105, 208, 229, 246.

548. FRANKLIN, Robert M.; “On the Acronym “OBE”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 69; N. 1; January, 1975; pp. 97, 98.

549. FRAZER, Felix J.; “Parallel Paths to the Unseen Worlds”; introd. Ann Davies; 382 pp.; illus.; 23 cm;

pb.; Builders of the Adytum; Los Angeles, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1967; pp. 43-46, 155-160, 369.

550. FREEDLAND, Nat; “The Occult Explosion”; 270 pp.; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.;

2nd print.; G. P. Putnam’s Sons; New York; 1972; pp. 63, 100-102.

551. FREIRE, António J.; “Da Alma Humana”; 320 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; illus.; Federação Espírita Portuguesa;

Lisboa; Portugal; 1950; pp. 150-176, 285-302.

552. FREITAS, Alberto de; “Viagem ao Invisível”; Informação; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr.

VI; N. 65; April, 1982; pp. 20-24.

553. FREIXEDO, Salvador; “Curanderismo y Curaciones por la Fe”; 190 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; pb.; Ediciones

Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1983; pp. 48, 49, 114.

554. FREIXEDO, Salvador; “El Diabolico Inconsciente: Parapsicologia y Religión”; with Alfonso Martínez

Taboas; 388 pp.; illus.; bibl. 381-385; 20.5 cm; pb.; 5th ed.; Editorial Orion; Mexico, D. F.; January,

1977; pp. 49-53.

555. FREIXEDO, Salvador; “Extraterrestres y Creencias Religiosas”; 200 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Editorial Orion; Mexico, D. F.; 1977; pp. 88, 95.

556. FREIXEDO, Salvador; “La Religión entre la Parapsicologia y los Ovnis”; 272 pp.; illus.; bibl. 265-267; 21.5 cm; pb.; Editorial Orion; Mexico, D. F.; 1978; p. 44.

557. FRICHET, Henry; “Les Forces Mystérieuses”; 282 pp.; 17 cm; hb.; Librairie Astra; Paris; no date; pp.

130-135, 142-148, 242, 243.

558. FRICHET, Henry; “L’Homme et ses Pouvoirs Secrets”; 244 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Librairie Astra; Paris;

1945; pp. 43, 179, 180.

559. FRISEN, Roy M.; “Astral Journeys”; Fate; Evanston; Ill.; U. S. A.; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 6; N. 11;

November, 1953; pp. 16-23.

560. FROST, Gavin, and FROST, Yvonne; “Astral Travel”; 240 pp.; illus.; bibl. 239, 240; 18 cm; pocket;

pb.; Granada Publishing; London; 1982; pp. 1-240 (Mini-library).

561. FRUNGILO JÚNIOR, Wilson; “Do Outro Lado”; Novel; 156 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Instituto de

Difusão Espírita; Araras, SP; Brazil; January, 1984; pp. 49, 84-92, 99-102, 118, 142-153.

562. FUGAIRON, L. S.; “La Survivance de L’Ame: La Mort et la Renaissance chez les Êtres Vivants”; 276

pp.; illus.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Librairie du Magnétisme; Paris; 1907; pp. 114-127, 131-137, 153-155, 166,

167.

563. FUNK, Isaac Kaufman; “The Psychic Riddle”; 244 pp.; alph.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Funk

& Wagnalls Co.; New York; 1947; pp. 179, 180.

564. GABBARD, Glen O.; TWEMLOW, Stuart W.; and JONES, Fowler C.; “Do Near Death Experiences Occur Only Near Death?”; The Journal of Nervous and Mental Disease; Baltimore, Maryland; U. S.

A.; Vol. 169; N. 6; 1981; bibl. 377; pp. 374-377.

565. GALEAZZI, Marlene Anna; “Tia Neiva: A Médium que Salvou a Si Mesma da Morte”; Manchete;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Magazine; Weekly; Yr. 31; N. 1.601; 25, December, 1982; illus.; pp. 126-129.

566. GALLUP JR., George; with William Proctor; “Adventures in Immortality”; 214 pp.; alph.; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Corgi Books; London; 1984; pp. 12, 13, 17, 22, 30, 35, 36-40, 46, 68, 99, 100, 133, 139,

146, 160, 161.

567. GARDNER, Martin; “Science Good, Bad and Bogus”; XVIII + 412 pp.; illus.; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.;

Prometheus Books; Buffalo, N. Y.; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 96, 98, 144, 145, 302, 303, 378.

568. GARFIELD, Patricia L.; “Creative Dreaming”; 244 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.;

7th print.; Ballantine Books; New York; January, 1981; pp. 118-150, 221, 222; eds.: Eng., Port.

569. GARFIELD, Patricia L.; “Pathway to Ecstasy”; Autobiography; XVI + 254 pp.; illus.; bibl. 241-246;

alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Holt, Rinehart & Winston; New York; 1979; pp. 13, 36, 72-77, 95, 113-128,

141-150.

Page 24: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

570. GARRETT, Eileen Jeannette Vancho Little; “Awareness”; XVIII + 308 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; 4th

print.; Creative Age Press; New York; 1945; pp. 278-282.

571. GARRETT, Eileen Jeannette Vancho Little; “Beyond the Five Senses”; Anthology; 384 pp.; glos. 383-

384; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; J. B. Lippincott Co.; New York; 1957; pp. 42-58.

572. GARRETT, Eileen Jeannette Vancho Little; “Many Voices: The Autobiography of a Medium”; introd.

Allan Angoff; 252 pp.; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; G. P. Putnam’s Sons; New York; 1968; pp. 189, 190,

193-195, 197, 198; eds.: Eng., Port.

573. GARRETT, Eileen Jeannette Vancho Little; “My Lyfe as a Search for the Meaning of Mediumship”; Autobiography; 226 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Rider & Co.; London; 1939; pp. 156-161, 203-205.

574. GARRETT, Eileen Jeannette Vancho Little; “Telepathy”; introd. Eugene Rollin Corson; XXX + 210

pp.; bibl. 209, 210; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Creative Age Press; New York; 1945;

pp. 67-90.

575. GAULD, Alan; “The Founders of Psychical Research”; XII + 388 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Schocken Books; New York; 1968; pp. 162-164, 169, 170, 182.

576. GAULD, Alan; “Mediumship and Survival: A Century of Investigations”; pref. Brian Inglis; XIV +

288 pp.; illus.; bibl. 268-282; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; William Heinemann; London; 1982; pp. 215-230,

250-253, 265.

577. GAYNOR, Frank; “Dictionary of Mysticism”; 210 pp.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Philosophical Library; New

York; 1953; pp. 19, 26.

578. GEDDES, Auckland; “A Voice from the Grandstand”; The Edinburg Medical Journal; Great Britain;

Vol. XLIV; N. VI; June, 1937; pp. 365-384.

579. GEISLER, H.; “Sind Astralwanderungen Wirklich so Gefährlich?”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 24; N. 7; July, 1973; p. 578.

580. GELEY, Gustave; “De L’Inconscient au Conscient”; XIV + 346 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Librairie Félix

Alcan; Paris; 1921; pp. 142, 273, 274; eds.: Fr., Eng., Sp., Port. 581. GELEY, Gustave; “Les Preuves du Transformisme”; 288 pp.; illus.; bibl. 5, 6; 21.5 cm; hb.; Félix

Alcan, Éditeur; Paris; 1901; pp. 270, 271.

582. GELEY, Gustave; “O Ser Subconsciente”; transl. and introd. Gilberto Campista Guarino; 230 pp.; 18

cm; pb.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1975; pp. 91-94, 167; eds.: Fr., Sp., Port.

583. GELEY, Gustave; “Resumo da Doutrina Espírita”; transl. and introd. Isidoro Duarte Santos; pref. Jean

Meyer; 194 pp.; glos. 171-189; 22 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Livraria Allan Kardec Editora; S. Paulo; Brazil;

1975; pp. 31, 32, 66, 67, 76-78, 172.

584. GERHARDI, William; “Resurrection”; Novel; Cassell & Co.; London; 1934.

585. GERTZ, John; “Hypnagogic Fantasy, EEG, and Psi Perfomance in a Single Subjet”; The Journal of

American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 77; N. 2; April, 1983; bibl. 167-170; pp.

155-170.

586. GEYMULLER, Henry de; “Swedenborg et les Phénomènes Psychiques”; 462 pp.; bibl. 442-453; 22.5

cm; hb.; Librairie Ernest Leroux; Paris; no date; pp. 412-415.

587. GIBIER, Paul; “Análise das Cousas”; transl. and pref. T.; 234 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.;

2nd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1934; pp. 105, 113-115, 117, 123-130.

588. GIBSON, Litzka R., and GIBSON, W. B.; “The Mystic and Occult Arts: A Guide to their Use in Daily

Living”; 224 pp.; Parker Publishing Co.; West Nyack; N. Y.; U. S. A.; 1969. 589. GILBERT, Alice; “Philip in the Spheres”; Aquarian Press; London; 1952; pp. 17, 56, 101.

590. GILBERT, Alice; “Philip in Two Worlds”; pref. L. A. G. Strong; 242 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Andrew

Dakers; London; 1948; pp. 94, 113, 126-139.

591. GILDEA, William; “Nem Céu, Nem Inferno: Uma Luz Depois da Morte”;

O Globo; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Newspaper; Daily; Yr. LII; N. 15.968; 30, June, 1977; illus.; p. 43.

592. GIOVETTI, Paola; “Qualcuno é Tornato”; pref. Emilio Servadio; 176 pp.; bibl. 174; 20 cm; pb.;

Armenia Editore; Milano; Italy; 1981; pp. 8, 24, 43-58, 68.

593. GIOVETTI, Paola; “Viaggi Senza Corpo”; 160 pp.; bibl. 155, 156; 20 cm; pb.; Armenia Editore;

Milano; Italy; 1983; pp. 1-160 (Mini-library).

594. GIOVETTI, Paola; “Le Visioni dei Morenti”; Luce e Ombra; Verona; Italy; Magazine; Quarterly; Yr.

80; N. 4; October-December, 1980; pp. 319-331.

595. GIROLAMO, Nancy Puhlmann Di; “O Castelo das Aves Feridas”; 100 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Instituição

Beneficente Nosso Lar; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 13-98.

Page 25: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

596. GLASKIN, Gerald M.; “A Door to Eternity: Proving the Christos Experience”; 184 pp.; illus.; bibl.

182, 183; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Wildwood House; Bookwise; Australia; 1979;

pp. 166-170.

597. GLASKIN, Gerald M.; “Mergulho Numa Vida Passada”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine;

Monthly; N. 59; August, 1977; illus.; pp. 20-24.

598. GLASKIN, Gerald M.; “Windows of the Mind: The Christos Experiment”; 208 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Wildwood House, London; 1974; pp. 11-18, 27-35, 177, 201.

599. GLASKIN, Gerald M.; “Worlds Within: Probing the Christos Experience”; 224 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Wildwood House; London; 1976; pp. 214-223.

600. GLOBO, O; Editorial; “Americano Conta que Morreu e Gostou”; O Globo; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

Newspaper; Daily; Yr. LIX; N. 18.171; 5, August, 1983; p.14.

601. GLOBO, O; Editorial; Apla; “A Enfermeira Morta Durante Duas Horas”;

O Globo; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Newspaper; Daily; Yr. XXXVII; N. 10.890; 31, October, 1961; pp. 1,

2.

602. GLOBO, O; Editorial; “Normal e Paranormal: Onde Está a Realidade?”;

O Globo; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Newspaper; Daily; Yr. LIII; N. 16.063; 3, October, 1977; p. 17.

603. GLOBO, O; Editorial; World Report; “Na Volta da Fronteira da Morte, Nova Visão da Vida”; O

Globo; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Newspaper; Daily; Yr. LIX; N. 18.484; 17, June, 1984; illus.; p. 29.

604. GODWIN, John; “Occult America”; XII + 314 pp.; illus.; glos. 291-294; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; Doubleday

and Co.; Garden City, N. Y.; U. S. A.; 1972; pp. 20, 112-120, 128, 194, 195.

605. GOES, Eurico de; “Prodígios da Biopsíquica Obtidos com o Médium Mirabelli”; 472 pp.; illus.; bibl.

429-466; 18 cm; hb.; Tipografia Cupolo; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1937; pp. 21, 25, 50, 91-93, 137, 142, 392-

411, 440.

606. GOLDBERG, Bruce; “Past Lives Future Lives”; VI + 186 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Newcastle Publishing

Co.; North Hollywood, Cal.; U. S. A.; June, 1982; p, 24, 65, 172. 607. GOLDSTEIN, Karl W. (Pseud. for Hernani Guimarães Andrade); “A Gente Morre... E Depois?

Existiria um Suporte Estrutural para o Modelo Organizador Biológico?”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo;

Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. VIII; N. 89; August, 1981; illus.; pp. 4, 5 (See N. 27-30).

608. GOLDSTEIN, Karl W. (Pseud. for Hernani Guimarães Andrade); “Como Age Você Fora do Corpo

Durante o Sono”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. V; N. 54; September,

1978; illus.; p. 5.

609. GOLDSTEIN, Karl W. (Pseud. for Hernani Guimarães Andrade); “Desdobramento Astral no

Laboratório”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. V; N. 56; November, 1978;

illus.; p. 5.

610. GOLDSTEIN, Karl W. (Pseud. for Hernani Guimarães Andrade); “Enquanto Você Dorme Seu Corpo

Astral Pode Viajar Visitando Outros Mundos”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly;

Yr. V; N. 55; October, 1978; illus.; pp. 5, 7.

611. GOMES, Vera Braga de Souza; “Deus, o Universo e o Homem”; 146 pp.; illus.; bibl. 146; 21 cm; pb.;

Mudra; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1982; pp. 60, 65, 111, 123-125, 127.

612. GOMES, Vera Braga de Souza; “Intermediários do Além”; 228 pp.; illus.; bibl. 223; 20.5 cm; pb.;

Mudra; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 52-55, 57, 60, 72, 82-87, 113-118, 148, 171, 172.

613. GÓMEZ, Quintin López; “Glosario de Palavras Nuevas e Poco Comunes”; 178 pp.; 16 cm; hb.; José Ventayol Vilá; Tarrasa; Spain; 1926; pp. 22, 23.

614. GONÇALVES, Júlio César; “Eles Prometem Ensinar Você a Sair do Próprio Corpo”; Shopping News-

City News; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Yr. 18; N. 891; 10, October, 1982; illus.; pp. 1, 5.

615. GONZALES, Georges; “O que nos Espera Depois da Morte”; transl. and pref. Francisco Klörs

Werneck; 140 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Editora Eco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1969; pp. 35, 36.

616. GOOCH, Stan; “Creatures from Inner Space”; 252 pp.; bibl. 140-248; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Rider &

Co.; London, 1984; pp. 194, 205.

617. GOOCH, Stan; “The Paranormal”; VI + 314 pp.; illus.; glos. 298, 299; bibl. 300-306; alph.; 20.5 cm;

hb.; dj.; Harper & Row, Publishers; New York; 1978; pp. 23, 24, 93-95, 149, 237, 238.

618. GOODMAN, Jeffrey; “Arqueología Psíquica”; transl. Gonzalo Zaragoza; prol. Paul S. Martin; 224

pp.; bibl. 215-224; 20 cm; pb.; Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1981; pp. 200-204.

619. GRAHAM, Winifred; “I Introduce”; Autobiography; 228 pp.; ilus; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Skeffington

and Son; London; no date; p. 57.

Page 26: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

620. GRANGER, Michel; “L’Héritage des Extra-terrestres ou Panorama de la Médiumnité Moderne”; 256

pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Albin Michel; Paris; 1977; pp. 204, 205.

621. GRANJA, Pedro; “Afinal, Quem Somos? De Onde Viemos e Para Onde Vamos...”; pref. Monteiro

Lobato; 394 pp.; bibl. 9-12; 21.5 cm; pb.; 5th ed.; Editora Brasiliense;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1951; pp. 62, 224, 229, 249, 331-345, 348.

622. GRANJA, Pedro; “Os Simples e os Sábios”; 266 pp.; bibl. 5, 6; 21.5 cm; pb.; Edição Calvário; S.

Paulo; Brazil; 1971; pp. 225, 226.

623. GRANT-VEILLARD, Sim; “101 Respuestas Sobre los Poderes Sobrenaturales”; transl. Ricardo Vargas; 174 pp.; bibl. 165, 166; 19 cm; pb.; Sagitario Ediciones y Distribuciones; Barcelona; Spain;

February, 1976; pp. 117, 125-129.

624. GRASSET, J.; “L’Occultisme Hier et Aujourd’hui”; pref. M. Émile Faguet; 472 pp.; bibl. 445-461;

alph.; 19 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Coulet et Fils, Éditeurs; Montpellier; France; 1908;

pp. 258-260.

625. GRASSET, J.; “Le Spiritisme Devant la Science”; pref. Pierre Janet; XXX + 392 pp.; bibl. 377-390;

alph.; 19 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Masson & Cie., Éditeurs; Paris; 1904; pp. 83-96, 326.

626. GRATTAN-GUINNESS, Ivor; Editor; “Psychical Research: A Guide to its History, Principles and

Practices”; 424 pp.; illus.; glos. 387-399; index of names; bibl. 88, 89; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; The

Aquarian Press; Wellingborough, Northamptonshire; Great Britain; 1982; pp. 78-89, 110, 191, 297,

319, 326, 327, 351, 394, 399.

627. GRAVES, Tom, and HOULT, Janet; Editors; “The Essential T. C. Lethbridge”; introd. Colin Wilson;

XX + 216 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1980; pp. 150, 151.

628. GREEN, Celia Elizabeth; “Analysis of Spontaneous Cases”; Proceedings of the Society for Psychical

Research; London; Vol. 53; Part 191; November, 1960; illus.; pp. 97-161.

629. GREEN, Celia Elizabeth; “The Decline and Fall of Science”; X + 184 pp.; glos. 176, 177; bibl. 178,

179; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Hamish Hamilton; London; 1976; pp. 13, 59, 68, 75, 82-84, 86, 93-100, 112-118, 120, 126, 129, 133, 138, 154, 161, 176.

630. GREEN, Celia Elizabeth; “Ecsomatic Experiences and Related Phenomena”; Journal of the Society for

Psychical Research; London; Vol. 44; N. 733; September, 1967;

pp. 111-131.

631. GREEN, Celia Elizabeth; “Lucid Dreams”; pref. H. H. Price; 194 pp.; ono; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.;

Institute of Psychophysical Research; Oxford; Great Britain; 1968; pp. 18-22,

28-40, 50, 60-62, 68, 69, 71-74, 99, 123, 129, 130, 161-169, 172.

632. GREEN, Celia Elizabeth; “Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; 144 pp.; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; Institute of

Psychophysical Research; Oxford; Great Britain; 1968; pp. 1-144; eds.: Eng., It. (Mini-library).

633. GREEN, Celia Elizabeth, and MC CREERY, Charles; “Apparitions”; X + 218 pp.; bibl. 213; alph.;

21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Hamish Hamilton; London; 1975; pp. 4, 5, 9, 12, 20, 21, 26-32, 36, 37, 53-58, 61, 73,

74, 79, 83, 100, 107, 111, 112, 125, 127, 132, 134, 135, 142, 146, 159, 169, 174, 178, 183-187, 195,

211, 212.

634. GREEN, Edward; “O Espiritismo”; without translator; 202 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Gráfica Editora Unitas; S.

Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 103-118.

635. GREENE, Richard A.; “The Handbook of Astral Projection”; 156 pp.; glos. 103-106; 21.5 cm; pb.;

Next Step Publications; Cambridge; Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1979; pp. 1-156 (Mini-library). 636. GREENHOUSE, Herbert B.; “The Astral Journey”; 360 pp.; bibl.; 341-347; alph.; 21 cm; dj.;

Doubleday & Co.; New York; 1975; pp. 1-360; eds.: Eng., It., Sp. (Mini-library).

637. GREENHOUSE, Herbert B.; “The Book of Psychic Knowledge”; 254 pp.; bibl. 247-253; Taplinger;

New York; 1973.

638. GREENHOUSE, Herbert B.; “In Defense of Ghosts”; VIII + 254 pp.; 22 cm;

2nd ed.; Simon; New York; 1970.

639. GREENHOUSE, Herbert B.; “Premonitions: A Leap into the Future”; 320 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pocket;

pb.; Pan Books; London; 1975; pp. 58, 59, 309.

640. GREGORY, Clive C. L.; and KOHSEN, Anita; “Physical and Psychical Research: An Analysis of

Belief”; X + 214 pp.; illus.; bibl. 211-213; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Omega Press; Reigate; Surrey; Great

Britain; 1954; pp. 143, 194, 199.

641. GREGORY, William; “Animal Magnetism”; 254 pp.; 22 cm; W. H. Harrison; London; 1877.

642. GRENSIDE, Dorothy; “The Meaning of Dreams”; G. Bell & Sons; London; 1923; pp. 48, 117.

Page 27: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

643. GREYSON, Bruce; “Telepathy in Mental Illness: Deluge or Delusion?”; The Journal of Nervous and

Mental Disease; Baltimore; Maryland; U. S. A.; Vol. 165; N. 8; 1977; bibl. 198-200; pp. 184-200.

644. GRIMARD, Ed.; “Une Échappée sur L’Infini”; X + 418 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Leymarie Éditeur; Paris;

1899; pp. 286, 287, 356.

645. GRIS, Henry, and DICK, William; “The New Soviet Psychic Discoveries”; 448 pp.; alph.; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Warner Books; New York; March, 1979; pp. 434, 435.

646. GROF, Stanislav; “Realms of the Human Unconscious: Observations from LSD Research”; XXVI +

260 pp.; illus.; bibl. 245, 246; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; E. P. Dutton; Toronto; Canada; 1976; pp. 186-190. 647. GROF, Stanislav, and GROF, Christina; “Beyond Death: The Gates of Consciousness”; 96 pp.; illus.;

bibl. 96; 28 cm; cart.; Thames and Hudson; London; 1980; pp. 9-14, 25.

648. GROF, Stanislav, and HALIFAX, Joan; “The Human Encounter With Death”; pref. Elisabeth Kübler-

Ross; XVI + 240 pp.; bibl. 222-228; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; E. P. Dutton; New York; 1978; pp. 154, 155.

649. GROSS, Darwin; “Ihr Recht Zu Wissen”; transl. Steve De Witt; introd. Bernardine Burlin; 190 pp.; 18

cm; pocket; pb.; IWP Publishing; Menlo Park; Cal.; U. S. A.; 1980; pp. 79,

84-87, 93.

650. GROSSO, Michael; “Out-of-Body Experiences: A Handbook” (Janet Lee Mitchell); Books Reviews;

The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 76;

N. 2; April, 1982; pp. 186-188.

651. GROSSO, Michael; “Plato and Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; The Journal of the American Society

for Psychical Research; New York; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 69; N. 1; January, 1975; bibl. 74; pp. 61-

74.

652. GROSSO, Michael; “A Practical Guide to Death and Dying” (John Warren White); Books Reviews;

The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 76;

N. 1; January, 1982; pp. 75-78.

653. GROSSO, Michael; “Some Varieties of Out-of-Body Experience”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 70; N. 2; April, 1976; bibl. 192,

193; pp. 179-193.

654. GROSSO, Michael; “Toward an Explanation of Near-Death Phenomena”; The Journal of the

American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 75; N. 1; January,

1981; pp. 37-60.

655. GUAITA, Stanislas de; “No Umbral do Mistério”; transl. José Antônio Faria Corrêa; ed. André

Pitágoras; 142 pp.; illus.; 22.5 cm; pb.; Grafosul; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil; 1979; pp. 92, 116, 117.

656. GUARINO, Gilberto Campista; “Clarividência, Precognição, Espaço-Tempo e Domínio Informacional

Omnijacente”; Anais do III Congresso Nacional de Parapsicologia e Psicotrônica; pp. 40-57; illus.;

24 cm; pb.; Abrap; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; July, 1982; pp. 48, 51 (See N. 281).

657. GUDJONSSON, Thorsteinn; “Astrobiology: The Science of the Universe”; 202 pp.; illus.; Bioradii

Publications; Reykjavík; Iceland; 1976.

658. GUDJONSSON, Thorsteinn; “Dreams are the Key to the Cosmos”; introd. John Alexander; 176 pp.;

illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Bioradii Publications; Reykjavík; Iceland; 1982; pp. 110-126.

659. GUÉRET, André, and OUDINOT, Pierre; “O Homem e os Imponderáveis”; transl.

J. Constantino K. Riemma; 190 pp.; illus.; bibl. 188-190.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1982; pp. 64, 161-166. 660. GUIEU, Jimmy; “El Libro de los Paranormales”; transl. Sofía Noguera; 254 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.;

A. T. E.; Barcelona; Spain; 1978; pp. 83-87, 95-98.

661. GUILMOT, Max; “Les Initiés et les Rites Initiatiques en Egypte Ancienne”; 266 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21.5

cm; pb.; Éditions Robert Laffont; Paris; 1977; pp. 57-60.

662. GUIMARÃES, Salô; “Projeção Consciente”; O Caminheiro; Newspaper; Bimonthly;

S. Paulo; Brazil; Yr. 2; N. 18; November-December, 1982; illus.; p. 15.

663. GUIRAO, Pedro; “Dossier del Mas Alla”; 240 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Plaza & Janes; Barcelona;

Spain; May, 1980; pp. 40, 42, 50, 99, 127, 179-190.

664. GUIRDHAM, Arthur; “Entre Dois Mundos”; transl. Norberto de Paula Lima and Márcio Pugliesi; 198

pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 10, 34-37, 43, 47, 86, 119,

120.

665. GUIRDHAM, Arthur; “The Nature of Healing”; George Allen & Unwin; London; 1964; p. 65.

666. GURNEY, Edmund; MYERS, Frederic William Henry; and PODMORE, August Frank; “Phantasms

of the Living”; 2 Vol.; 1.420 pp.; 22 cm; hb.; Trübner and Co.; London; 1886; Vol. I: pp. LXI-LXIV,

Page 28: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

204-220, 230, 231, 251-254, 347-358, 420-424; Vol. II: pp. 61-71,

82-86, 130-152, 169-270, 386-560, 600-641 (Mini-library).

667. GYNSKA, Tola; “A Escada de Ouro de Vênus”; transl. Marysia Fontoura Leinz; pref. André

Doffagne; 140 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Centro Espiritual Vahali-Brasil; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1978;

pp. 13, 14.

668. HAEMMERLÉ, A.; “Experiences of Bilocation”; Annals of Psychical Science; Vol. 4; 1906; pp. 113-

119.

669. HALES, Carol; “Astral Errand of Mercy”; Fate; Evanston; Ill.; U. S. A.; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 16; N. 9; September, 1963.

670. HALL, Prescott F.; “Digest of Spirit Teachings Received Through Mrs. Minnie

E. Keeler”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; Vol. X; November-De-

cember, 1916; pp. 632-661, 679-708.

671. HALL, Prescott F.; “Experiments in Astral Projection”; The Journal of the American Society for

Psychical Research; New York; Vol. XII; January, 1918; pp. 39-60.

672. HALLOCK, Charles; “Luminous Bodies: Here and Hereafter”; 110 pp.; Metaphysical Publishing Co.;

New York; 1906.

673. HAMLYN, E. C.; “Medical Man Says Astral Projection is Commonplace”; Psychic News; London; N.

2.174; 02, February, 1974; p. 5.

674. HAMMOND, C. L.; “Lost Secrets from Ancient Mystery Schools”; Vol. One; XIV + 222 pp.; 20.5

cm; hb.; dj.; New Horizon; Great Britain; 1984; pp. XIII, 9, 58, 139, 153, 155, 159, 161, 167-169, 216.

675. HAMMOND, David; “The Search for Psychic Power”; 292 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Bantam

Books; New York; 1975; pp. 11, 104-122, 146, 147; eds.: Eng., Sp.

676. HAMPTON, Charles; “The Transition Called Death: A Recurring Experience”; introd. Joy Mills; 116

pp.; illus.; bibl. 111-116; 18 cm; pb.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton, Ill.; U. S. A.;

1979; pp. 6-10, 16-19, 26, 30, 39, 43-53, 77; eds.: Eng., Port. 677. HANKEY, Muriel Winifred; “James Hewat McKenzie: Pioneer of Psychical Research”; Biography;

158 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Helix Press; New York; 1963; pp. 29,

125-127, 130-132.

678. HAPGOOD, Charles H.; “Voices of Spirit: Through the Psychic Experience of Elwood Babbitt”; 336

pp.; illus.; glos. 321-328; bibl. 329-332; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Delacorte Press/Seymour Lawrence;

New York; 1975; pp. 75, 176-184, 325; eds.: Eng., Port.

679. HARARY, Stuart Keith, and SOLFVIN, G.; “A Study of Out-of-Body Experiences Using Auditory

Targets”; Research in Parapsychology 1976; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen,

N. J.; U. S. A.; 1977.

680. HARE, Michael; “The Multiple Universe: On the Nature of Spiritual Reality”; 198 pp.; bibl.; Julian

Press; New York; 1968.

681. HARLOW, S. Ralph; “Life After Death”; introd. Enid Hoffman; 174 pp.; 23.5 cm; pb.; Para Research;

Rockport, Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 7, 8, 112.

682. HARLOW, S. Ralph; “SOS: Traumtelepatie”; transl. E. M. Körner; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 21; N. 4; April, 1970; pp. 320, 321.

683. HARNOLD, Hans; “Como se Organizam e se Dirigem as Sessões Espíritas”; without translator; 170

pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Empresa Editora O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1926; pp. 24, 35-37. 684. HARRIS, Bertha; “Traveller in Eternity”; 64 pp.; Regency Press; London; 1975;

pp. 1-64.

685. HARRISON, Shirley, and FRANKLIN, Lynn; “The Psychic Search”; introd. Allan

A. Swenson; VIII + 152 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; pb.; Guy Gannett Publishing; Portland, Maine; U. S. A.;

1981; pp. 103, 104.

686. HARRISON, William H.; “Spirits Before Our Eyes”; 220 pp.; W. H. Harrison; London; 1879.

687. HART, Hornell Norris; “The Enigma of Survival: The Case For and Against an After Life”; 286 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 264-276; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Charles C. Thomas, Publisher; Springfield, Ill.; U. S. A.;

1959; pp. 159, 160, 175, 182-185, 200, 203, 204, 225-228, 241-245, 260, 261 (Mini-library).

688. HART, Hornell Norris; “ESP Projection: Spontaneous Cases and the Experimental Method”; The

Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; 1954;

pp. 121-146.

689. HART, Hornell Norris; “Toward a New Philosophical Basis for Parapsychological Phenomena”; 68

pp.; illus.; 23 cm; pb.; Parapsychology Foundation; New York; 1965; pp. 15-22, 45, 46.

Page 29: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

690. HART, Hornell Norris; “Six Theories About Apparitions”; Proceedings of the Society for Psychical

Research; London; Vol. 50; Part 185; May, 1956; pp. 153-239.

691. HART, Hornell Norris; “Travelling ESP”; Proceedings of the First International Conference of

Parapsychological Studies; Parapsychology Foundation; New York; 1955.

692. HART, Hornell Norris, and HART, Ella B.; “Visions and Apparitions Collectivelly and Reciprocally

Perceived”; Proceedings of the Society for Psychical Research; Vol. XLI; Part 130; May, 1933; pp.

205-249.

693. HARTMANN, Franz; “Magic White and Black”; 298 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; pb.; 5th ed.; Newcastle Publishing Co.; North Hollywood, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1971; pp. 164-182.

694. HAUTERIVE, Ernest D’; “Le Merveilleux au XVIIIe. Siècle”; 264 pp.; bibl. 255-259; 17.5 cm; hb.;

Félix Juven, Éditeur; Paris; no date; pp. 88-93.

695. HAY, David; “Exploring Inner Space”; 256 pp.; bibl. 236-246; alph.; 20 cm; pb.; Penguin Books;

Great Britain; 1982; p. 136.

696. HAYNES, Renée; “Las Fuerzas Ocultas”; transl. Jose Angel de Juanes; 278 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm;

pb.; Ediciones Morata; Madrid; Spain; 1962; pp. 88, 89, 93, 263.

697. HAYNES, Renée; “Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research;

London; Vol. 41; N. 707; March, 1961; p. 52.

698. HAYNES, Renée; “The Seeing Eye, the Seeing I; Perception, Sensory and Extra-Sensory”; 224 pp.;

alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Hutchinson & Co.; London; 1976; pp. 13, 76, 93, 142, 148, 149, 158, 207, 208.

699. HEAD, Joseph, and CRANSTON, S. L.; “Reincarnation: The Phoenix Fire Mystery”; 620 pp.; 23 cm;

hb.; Julian Press / Crown Publishers; New York; 1977; pp. 413, 414,

448-455.

700. HEAPS, Willard A.; “Psychic Phenomena”; 192 pp.; bibl. 172-183; alph.; 20 cm; hb.; dj.; Thomas

Nelson, Publishers; Nashville, Tenessee; U. S. A.; 1974; pp. 31, 45, 168, 182, 183.

701. HEGEDÜS, Alejandro; “Los Fenómenos Extranormales”; 378 pp.; bibl. 373, 374; 20 cm; cart.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1962; pp. 272-293.

702. HEIM, Albert; “Notizen über den Tod durch Absturz”; Jahrbuch des Schweizer Alpenclub; Vol. 27;

1892; pp. 327-337.

703. HEINDEL, Max (Pseud. for Carl Louis Grasshoff); “El Cuerpo de Deseos”; without translator; 144

pp.; 20 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977; pp. 55-59.

704. HEINDEL, Max (Pseud. for Carl Louis Grasshoff); “El Cuerpo Vital”; without translator; 150 pp.; 20

cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977; pp. 71-91.

705. HEINDEL, Max (Pseud. for Carl Louis Grasshoff); “Diccionario Rosacruz”; without translator; 158

pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977; pp. 20-22, 47.

706. HEINE, H. G.; “The Vital Sense: The Implications and Explanation of the Sixth Sense”; VIII + 296

pp.; bibl. 279-285; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Cassell and Co.; London; 1960;

pp. 116, 130, 133, 183-186, 203, 204, 258, 259, 263-268.

707. HEINTSCHEL-HEINEGG, Aglaja; “Der innere Kompass bei Tieren und Menschen”; Esotera;

Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 24; N. 5; May, 1973; illus.; pp. 395-403.

708. HEINTSCHEL-HEINEGG, Aglaja; “Kontakte mit Unsichtbaren? Mediales Erleben”; 218 pp.; bibl.

248-250; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Fischer Taschenbuch Verlag; Frankfurt; West Germany; 1980; pp.

120-138, 146, 149, 150, 229, 241, 244. 709. HELB, Dies; “O Desdobramento”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 57; June, 1977;

pp. 26-33.

710. HEMINGWAY, Ernest; “A Farewell to Arms”; Novel; 288 pp.; 19 cm; hb.; Jonathan Cape; London;

1958; p. 53.

711. HEMMERLIN, Emmanuel; “Les Expériences Hors du Corps en Relation Avec la Mort Physique”;

Renaître 2000; Paris; Magazine; Quarterly; 125th and 126th Yr.; New series; Numbers 29, 30, 31;

August-October, 1982; pp. 157, 158, 174; November-December, 1982;

pp. 213-216; January-February, 1983; pp. 7-10.

712. HEMMERT, Danielle, and ROUDÈNE, Alex; “Aparições, Fantasmas e Desdobramentos”; transl.

Nastia Sliozkin; 206 pp.; illus.; bibl. 204, 205; 21 cm; pb.; Publicações Europa-América; Mira-Sintra;

Portugal; no date; pp. 8, 9, 13-61, 175-200; eds.: Fr., Port.

713. HEMMERT, Danielle, and ROUDÈNE, Alex; “O Universo dos Espíritos”; transl. Attílio Cancian; 202

pp.; bibl. 199; 21 cm; pb.; Hemus Editora; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1984; pp. 29-71.

Page 30: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

714. HERLIN, Hans; “O Mundo Extra-Sensorial”; transl. Ruy Jungmann; 208 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 177-188; eds.: Ger., Sp., Port.

715. HERMÓGENES, José; “Yoga para Nervosos”; pres. Oswaldo Paulino; 390 pp.; illus.; glos. 371-380;

bibl. 381-390; 21 cm; pb.; 18th ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1984;

pp. 259-264 (See N. 32).

716. HEYDECKER, Joe J.; “Fatos da Parapsicologia”; transl. Edith Wagner; 108 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; pb.;

Livraria Freitas Bastos; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1984; p. 49.

717. HEYWOOD, Rosalind; “Beyond the Reach of Sense”; 252 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; E. P. Dutton & Co.; New York; 1974; p. 242.

718. HEYWOOD, Rosalind; “ESP: A Personal Memoir”; Autobiography; introd. Cyril Burt; 222 pp.; 21

cm; hb.; dj.; E. P. Dutton & Co.; New York; 1964; pp. 103, 104.

719. HEYWOOD, Rosalind; “Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; Journal of the Society for Psychical

Research; London; Vol. 42; N. 716; June, 1963; p. 86.

720. HILL, Douglas; “O Regresso dos Mortos”; transl. Maria de Lourdes Medeiros; 120 pp.; illus.; 20 cm;

pb.; Edilivro; Lisboa; Portugal; 1980; pp. 52, 53.

721. HILL, Douglas, and WILLIAMS, Pat; “The Supernatural”; 352 pp.; illus.; alph.; 24 cm; hb.; Hawthorn

Books Publishers; New York; 1965; pp. 106, 322.

722. HILL, J. Arthur; “Man is a Spirit”; 120 pp.; Cassell and Co.; London; 1918; pp. 43, 73.

723. HILL, J. Arthur; “New Evidences in Psychical Research”; introd. Oliver Lodge; 218 pp.; alph.; 19 cm;

hb.; William Rider & Son; London; 1911; pp. 13-21.

724. HILL, J. Arthur; “Psychical Investigations”; 304 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; George

H. Doran Co.; New York; 1917; p. 250.

725. HILLS, Christopher; “Nuclear Evolution, Discovery of the Rainbow Body”; XIV

+ 1.010 pp.; illus.; alph.; 23.5 cm; pb.; University of the Trees Press; Boulder Creek, Cal.; U. S. A.;

1979; p. 89. 726. HINTZE, Naomi A., and PRATT, J. Gaither; “The Psychic Realm: What can You Believe?”; pref. Ian

Stevenson; 270 pp.; bibl. 255-263; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Random House; New York; 1975; pp. 86-96.

727. HITCHING, Francis; “The World Atlas of Mysteries”; 256 pp.; illus.; bibl. 242-248; alph.; 29 cm;

cart.; 6th print.; Pan Books; London; 1983; pp. 82-85, 106, 107.

728. HIVES, Frank; “Glimpses Into Infinity”; pref. Mrs. Philip Champion de Crespigny; introd. G. Lumley;

XXXIV + 278 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; John Lane the Bodley Head; London; 1931;

pp. 7-11, 69-142.

729. HODSON, Geoffrey; “Basic Theosophy”; 572 pp.; illus.; bibl. 339, 340; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; The

Theosophical Publishing House; Adyar, Madras; India; 1981; pp. 73-76, 138-142, 157, 158, 164.

730. HODSON, Geoffrey; “O Reino dos Deuses”; transl. Carmen Penteado Piza and Joaquim Gervásio de

Figueiredo; 258 pp.; illus.; 23.5 cm; hb.; Sociedade Teosófica do Brasil;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1967; p. 247.

731. HODSON, Geoffrey; “The Science of Seership”; 224 pp.; illus.; alph.; 22 cm; hb.;

5th print.; The Occult Book Society; London; no date; p. 215.

732. HOFFMAN, Enid; “Develop Your Psychic Skills”; 184 pp.; bibl. 177, 178; alph.; 23.5 cm; pb.; Para

Research; Rockport, Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 35, 38, 39, 61.

733. HOFFMAN, Enid; “Huna: A Beginner’s Guide”; 220 pp.; illus.; bibl. 213-215; alph.; 23.5 cm; pb.; 5th print.; Para Research; Rockport, Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 19, 55.

734. HOLLOWAY, Gilbert N.; “O Médium e sua Percepção Extra-Sensorial”; transl. Almira B. Guimarães

and Ebréia de Castro Alves; 192 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editora Pallas; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1982;

pp. 21, 112, 113, 145, 146.

735. HOLMS, Archibald Campbell; “The Facts of Psychic Science”; pref. Leslie

A. Shepard; XXVI + 512 pp.; index of names; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; University Books; New York;

1969; pp. 448-469.

736. HOLROYD, Stuart; “Alien Intelligence”; 232 pp.; illus.; bibl. 227-229; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Everest House Publishers; New York; 1979; pp. 97-124, 141, 142.

737. HOLROYD, Stuart; “Los Fenómenos de la Parapsicología”; transl. José Luis Alvarez; 144 pp.; 26 cm;

hb.; Editorial Noguer; Barcelona; Spain; 1976; pp. 16, 17, 22-25, 41-43, 101.

738. HOLROYD, Stuart; “El Mundo de los Sueños”; transl. Alfredo Andrés; 144 pp.; illus.; 26 cm; hb.;

Editorial Noguer; Barcelona; Spain; 1977; pp.72-78.

Page 31: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

739. HOLROYD, Stuart; “PSI and the Consciousness Explosion”; 236 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Taplinger

Publishing Co.; New York; 1977; pp. 17, 75-77, 155, 156.

740. HOLROYD, Stuart; “Psychic Voyages”; 144 pp.; illus.; 26 cm; hb.; Doubleday and Co.; New York;

1977; pp. 46-85.

741. HOLT, Henry; “On the Cosmic Relations”; 2 Vol.; XII + 990 pp.; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; Houghton Mifflin

Co.; New York; February, 1915; pp. 881-913.

742. HOLZER, Hans; “Carismática”; transl. Maria Stella Bruce; 154 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

5th ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 98-103. 743. HOLZER, Hans; “The Directory of the Occult”; 202 pp.; glos. 189-201; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Henry

Regnery Co.; Chicago, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1974; pp. 190, 192.

744. HOLZER, Hans; “Extra-Sensory Perception and You”; 216 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Leslie Frewin

Publishers; London; 1969; pp. 42-50, 98, 99.

745. HOLZER, Hans; “Interpretación Práctica de los Sueños”; transl. Celia Filipetto; 190 pp.; bibl. 187; 20

cm; pb.; Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1981; pp. 56, 57,

161-174.

746. HOLZER, Hans; “Janela Sobre o Passado”; transl. Affonso Blacheyre; 240 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 21-23, 120, 121.

747. HOLZER, Hans; “O Lado Psíquico dos Sonhos”; transl. Vera Day; 176 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora

Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1976; pp. 33, 122-136.

748. HOLZER, Hans; “The Psychic World of Bishop Pike”; 224 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Crown

Publishers; New York; 1970; pp. 156, 158.

749. HOLZER, Hans; “O Sobrenatural ao Nosso Alcance”; transl. Luíza Ribeiro; 178 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

Editorial Nórdica; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1977; pp. 55-64.

750. HOLZER, Hans; “Supervivientes de la Muerte”; transl. Horacio González Trejo; 172 pp.; 19.5 cm;

pb.; Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1980; pp. 13-27. 751. HOLZER, Hans; “The Truth About ESP”; 176 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Doubleday

& Co.; New York; 1974; pp. 93-114.

752. HOME, Daniel Dunglas; “Révélations sur Ma Vie Surnaturelle”; 338 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Didier

et Cie, E. Dentu; Paris; 1863; pp. 56-82.

753. HONEGGER, Barbara; “The OBE as a Near-Birth Experience”; In Research in Parapsychology; 1982;

The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; pp. 230, 231.

754. HONEGGER, Barbara, and PALMER, John; “Correspondence”; Parapsychology Review; New York;

Vol. 10; N. 2; March-April, 1979; pp. 24-27.

755. HOOPER, Judith; “Interview John Lilly”; Omni; New York; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. V; N. 4;

January, 1983; illus.; pp.56-58, 74, 76, 78-82.

756. HOPE, Murry; “Practical Techniques of Psychic Self-Defense”; 96 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; The

Aquarian Press; Wellingborough; Northamptonshire; Great Britain; 1983; pp. 46, 49-55.

757. HORIA, Vintila; “Encuesta Detras de lo Visible”; 256 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Plaza & Janes;

Barcelona; Spain; February, 1980; pp. 115-125, 160, 161.

758. HOSSRI, Cesário Morey; “Prática do Treinamento Autógeno & LSD”; 158 pp.; illus.; bibl. 151-154;

21 cm; pb.; Editora Mestre Jou; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1968; pp. 99-101, 105, 148.

759. HOSSRI, Cesário Morey; “Sonho Acordado Dirigido”; 172 pp.; illus.; bibl. 163-170; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Mestre Jou; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1974; pp. 128, 129.

760. HOSSRI, Cesário Morey; “Tratamento Autógeno e Equilíbrio Psicotônico”; 124 pp.; illus.; bibl. 120-

122; 21 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Editora Mestre Jou; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1978; p.73.

761. HOWARD, Michael; “Candle Burning, Its Occult Significance”; 96 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd print.;

The Aquarian Press; Wellingborough, Northamptonshire; Great Britain; 1982; pp. 84, 85.

762. HUBER, Guido; “Übersinnliche Gaben”; pref. Peter Ringger; 148 pp.; bibl. 146, 147; 20 cm; hb.; dj.;

Origo Verlag; Zürich; Switzerland; 1959; pp. 23, 94, 109.

763. HUBER, Lela; “Gegenseitiger Astral besuch”; transl. E. M. Körner; Esotera; Freiburg; West

Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 21; N. 10; Oktober, 1970; p. 941.

764. HUDSON, Thomson Jay; “The Law of Psychic Phenomena”; introd. Erwin Seale; 410 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

Samuel Weiser; New York; 1975; pp. 185-190, 289, 290; eds.: Eng., Port.

765. HUFFORD, David J.; “The Terror that Comes in the Night”; 278 pp.; bibl.; alph.; University of

Pennsylvania Press; Philadelphia, PA; U. S. A.; 1982.

Page 32: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

766. HUMPHREYS, Christmas; “O Zen-Budismo”; transl. Louisa Ibañez; 188 pp.; bibl. 183-187; 21 cm;

pb.; Zahar Editores; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1977; pp. 123-131.

767. HUNT, Douglas; “Exploring the Occult”; 220 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 2nd print.; Ballantine Books;

New York; April, 1970; pp. 50-62, 192, 193.

768. HUSON, Paul; “How to Test and Develop Your ESP”; 216 pp.; illus.; glos. 197-203; bibl. 204-207;

alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Stein and Day Publishers; New York; 1975; pp. 65,

101-117, 193, 194, 199, 200.

769. HUTCHINGS, Emily Grant; “Where do we go from Here? The Journey of Life”; 306 pp.; Putnam’s; New York; 1933.

770. HUXLEY, Aldous Leonard; “A Ilha”; Novel; transl. Gisela Brigitte Laub; 358 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 6th ed.;

Editora Civilização Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1971; pp. 45-48, 320, 325, 326.

771. HUXLEY, Aldous Leonard; “Moksha”; Anthology; transl. Eliana Sabino; org. Michel Horowitz and

Cynthia Palmer; introd. Albert Hofmann and Alexander Shulgin; 330 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora

Globo; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 83, 84, 98, 99, 234-240, 263, 267.

772. HUXLEY, Aldous Leonard; “As Portas da Percepção”; transl. and pref. Oswaldo de Araújo Souza; 46

pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 9th ed.; Editora Globo; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil; 1979; pp. 29-30.

773. HYSLOP, James H.; “Psychical Research and Survival”; X + 208 pp.; bibl. 207, 208; 18.5 cm; hb.; G.

Bell & Sons; London; 1913; pp. 135-137, 144.

774. IBRAHIM, Yosip; “Mi Preparacion para Ganimedes”; 208 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; pb.;

5th ed.; Editorial Ganimedes; Buenos Aires; Argentina; November, 1976; pp. 149-155.

775. IMBASSAHY, Carlos; “Espiritismo”; in “Religiões Comparadas: Oito Sínteses Doutrinárias”; 228 pp.;

illus.; 22.5 cm; pb.; Cruzada Espiritualista; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1929; pp. 148, 158, 159.

776. IMBASSAHY, Carlos; “A Evolução”; pref. Pedro Granja; 362 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Livraria da Federação

Espírita do Paraná; Curitiba, PR; Brazil; 1955; pp. 251-264.

777. IMBASSAHY, Carlos; “Freud e as Manifestações da Alma”; 252 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Editora Eco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 138, 139.

778. IMBASSAHY, Carlos; “Hipóteses em Parapsicologia”; pref. José Alberto Menezes; 276 pp.; 21 cm;

pb.; Editora Eco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1967; pp. 206-209.

779. IMBASSAHY, Carlos; “À Margen do Espiritismo”; pref. Guillon Ribeiro; 256 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; 2nd

ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1950; pp. 115-120.

780. IMBASSAHY, Carlos; “O Que é a Morte”; pref. José Herculano Pires; 190 pp.; bibl. 187-189; 21 cm;

pb.; Editora Cultural Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1978; pp. 82-135.

781. IMBASSAHY, Carlos, and GRANJA, Pedro; “Fantasmas, Fantasias e Fantoches”; pref. Júlio Abreu

Filho; 400 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Édipo, Edições Populares; S. Paulo; Brazil; September, 1950; p. 382.

782. IMBASSAHY, Carlos de Brito; “Classificacion de los Fenomenos Paranormales”; Evolucion; Caracas;

Venezuela; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. XVI; N. 74; Octubre, 1984; illus.;

pp. 9-12.

783. IMBASSAHY, Carlos de Brito; “Quando os Fantasmas se Divertem”; pref. Hernani Guimarães

Andrade; 14 + 176 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Casa Editora O Clarim; Matão, SP; Brazil; 1971;

pp. 127, 128.

784. IMPERATOR (Pseud.); “Pode a Consciência ser Projetada?”; O Rosacruz; Magazine; Monthly;

August, 1978; illus.; pp. 124-127. 785. IMPERATOR (Pseud.); “A Projeção da Consciência”; O Rosacruz; Magazine; Monthly; February,

1983; illus.; pp. 52-55.

786. INARDI, Massimo; “A História da Parapsicologia”; transl. A. J. Pinto Ribeiro; 310 pp.; bibl. 303-305;

22 cm; pb.; Edições 70; Lisboa; Portugal; July, 1979; pp. 148-150.

787. INARDI, Massimo; “O Sexto Sentido”; transl. Attílio Cancian; 220 pp.; illus.; bibl. 215-217; 21 cm;

pb.; Hemus; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1977; pp. 93-203.

788. INGBER, Dina; “Visões de Além da Morte”; Ciência Ilustrada; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly;

Yr. II; N. 7; April, 1983; illus.; pp. 16-21.

789. INGLIS, Brian; “Natural and Supernatural: A History of the Paranormal from Earliest Times to 1914”;

490 pp.; illus.; bibl. 455-476; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Hodder and Stoughton; London; 1977; pp. 24,

131, 132, 149, 333, 334.

790. IRWIN, Harvey J.; “Out-of-the-Body Down Under: Some Cognitive Characteristics of Australian

Students Reporting OOBEs”; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 50; N. 785;

bibl.; September, 1980; pp. 448-459.

Page 33: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

791. IRWIN, Harvey J.; “The Psychological Function of Out-of-body Experiences: So Who Needs the Out-

of-Body Experience?”; The Journal of Nervous and Mental Disease; Baltimore, Maryland; U. S. A.;

Vol. 169; N. 4; 1981; bibl. 247, 248; pp. 244-248.

792. IRWIN, Harvey J.; “Some Psychological Dimensions of the Out-of-Body Experience”;

Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 12; N. 4; July-August, 1981; pp. 1-6.

793. ISAACS, Julian; “On Kinetic Effects During Out-of-Body Projection”; The Journal of the American

Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 75; N. 2; April, 1981;

pp. 192-194. 794. JACKSON, A. W.; “The Celtic Church Speaks Today”; World Fellowship Press; 1968; p. 26.

795. JACO, Grace R.; “Wenn das der Tod ist...”; transl. E. M. Körner; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 21; N. 11; November, 1970; p. 1020.

796. JACOBSON, Nils O.; “Life Without Death?”; transl. Sheila La Farge; VIII + 342 pp.; illus.; glos. 327-

329; bibl. 295-325; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Turnstone Books; London; 1974;

pp. 91-126; eds.: Swedish, Eng., Ger., Port.

797. JACOBY, A.; “Señor Kon-tiki”; George Allen & Unwin; London; 1968; p. 24.

798. JAFFÉ, Aniela; “Apparitions, An Archetypal Approach to Death Dreams And Ghosts”; pref. Carl

Gustav Jung; VIII + 214 p.; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; Spring Publications; Irving, Texas; U. S. A.; 1979; pp.

143-167.

799. JAGOT, Paul-Clément; “Méthode Scientifique Moderne de Magnétisme, Hypnotisme, Suggestion”;

352 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; M. Drouin, Éditeur; Paris; no date;

pp. 155-172; eds.: Fr., It.

800. JAGOT, Paul-Clément; “Traité Méthodique du Magnétisme Personnel”; 268 pp.; 22 cm; hb.; Éditions

Dangles; Paris; 31, May, 1952; pp.165-180.

801. JAGOT, Paul-Clément; “Traité Théorique et Pratique de la Double Vue”; 200 pp.; illus.; 22.5 cm; pb.;

Librairie et Éditions Leymarie; Paris; 1982; pp. 150-152. 802. JAMES, William; “Études et Réflexions d’un Psychiste”; transl. Durandeaud; introd. René Sudré; 336

pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Payot; Paris; 1924; pp. 171-174; eds.: Eng., Fr., Port.

803. JAMES, William; “The Varieties of Religious Experience”; XVIII + 526 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; hb.; The

Modern Library; New York; no date; pp. 376-386.

804. JEANNE, Louise; “Causeries Spirites”; 216 pp.; 17 cm; hb.; Imprimerie Durand, Fillons et Lagarde;

Toulouse; France; 1885; pp. 86-88.

805. JEBB, Robert H.; “A Business-man’s Experiences of the Truth of Life After

Death”; Aird & Coghill; London; 1925; pp. 52, 113.

806. JOHN, Da Free; “Easy Death”; editor Georg Feuerstein; introd. Kenneth Ring; XXII + 406 pp.; illus.;

alph.; 23 cm; pb.; The Dawn Horse Press; Clearlake, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1983; pp. 239, 254-256, 276, 360-

362.

807. JOHNSON, Raynor C.; “The Imprisoned Splendour”; 426 pp.; alph.; 22 cm; pb.; The Theosophical

Publishing House; Wheaton, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1971; pp. 218-240.

808. JOHNSON, Raynor C.; “A Watcher on the Hills”; Hodder and Stoughton; London; 1959.

809. JOIRE, Paul; “De L’Extériorisation de la Sensibilité”; 380 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; hb.; Félix Alcan, Éditeur;

Paris; 1897; pp. 341-352.

810. JOIRE, Paul; “Psychical and Supernormal Phenomena”; 634 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Frederick A. Stokes Co.; New York; no date; pp. 79-91.

811. JORGE, José; Organizator; “Antologia do Perispírito”; 204 pp.; illus.; bibl. 197-202; 23 cm; pb.;

Instituto Maria; Juiz de Fora, MG; Brazil; 1983; pp. 12, 54-57, 78-80, 193.

812. JUNG, Carl Gustav; “Memoires, Dreams, Reflections”; ed. and introd. Aniella Jaffé; transl. Richard

Winston and Clara Winston; 448 pp.; illus.; glos. 410-420; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 11st print.;

William Collins Sons; Glasgow; Great Britain; November, 1977; pp. 320, 321, 343, 344; eds.: Ger.,

Eng., Port.

813. JUNG, Carl Gustav; “The Structure and Dynamics of the Psyche”; transl. R. F. C. Hull; X + 588 pp.;

bibl. 535-552; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; 4th print.; Princeton University Press; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1978;

pp. 481, 482, 506-509.

814. KARAGULLA, Shafica; “Breakthrough to Creativity”; 268 pp.; bibl. 263-268; 22.5 cm; hb.; dj.; De

Vorss & Co.; Marina Del Rey, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1978; pp. 73, 110-115, 180, 246.

Page 34: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

815. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “O Céu e o Inferno”; transl. Manuel

Justiniano Quintão; 426 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 28th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

1982; pp. 55, 168-172, 174, 243, 249, 407.

816. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Espírito de um Lado, Corpo do Outro”;

transl. Júlio Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. III;

N. 1; reed.; 21 cm; hb.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1968; January, 1860; pp. 11-19.

817. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Estudo sobre o Espírito de Pessoas

Vivas”; transl. Júlio Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. III; N. 3; reed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; 1968; March, 1860; pp. 85-91.

818. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “O Evangelho Segundo o Espiritismo”;

transl. Guillon Ribeiro; 456 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 86th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; 1982; pp. 109, 110, 398, 400, 427.

819. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Evocação de um Surdo-mudo

Encarnado”; transl. Júlio Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. VIII; Vol. 1; reed.; Edicel;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1968; January, 1865; pp. 19-21.

820. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Fenômeno de Bi-Corporeidade”; transl.

Júlio Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. I; N. 12; reed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1968;

December, 1858; pp. 343-346.

821. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “A Gênese”; transl. Guillon Ribeiro; 400

pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 15th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1967; pp. 203, 273-283,

290, 293, 294, 339, 340, 354.

822. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Identidade de um Espírito Encarnado”;

transl. Júlio Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. VI; Vol.

1; reed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1968; January, 1863; pp. 20-23.

823. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Ligação Entre o Espírito e o Corpo”; transl. Júlio Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. II; N. 5; reed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil;

1968; May, 1859; pp. 139, 140.

824. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “O Livro dos Espíritos”; transl. Guillon

Ribeiro; 480 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.; 31st ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no

date; pp. 171, 201, 213-236, 254, 278.

825. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “O Livro dos Médiuns”; transl. Guillon

Ribeiro; 480 pp.; glos. 478-480; 18 cm; pb.; 30th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; 1972; pp. 71, 117, 123, 124, 128, 141-153, 260, 361-364, 367, 376; eds.: Fr., Eng., Port., It.,

Sp., esperanto.

826. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Maria D’Agreda: Fenômeno de

Bicorporeidade”; transl. Júlio Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. III; N. 11; reed.;

Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1968; November, 1860; pp. 372-376.

827. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Obras Póstumas”; transl. Guillon

Ribeiro; 354 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 12nd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1964; pp.

46-51, 69-78, 89, 90, 159, 160, 171.

828. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “O Principiante Espírita”; without

translator; introd. Henri Sausse; 128 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; 10th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1944; pp. 101, 113, 114.

829. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “O Que é o Espiritismo”; without

translator; introd. Henri Sausse; 218 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 24th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de

Janeiro; Brazil; 1982; pp. 194, 195, 204.

830. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Santo Atanásio, Espírita sem o Saber”;

transl. Júlio Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. VII; Vol.

1; reed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; 1968; January, 1864; pp. 29, 30.

831. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Teoria dos Sonhos”; transl. Júlio Abreu

Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. VIII; Vol. 7; reed.; Edicel;

S. Paulo; 1968; July, 1865; pp. 202-205.

832. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Uma Aparição Providencial”; transl.

Júlio Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. IV; N. 7; reed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1968;

July, 1861; pp. 212-215.

Page 35: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

833. KARDEC, Allan (Pseud. for Leon Hypolite Denizard Rivail); “Um Sonho Instrutivo”; transl. Júlio

Abreu Filho; Revista Espírita; Paris; Monthly; Yr. IX; Vol. 6; reed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1968;

July, 1866; pp. 171-174.

834. KARL, Miguel; “O Espiritismo, Doutrina da Felicidade”; introd. Cesar Gonçalves; 96 pp.; 17.5 cm;

hb.; Editora Espírita; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1937; pp. 85-87.

835. KELLER, Werner; “La Parapsychologie Ouvre le Futur”; transl. Anne Soulé-Abeilhou; 412 pp.; illus.;

glos. 407-410; bibl. 411, 412; 21.5 cm; pb.; Éditions Robert Laffont; Paris; 1978; pp. 340-360, 408; em

Ger., Fr. 836. KELWAY-BAMBER, L.; “Claude’s Book”; introd. Oliver Lodge; XXVIII + 150 pp.; 19 cm; hb.; 2nd

ed.; Methuen & Co.; London; 1919; pp. 10, 11.

837. KELWAY-BAMBER, L.; “Claude’s Second Book”; introd. Ellis Thomas Powell; XX + 124 pp.; illus.;

18 cm; hb.; Psychic Book Club; London; 1919; pp. 75, 76.

838. KENNELLY, F. J.; “Reincarnation and Survival”; 88 pp.; Arken Publishing Co.; Aurora; U. S. A.;

1974.

839. KENNETT, Frances; “How to Read Your Dreams”; 64 pp.; illus.; 29 cm; hb.; dj.; Golden Hands

Books; London; 1975; p. 58.

840. KERNER, Justinus; “A Vidente de Prevorst”; Biography; transl. Carlos Imbassahy; 266 pp.; 19 cm;

pb.; Casa Editora O Clarim; Matão, SP; Brazil; 1973; pp. 65, 66.

841. KETTELKAMP, Larry; “Hypnosis: The Wakeful Sleep”; 96 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; William

Morrow and Co.; New York; 1975; pp. 89-91.

842. KFOURI, Fauze; “Raio X da Mente Humana”; pref. L. Romanowski; 190 pp.; glos. 181-187; bibl.

189, 190; 21 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Author’s Edition; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1976; pp. 182.

843. KILNER, Walter John; “The Human Aura”; pref. Leslie A. Shepard; XIV + 306 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21

cm; pb.; The Citadel Press; Secaucus, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1965; pp. 38-43.

844. KING, Francis; editor and introd.; “Astral Projection, Ritual Magic and Alchemy”; 254 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; Samuel Weiser; New York; 1972; pp. 49-76.

845. KING, Francis; “Ritual Magic in England”; 176 pp.; bibl. 175, 176; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; New English

Library; London; December, 1972; pp. 101, 114-118.

846. KING, Francis, and SKINNER, Stephen; “Techniques of High Magic: A Manual of Self-Initiation”;

228 pp.; illus.; bibl. 218; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Destiny Books; New York; 1981;

pp. 10, 13, 106-125, 218.

847. KING, Stephen; “O Iluminado”; transl. Betty Ramos Albuquerque; 396 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 31, 78, 273.

848. KINGSTON, Kenny; “Sweet Spirits”; XII + 260 pp.; illus.; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Contemporary

Books; Chicago, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1978; pp. 143, 144.

849. KIPP, Heinrich; “Die Geisterwelt ist nicht verschlossem...”; Die Andere Welt; Freiburg; West

Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 20; N. 12; December, 1969; pp. 1097, 1098.

850. KLEIN, Aaron E.; “Parapsychologie”; 112 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Wilhelm Goldman Verlag;

München; West Germany; 1975; pp. 81-83.

851. KNIGHT, David C.; “The ESP Reader”; Anthology; XIV + 432 pp.; glos. 424-428; bibl. 429-431;

index of names; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Castle Books; Secaucus, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1969; pp. 89, 104, 273-316,

393-400, 424-428. 852. KNIGHT, Gareth; “A History of White Magic”; introd. Kathleen Raine; 236 pp.; illus.; bibl. 223-226;

alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Samuel Weiser; New York; 1979; pp. 177-179, 218.

853. KNIGHT, Gareth; “Occult Exercises and Practices”; 96 pp.; illus.; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; The Aquarian

Press; London; 1982; pp. 33-59; eds.: Eng., Sp.

854. KOESTLER, Arthur; “The Invisible Writing”; Hamish Hamilton, Collins; London; 1954; p. 352.

855. KOHN, Elisabeth; “Ein Weg zur grundlegenden Schicksalswandlung”; Die Andere Welt; Freiburg;

West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 19; N. 3; March, 1968;

pp. 208-210.

856. KOHN, Elisabeth; “Erwach aus dem Traum des Lebens!”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 23; N. 5; May, 1972; pp. 423-428.

857. KOHR, Richard L.; “A Survey of Psi Experiences Among Members of a Special Population”; The

Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 74; N. 4; October, 1980; pp.

395-411.

Page 36: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

858. KOLOSIMO, Peter; “Ciudadanos de las Tinieblas”; transl. Juan Moreno; pref. Andrea Romero; 256

pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 2nd ed.; Plaza & Janes; Barcelona; Spain; November, 1979; pp. 145-149, 156.

859. KOPP, René; “Introduction Générale a L’Étude des Sciences Occultes”; 384 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; Paul

Leymairie Éditeur; Paris; 1930; pp. 127-132.

860. KOVACH, Tom; “Out-of-Body Survey”; Omni; New York; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 4; N. 11;

August, 1982; illus.; p. 94.

861. KRIPPNER, Stanley Curtiss; Editor; “Extrasensory Perception”; Anthology; introd. Montague

Ullman; 308 pp.; index of names; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Plenum Press; New York; 1978; pp. 116-118, 150, 159, 160.

862. KRIPPNER, Stanley Curtiss; “The Implications of Contemporary Dream Research”; Journal of the

American Society of Psichosomatic Dentistry and Medicine; Part I; Vol. 18; N. 3; 1971; pp. 94-101;

Part. II; Vol. 18; N. 4; bibl. 138-140; 1972; pp. 130-140.

863. KRIPPNER, Stanley Curtiss; “Song of the Siren: A Parapsychological Odyssey”; XVIII + 312 pp.;

alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; Harper & Row, Publishers; New York; 1975; pp. 262-264.

864. KRIPPNER, Stanley Curtiss; & RUBIN, Daniel; Editors; “The Kirlian Aura: Photographing the

Galaxies of Life”; 208 pp.; illus.; bibl. 200-204; 21 cm; pb.; Anchor Press; New York; 1974; pp. 171,

172.

865. KRIPPNER, Stanley Curtiss; & VILLOLDO, Alberto; “The Realms of Healing”; introd. Evan Harris

Walker; X + 336 pp.; illus.; bibl. 317-324; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Celestial Arts; Millbrae, Cal.; U. S. A.;

1976; pp. 299, 300.

866. KRISHNA, Gopi; “Kundalini: The Evolutionary Energy in Man”; introd. Frederic Spiegelberg;

comment James Hillman; 252 pp.; 22 cm; pb.; Shambhala Publications; Boulder; Colorado; U. S. A.;

1971; pp. 12, 13.

867. KRISHNA, Gopi; “The Secret of Yoga”; 212 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Turnstone Press; Wellingborough;

Northamptonshire; Great Britain; 1981; pp. 123-126. 868. KRISHNAN, V.; “Near-Death Experiences: Reassessment Urged”; Parapshychology Review; New

York; Vol. 12; N. 4; July-August, 1981; pp. 10, 11.

869. KRISHNAN, V.; “Out-of-the-Body Vision”; Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 13; N. 2;

March-April, 1982; bibl. 22; pp. 21, 22.

870. KRISHNAN, V.; “Correspondence: V. Krishnan Questions”; Parapsychology Review; New York;

Vol. II; N. 4; July-August, 1980; bibl.; p. 26.

871. KRUGER, Helen; “Other Healers, Other Cures”; XVI + 404 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; The Bobbs-

Merril Co.; New York; 1974; pp. 302, 303, 337.

872. KYBER, Manfred; “Também Eles são Nossos Irmãos?”; transl. Tatiana Braunwieser; 162 pp.; illus.;

19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Cultural Espiritual; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981; pp. 138-142.

873. LAFFERTY, La Vedi, and HOLLOWELL, Bud; “The Eternal Dance”; pres. Car. Llewellyn

Weschcke; introd. Patricia-Rochelle Diegel; 540 pp.; illus.; bibl. 511-522; alph.; 20.5 cm; pb.;

Llewellyn Publications; St. Paul, Minnesota; U. S. A.; pp. 340, 453, 478.

874. LAMONT, Stewart; “Is Anybody There?”; 144 pp.; glos. 143; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Mainstream

Publishing; Edinburg; Great Britain; 1980; pp. 81-104, 109-114, 143.

875. LANCELIN, Charles; “L’Ame Humaine”; 206 pp.; illus.; 17 cm; hb.; Henri Durville, Imprimeur-

Éditeur; Paris; 1920; pp. 9, 33-43. 876. LANCELIN, Charles; “L’Au-Dela et ses Problèmes”; pref. Michel de Montaigne; 304 pp.; illus.; 17.5

cm; pb.; Librairie du Magnetisme; Paris; 1907; pp. 112-135.

877. LANCELIN, Charles; “L’Évocation des Morts”; 60 pp.; 24 cm; pb.; Henri Durville, Imprimeur-

Éditeur; Paris; 1925; pp. 14, 15.

878. LANCELIN, Charles; “La Fraude dans la Production des Phénomènes Médiumniques”; 132 pp.; 25.5

cm; pb.; Hector et Henri Durville, Éditeurs; Paris; no date; pp. 39, 40.

879. LANCELIN, Charles; “Méthode de Dédoublement Personnel: Extériorization de la Neuricité, Sorties

en Astral”; 554 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.; Hector et Henri Durville, Éditeurs; Paris; 1912; pp. 309-398

(Mini-library).

880. LANCELIN, Charles; “L’Occultisme et la Science”; 678 pp.; 22 cm; pb.; Éditions Jean Meyer; Paris;

1926; pp. 496-504.

881. LANCELIN, Charles; “L’Occultisme et la Vie”; 544 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.; Éditions Adyar; Paris;

1928; pp. 484-487, 535-540.

Page 37: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

882. LANCELIN, Charles; “A Prática do Desdobramento”; without translator; Revista O Pensamento; S.

Paulo; Yr. XXXV; N. 408, 409, 410; September-October, 1942; illus.; pp. 297-299, 327-329.

883. LANCELIN, Charles; “La Vie Posthume”; 416 pp.; illus.; 24 cm; hb.; Henri Durville, Imprimeur-

Éditeur; Paris; 1923; pp. 145-155.

884. LANDAU, Lucian; “An Unusual Out-of-the-Body Experience”; Journal of the Society for Psychical

Research; London; Vol. 42; N. 717; September, 1963; illus.; pp. 126-128.

885. LANG, Andrew; “The Book of Dreams and Ghosts”; introd. Robert Reginald; 302

pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Newcastle Publishing Co; Hollywood, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1972; pp. 84-87, 89-93.

886. LANTIER, Jacques; “El Espiritismo”; transl. M. Bofill y E. Petit; 176 pp.; bibl. 175, 176; 21.5 cm; pb.;

Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1976; pp. 147-149.

887. LARCHER, Hubert; & RAVIGNANT, Patrick; “Os Domínios da Parapsicologia”; transl. Margarida

Schiappa and Francisco Agarez; 366 pp.; illus.; glos. 337-345; bibl. 349-359; 20.5 cm; cart.; Edições

70; Lisboa; Portugal; January, 1977; pp. 9, 33, 48, 169, 187-194, 284-286, 310, 337-340.

888. LARSEN, Caroline D.; “My Travels in the Spirit World”; 106 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; hb.; Tulle Co.;

Rutland, Vermont; U. S. A.; 1927; pp. 1-106.

889. LAUBSCHER, Barend Jacob Frederick; “Beyond Life’s Curtain”; pref. John

D. Pearce-Higgins; 108 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Howard Timmim; Cape Town; South Africa; 1967;

pp. 28-32, 39, 54-66.

890. LAUBSCHER, Barend Jacob Frederick; “Where Mystery Dwells”; pref. John

D. Pearce-Higgins; X + 262 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; James Clarke & Co.; Cambridge; England;

1972; pp. 23, 27-36, 104, 198, 200-208, 212.

891. LAUTNER, Theodor; “Seelenwanderungen während des Schlafes und bei Ohnmachten”; Die Andere

Welt; Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 19; N. 12; December, 1968; illus.; pp. 1073-

1077. 892. LAWRENCE, J.; “Magnetismo Utilitário y Milagroso”; without translator; 196 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.;

Eletric & Magnetic Federal Institute; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 125-127, 183-187.

893. LAWRENCE, J.; “Ocultismo Pratico”; 400 pp.; 23 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Lawrence

& Co.; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 01, March, 1913; pp. 364-384.

894. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “The Astral Plane: Its Scenery, Inhabitants, and Phenomena”; 128

pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; 5th ed.; Theosophical Publishing House; Los Angeles; U. S. A.; 1918; pp. 31-35;

eds.: Eng., Sp., Port.

895. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “Les Aides Invisibles”; without translator; 160 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.;

4th ed.; Les Éditions Adyar; Paris; 1930; pp. 27-37; eds.: Eng., Fr., Sp., Port.

896. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “Los Centros de Fuerza y el Fuego Serpentino”; without translator;

52 pp.; 17 cm; pb.; Editorial Orion; Mexico; D. F.; 1976; pp. 23-28.

897. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “The Chakras”; XIV + 132 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; The

Theosophical Publishing House; Adyar, Madras; India; 1973; pp. 71-94.

898. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “De La Clairvoyance”; transl. La Garnérie; 228 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.;

Publications Théosophiques; Paris; 1910; pp. 69-106; eds.: Eng., Fr., Port.

899. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “Compêndio de Teosofia”; without translator; 116 pp.; 19.5 cm;

pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 52, 61, 70, 71. 900. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “El Hombre Visible e Invisible”; transl. Luis Aguilera Fernandez;

140 pp.; illus.; 22.5 cm; pb.; 6th ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977;

pp. 107-111.

901. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “O Lado Oculto das Coisas”; transl. Raymundo Mendes Sobral;

382 pp.; bibl. 381; alph.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981;

pp. 305-308.

902. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “El Plano Mental”; transl. Federico Climent Terrer; 100 pp.; 19.5

cm; pb.; 5th ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1976; pp. 1-100.

903. LEADBEATER, Charles Webster; “O Que há Além da Morte”; transl. Cinira Riedel de Figueiredo;

362 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1974; pp. 165-175; eds.: Eng., Sp., Port.

904. LEAF, Horace; “A Morte não é o Fim: Memórias de Um Médium”; Autobiography; transl. Nair

Lacerda; 202 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1984; pp. 84-92.

905. LEAF, Horace; “What Mediumship is”; 168 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; dj.; 8th print.; Spiritualist Press;

London; 1976; pp. 142-150.

Page 38: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

906. LEAL, Julio Cesar; “A Casa de Deus”; 202 pp.; 17 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio

de Janeiro; Brazil; 1921; pp. 45, 48, 49.

907. LEARY, Timothy; METZNER, Ralph; and ALPERT, Richard; “The Psychedelic Experience: A

Manual Based on the Tibetan Book of the Dead”; 160 pp.; 23.5 cm; hb.; 2nd print.; University Books;

New York; September, 1964; pp. 38, 59.

908. LEE, Dal; “Dictionary of Astrology”; 250 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Warner Books; New York;

December, 1968; p. 71.

909. LEFEBURE, Francis; “Expériences Initiatiques”; 2 Vol.; 416 pp.; Tome II; illus.; 22.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Librairie Verrycken; Antuérpia; Belgium; 1976; pp. 1-274 (Mini-library).

910. LEFEBURE, Francis; “Les Homologies: Architecture Cosmique”; 460 pp.; illus.; 24 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Le Courrier du Livre; Paris; 1978; pp. 190, 269, 283, 304, 305, 311, 313, 333, 342-344, 360, 379.

911. LEFEBURE, Francis; “Respiración Ritmica y Concentración Mental”; 128 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editorial

Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1978; pp. 122-124.

912. LEFEBURE, Francis; “La Respiration et l’Amour”; Inconnues; Lausanne; Switzerland; Magazine; 3rd

Série; Vol. 12; 1956; pp. 146-161.

913. LEFEBURE, Francis; “La Rêverie Dirigée”; Inconnues; Lausanne; Switzerland; Magazine; 3rd Série;

Vol. 14; 1960; pp. 175-181.

914. LENZ, Frederick; “Lifetimes: True Accounts of Reincarnation”; 206 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; The

Bobbs-Merril Co.; New York; 1979; pp. 47, 59-61, 94-96.

915. LEONARD, Gladys Osborn; “The Last Crossing”; Psychic Book Club; London; 1937; pp. 73, 106.

916. LEONARD, Gladys Osborn; “My Life in Two Worlds”; 300 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Cassell & Co.; London;

1931; pp. 23-29.

917. LESLIE, William, and GREEN, Celia Elizabeth; “Ausserköperliche Erfahrunge: wissenschaftlich

erforscht”; transl. E. M. Körner; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 21; N. 5;

May, 1970; pp. 417-419. 918. LESSA, Adelaide Petters; “Precognição”; 392 pp.; illus.; bibl. 381-388; 21 cm; pb.; Livraria Duas

Cidades; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1975; pp. 337, 354.

919. LESTER, Reginald Mounstephens; “In Search of the Hereafter”; XIV + 242 pp.; 20.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Wilfred Funk; New York; 1953; pp. 54-68.

920. LETHBRIDGE, T. C.; “Ghost and Ghoul”; XII + 156 pp.; illus.; alph.; 22 cm; pb.;

2nd print.; Routledge and Kegan Paul; London; 1967; pp. 143-145.

921. LEVINE, Stephen; “Who Dies? An Investigation of Conscious Living and Conscious Dying”; pref.

Ram Dass; XVI + 318 pp.; bibl. 308-310; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Anchor Books; New York; 1982; pp. 277-

280.

922. LÉVRIER, Léon; “Les Forces Médiumniques”; pref. J. Pascal; 88 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.; Nicolas,

Renault & Cie.; Poitiers; France; 1921; pp. 24-31, 54-62.

923. LEWIS, Ioan M.; “Êxtase Religioso”; transl. José Rubens Siqueira de Madureira; 264 pp.; illus.; bibl.

255-259; 20.5 cm; pb.; Editora Perspectiva; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1977; pp. 53, 55, 56, 199-201, 206.

924. LHERMITTE, Jean; “Le Problème des Miracles”; 234 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 6th ed.; Librairie Gallimard;

Paris; 1956; pp. 197-212.

925. LIEF, Harold I.; “Commentary on Dr. Ian Stevenson’s “The Evidence of Man’s Survival After Death”;

The Journal of Nervous and Mental Disease; Baltimore, Maryland; U. S. A.; Vol. 165; N. 3; 1977; bibl. 173; pp. 171-173.

926. LILLY, John Cunningham; “The Center of the Cyclone”; XII + 226 pp.; bibl. 221, 222; 21 cm; hb.; dj.;

The Julian Press; New York; March, 1972; pp. 24-58, 148; eds.: Eng., It., Sp.

927. LILLY, John Cunningham, and LILLY, Antonietta Lena; “The Dyadic Cyclone: The Autobiography

of a Couple”; 252 pp.; illus.; bibl. 246-248; 20 cm; pocket; pb.; Granada Publishing; London; 1978;

pp. 69-77.

928. LIMA, Luiz da Rocha; “Memórias de Um Presidente de Trabalhos”; pres. Paulo da Costa Rzezinski;

708 pp.; illus.; bibl. 707, 708; 27 cm; cart.; Lar de Frei Luiz; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1982; pp. 54, 55.

929. LIMOSIN, Febo de; “Para Hablar con los Espiritus”; 180 pp.; illus.; 20.5 cm; hb.; Publicaciones

Mundial; Barcelona; Spain; 1930; pp. 161-166.

930. LIND, Frank; “My Occult Case Book”; X + 214 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Rider and Co.; London;

1953; pp. 26-41, 118, 128, 206-208, 213.

931. LINEDECKER, Clifford L.; “Country Music Stars and the Supernatural”; 318 pp.; illus.; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Dell Publishing Co.; New York; July, 1979; pp. 284-293.

Page 39: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

932. LINEDECKER, Clifford L.; “Psychic Spy: The Story of an Astounding Man” (Ernesto A.

Montgomery); Biography; XIV + 178 pp.; bibl. 176-178; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Doubleday and Co.; Garden

City, N. Y.; U. S. A.; 1976; pp. 48-58.

933. LINS, Edmar; “Os Fantásticos Caminhos da Parapsicologia”; pref. Joston Miguel Silva; 278 pp.; illus.;

20.5 cm; pb.; Ebrasa; Brasília; Brazil; 1970; pp. 87, 88, 90, 91.

934. LIPPMAN, Caro W.; “Hallucinations of Physical Duality in Migraine”; The Journal of Nervous and

Mental Disease; New York; Vol. 117; N. 4; Serial N. 856; April, 1953;

pp. 345-350. 935. LISBÔA, Roberto; “Primeiros Passos em Metapsíquica”; 274 pp.; illus.; bibl. 271, 272; 23 cm; pb.;

Editor Borsoi; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1955; pp. 202-206.

936. LISCHKA, Alfred; “Durch meine Hölle und Meinen Himmel”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 24; N. 12; December, 1973; illus.; pp. 1104-1109.

937. LISCHKA, Alfred; “Erlebnisse jenseits der Schwelle”; 234 pp.; bibl. 229-234; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Ansata-

Verlag; Schwarzenburg; Switzerland; 1979; pp. 91-180 (Mini-library).

938. LISCHKA, Alfred; “Ich Erkante, dass ich an der Decke Schwebte”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 24; N. 11; November, 1973; illus.; pp. 1001-1005.

939. LLEWELLYN, Editorial Staff; “The Truth About Psychic Attack & Protection”; 28 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

Llewellyn Publications; St. Paul, MN; U. S. A.; 1984; pp. 21, 22.

940. LOBO, Ary Maurell; “Ou a Vida Termina com a Morte, ou com a Morte Começa Outra Vida”;

Ciência Popular; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 11; August, 1949; pp. 1-3.

941. LODGE, Oliver; “The Survival of Man”; XII + 358 pp.; illus.; alph.; 19 cm; hb.; Methuen & Co.;

London; February, 1911; pp. 88, 99-104.

942. LOESTER (Pseud.); “Práticas Esotéricas”; 394 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Editora

O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1923; pp. 32-39.

943. LOMBROSO, Cesare; “After Death - What?”; transl. William Sloane Kennedy; XIV + 364 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; Small, Maynard & Co.; Boston; U. S. A.; 1909; pp. 246-257; eds.: Eng., Ger., It.,

Port.

944. LONDON, Jack; “The Star Rover”; Novel; The Macmillan Co.; London; 1963.

945. LONG, Max Freedom; “Recovering the Ancient Magic”; pref. E. Otha Wingo; 288 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm;

pb.; Huna Press; Cape Giardeau, MO; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 142-146.

946. LONG, Max Freedom; “The Secret Science at Work”; 344 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; De Vorss & Co.;

Marina del Rey, Cal.; U. S. A.; no date; pp. 33-60.

947. LONG, Max Freedom; “The Secret Science Behind Miracles”; 408 pp.; illus.; glos. 407, 408; alph.; 21

cm; pb.; 13rd print.; De Vorss & Co.; Publishers; Marina Del Rey, Cal.;

U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 104, 110, 111, 127, 148-152, 154, 158, 172, 200-204, 213-215, 261, 287-291, 378,

379; eds.: Eng., Port.

948. LORENZ, Francisco Valdomiro; “Chamas de Ódio e a Luz do Puro Amor”; 180 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm;

pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1983; pp. 38, 39, 177-179.

949. LORENZ, Francisco Valdomiro; “O Filho de Zanoni”; Novel; 234 pp.; 23 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Empresa

Editora O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1943; p. 171.

950. LORENZ, Francisco Valdomiro; “Lições Práticas de Ocultismo Utilitário”; 282 pp.; 18 cm; hb.;

Editora O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1942; pp. 227-231. 951. LORENZ, Francisco Valdomiro; “Raios de Luz Espiritual: Ensinos Esotéricos”; 198 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.;

Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1973; pp. 44, 72.

952. LORENZATTO, José; “Parapsicologia e Religião: Alguns Aspectos da Mística

à Luz da Ciência”; pres. Oscar González-Quevedo; 200 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Edições Loyola;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1979; pp. 142-153.

953. L’ORNE, Mme. Asa; “Chloroformed but Conscious”; Bordeland; London; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. I;

N. VI; October, 1894; pp. 564, 565.

954. LUCAS, Dean; “The Jung-Jaffé View of Out-of-body Experiences” (Robert Crookall); Books

Reviews; Theta; Durham; North Carolina; U. S. A.; N. 38; Winter, 1973; pp. 6-8.

955. LUCKNER, Udo Oscar; “A Lenda de Araés”; 110 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Imery Publicações; Goiânia,

GO; Brazil; 1983; pp. 69, 70.

956. LUDWIG, Arnold M.; “Altered States of Consciousness”; Archives General of Psychiatry; Vol. 15;

September, 1966; bibl. 233, 234; pp. 225-234.

Page 40: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

957. LUKIANOWICZ, N.; “Autoscopic Phenomena”; American Medical Association Archives of

Neurology and Psychiatry; Vol. 80; August, 1958; bibl. 218-220; pp. 199-220.

958. LUNA, Roso de; “O Livro que Mata a Morte”; transl. and pres. Edmundo Cardillo; 298 pp.; 20 cm;

hb.; Editora Três; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1973; pp. 122, 158, 229-232, 291, 292.

959. LURDAHL, Craig R.; “A Collection of Near-Death Research Readings”; Anthology; pref. Raymond

A. Moody Jr.; XVI + 240 pp.; 22.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Nelson-Hall Publishers; Chicago, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1982.

960. LUTYENS, Mary; “Krishnamurti: Os Anos do Despertar”; Biography; transl. Octavio Mendes Cajado;

302 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Cultrix; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1978; pp. 22, 25, 38, 43-49, 163, 174. 961. LYRA, Alberto; “O Ensino dos Mahatmas”; 278 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Ibrasa;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1977; pp. 128, 129.

962. LYRA, Alberto; “O Inconsciente, a Magia e o Diabo no Século XX”; 294 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 204-249.

963. LYRA, Alberto; “Parapsicologia e Inconsciente Coletivo”; 176 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1970; pp. 14, 15.

964. LYRA, Alberto; “Parapsicologia, Psiquiatria, Religião”; 186 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S.

Paulo; Brazil; 1968; pp. 86-90.

965. M; “Dioses Atomicos”; 222 pp.; illus.; glos. 215-217; 20 cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires;

Argentina; 1950; pp. 101-103.

966. MACDOUGALL, Curtis D.; “Superstition and the Press”; XII + 616 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; pb.;

Prometheus Books; Buffalo, N. Y.; U. S. A.; 1983; pp. 117-121, 324, 360, 527, 529, 546, 555.

967. MACHADO, Brasilio Marcondes; “Contribuição ao Estudo da Psiquiatria, Espiritismo e

Metapsiquismo”; Thesis; 272 pp.; illus.; bibl. 266-269; 22 cm; hb.; Author’s Edition; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; 1922; pp. 94-96.

968. MACHADO, Mário Amaral; “Os Fenômenos Paranormais de Thomas Green”; 154 pp.; illus.; 21 cm;

pb.; Editora Tecnoprint; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1984; pp. 15-23, 58. 969. MACHADO, Ubiratan Paulo; “Os Intelectuais e o Espiritismo”; pref. Salim Miguel; 242 pp.; illus.;

bibl. 233-240; 21 cm; pb.; Edições Antares; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 65, 66, 207, 208.

970. MACKENZIE, Andrew; “Hauntings and Apparitions”; introd. Brian Inglis; XVIII

+ 270 pp.; illus.; bibl. 258-265; alph.; 20 cm; pb.; Granada Publishing; London; 1983; pp. 7, 31, 242,

243.

971. MACKLIN, John; “Passaporte para o Desconhecido”; transl. Hélio Pólvora; 134 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 87, 88.

972. MACKINTOSH, William Hunter; “Did He Dream His Past Incarnation?”; Psychic News; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2436; February 10, 1979; p. 2.

973. MACKINTOSH, William Hunter; “Doctor Takes Astral Flight to Earth’s Bowels”; Psychic News;

London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2178; March 2, 1974; p. 2.

974. MACKINTOSH, William Hunter; “The Essence of Espiritualism”; 62 pp.; 22 cm; Gerrard’s Cross,

Smythe; London; 1973.

975. MACKINTOSH, William Hunter; “Famous Medium Describes Her Other-World Visits”; Psychic

News; London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2241; May 17, 1975; p. 2.

976. MACKINTOSH, William Hunter; “His Astral Travel is in Space and Time”; Psychic News; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2219; December 14, 1974; p. 2. 977. MACKINTOSH, William Hunter; “How You can Become Astral Traveller”; Psychic News; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2308; August 28, 1976; p. 2.

978. MACKINTOSH, William Hunter; “She Left Her Body and Entered the Atom”; Psychic News;

London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2451; May 26, 1979; illus.; p. 2.

979. MACKINTOSH, William Hunter; “What Causes Astral Body to Travel?”; Psychic News; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2520; September 27, 1980; p. 2.

980. MACLAINE, Shirley; “Minhas Vidas”; Autobiography; transl. A. B. Pinheiro de Lemos; 318 pp.; 21

cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 9, 151-153, 169, 170, 192, 284-287.

981. MADDELEY, Peter; “Events on the Threshold of the After-Life” (Robert Crookall); Books Reviews;

Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 44; N. 735; March, 1968; pp. 259, 260.

982. MADDOCK, Peter; “London Parascience Conference”; Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. II;

N. 66; November-December, 1980; pp. 15-18.

983. MAES, Hercílio; “Elucidações do Além”; prfr. José Fuzeira; 194 pp.; illus.; 22.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Livraria Freitas Bastos; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1975; pp. 145, 148, 151, 164, 165, 167, 168, 185, 188.

Page 41: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

984. MAES, Hercílio; “Mediunismo”; 244 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Livraria Freitas Bastos; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; 1978; pp. 85-88.

985. MAES, Hercílio; “Semeando e Colhendo”; 274 pp.; 23.5 cm; pb.; Livraria Freitas Bastos; Rio de

Janeiro; Brazil; 1967; pp. 32, 82, 184.

986. MAES, Hercílio; “A Sobrevivência do Espírito”; 254 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Livraria Freitas Bastos;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978; pp. 184-194.

987. MAES, Hercílio; “A Vida Além da Sepultura”; 288 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Livraria Freitas Bastos;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; p. 6. 988. MAETERLINCK, Maurice; “L’Hôte Inconnu”; VIII + 326 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Eugène Fasquelle, Éditeur;

Paris; 1917; pp. 15-18; eds.: Fr., Sp.

989. MAGRE, Maurice; “Les Interventions Surnaturelles”; 252 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Fasquelle Éditeurs; Paris;

23, March, 1939; pp. 145-150, 205.

990. MAHONY, Patrick; “Out of Silence: A Book of Factual Fantasies”; 180 pp.; Storm; New York; 1948.

991. MALLORY, Lucy A. Rose; Editora; “The World’s Advance Thought: The Avant-Courier of the New

Spiritual Dispensation”; Vol. 28; N. 9; New Series; October, 1917.

992. MALZ, Betty P.; “My Glimpse of Eternity”; 130 pp.; 17.5 cm; pocket; pb.; Berkeley Books; New

York; April, 1980; pp. 81-87; eds.: Eng., Port.

993. MANNING, Al G.; “Aproveite o Seu Poder Psicocósmico”; transl. Eduardo Brandão; 240 pp.; 21 cm;

pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 153-162.

994. MANNING, Matthew; “Un Fenómeno Paranormal”; transl. Ramón Ibero; pref. Peter Bander; introd.

Derek G. Manning; 232 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; hb.; dj.; Ediciones Matínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1976;

pp. 25, 85, 89, 93; eds.: Eng., Sp.

995. MARCO, Felice; “La Mecanica Dello Spiritismo”; 156 pp.; 20.5 cm; hb.; Ditta

G. B. Paravia e Co.; Torino; Italy; 1909; pp. 66-70.

996. MARIN, Cesar Camargo y; “Psico-Analisis del Sueño Profetico”; prol. Quintiliano Saldaña; 328 pp.; bibl. 303-318; 18 cm; hb.; M. Aguilar, Editor; Madrid; Spain; 1929; pp. 98, 118-128, 148.

997. MARINHO, Iracema; “Cartas para o Além”; 1st Vol.; 178 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Elyas; Rio de

Janeiro; Brazil; 1982; pp. 83, 84.

998. MARINUZZI, Raul; “Parapsicologia Didática”; introd. Vinicius de Carvalho; 182 pp.; illus.; glos.

171-181; 21 cm; pb.; Livraria Freitas Bastos; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1977; p. 171.

999. MARQUES, América Paoliello; “Estrutura da Personalidade em Sujeitos Sensitivos e Não-

Sensitivos”; 50 pp.; bibl. 30, 31; 21 cm; pb.; Gráfica Editora Karnac; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; p. 3.

1000. MARRICK, Sergivan Du (Pseud. for Hernani Guimarães Andrade); “A Sobrevivência da

Personalidade Após a Morte do Corpo Físico”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly;

Yr. II; N. 13; April, 1975; p. 6 (See N. 27-30).

1001. MARRYAT, Florence; “There is no Death”; 248 pp.; 24 cm; hb.; dj.; Causeway Books; New

York; 1973; pp. 35-47.

1002. MARTIN, Anthony; “The Theory and Practice of Astral Projection: Exploration in a World

Beyond the Body”; 96 pp.; bibl. 93-95; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; The Aquarian Press; London; 1980; pp. 1-96;

eds.: Eng., Sp. (Mini-library).

1003. MARTIN, B. W.; “The Dictionary of the Occult”; 140 pp.; 23.5 cm; pb.; Rider and Co.; London;

1979; pp. 22, 23, 86, 87. 1004. MARTIN, Malachi; “Hostage to the Devil”; 480 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Reader’s Digest Press;

New York; 1976; pp. 352-355; eds.: Eng., Port.

1005. MARTINS, Celso; “A Delicada Questão da Vida”; 134 pp.; bibl. 119; alph.; 20.5 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.;

Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; June, 1979; pp. 97, 98.

1006. MARTINS, Celso; “A Obsessão e seu Tratamento Espírita”; 176 pp.; bibl. 65, 66, 124, 174, 175;

21 cm; pb.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; May, 1982; pp. 25-32, 162, 163, 165, 166.

1007. MARTINS, Celso; “Ocorrências no Mundo Espiritual”; Desobsessão; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil;

Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XXXIII; N. 403; September, 1981; p. 7.

1008. MARTINS, Edílson; “Seita do Santo Daime Usa em Rituais Alucinógeno Amazônico”; Jornal do

Brasil; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Daily; Yr. XCIII; N. 212; 6, November, 1983; illus.; p. 16.

1009. MARTINS, Romualdo Joaquim; “Memórias de Um Médium”; pref. Derna Rosa; 186 pp.; 22 cm;

pb.; no publisher; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1964; pp. 95-97.

1010. MARX, Monique; Anthology; “L’Infini Sursis on de l’Autre Côté de la Vie”; 318 pp.; illus.; bibl.

314-316; 24 cm; pb.; Claude Tchou; Paris; 1979; pp. 27, 28, 31, 107-110, 158.

Page 42: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1011. MASON, Peggy; “I Visit the Animal Spirit Realms”; Two Worlds; London; Magazine; Monthly;

82nd Year; N. 3897; October, 1968; pp. 292-296.

1012. MASTERS, R. E. L., and HOUSTON, Jean; “The Varieties of Psychedelic Experience”; 326 pp.;

22 cm; hb.; dj.; 2nd ed.; Turnstorne Books; London; 1973; pp. 85-87, 114-117.

1013. MATSON, Katinka; “The Encyclopaedia of Reality”; 362 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Granada Publishing;

London; 1979; pp. 38-40.

1014. MATTER, M.; “Emanuel Swedenborg: Sa Vie, Ses Écrits et Sa Doctrine”; Biography; XVI + 436

pp.; 22 cm; hb.; Didier et Cie., Librairies-Éditeurs; Paris; 1863; pp. 98, 109, 110, 145, 232, 366. 1015. MATTOS, Idalinda A.; “Desdobramento Materializado”; A Flama Espírita; Uberaba, MG; Brazil;

Newspaper; Weekly; Yr. XXXV; N. 2.502; 20, November, 1982; p. 3.

1016. MAUSS, Marcel; “A General Theory of Magic”; transl. Robert Brain; pref. David Pocock; 148

pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1972; pp. 34, 35, 122, 123.

1017. MAXWELL, Joseph; “Les Phénomènes Psychiques”; pref. Charles Robert Richet; 320 pp.; 21.5

cm; hb.; 6th ed.; Librairie Félix Alcan; Paris; 1920; pp. 190, 224, 298-301.

1018. MC ADAMS, Elizabeth E.; & BAYLESS, Raymond; “The Case for Life After Death:

Parapsychologists Hook at the Evidence”; 158 pp.; bibl. 151-153; alph.; Nelson-Hall; Chicago, Ill.; U.

S. A.; 1981.

1019. MC CONNELL, R. A.; Editor; “Encounters With Parapsychology”; 236 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; Author’s

Edition; Pittsburgh, PA; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 75, 76, 169.

1020. MC CREERY, Charles; “Psychical Phenomena and the Physical World”; introd. George Joy; 138

pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Hamish Hamilton; London; 1973; pp. 9, 17, 31-42, 49, 104-106, 118-132.

1021. MC HARG, James F.; “Journeys Out of the Body” (Robert Monroe); Books Reviews; Journal of

the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 47; N. 755; March, 1973;

pp. 48-52.

1022. MC INTOSH, Alastair I.; “Beliefs About Out-of-the-Body Experiences Among the Elema, Gulf Kamea, and Rigo Peoples of Papua, New Guinea”; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research;

London; Vol. 50; N. 785; September, 1980; illus.; bibl.; pp. 460-478.

1023. MC RAE, Ronald; “Mind Wars: The True Story of Government Research Into the Military

Potential of Psychic Weapons”; introd. Marcello Truzzi; 156 pp.; bibl. 139-150; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.;

St. Martin’s Press; New York; 1984; pp. 27, 52.

1024. MEAD, George Robert Stow; “Apolonio de Tyana”; transl. Julio González; pref. Rafael Urbano;

142 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Editorial Dedalo; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977; pp. 106, 107.

1025. MEAD, George Robert Stow; “The Subtle Body in Western Tradition”; 110 pp.; 18.5 cm; cart.;

Stuart & Watkins; London; 1967; pp. 33-55.

1026. MECK, M. de; “Esotérisme & Survie: Études d’un Mystique Moderne”; 282 pp.; 19.5 cm; hb.;

Éditions Drouin; Paris; no date; pp. 256-260.

1027. MECK, M. de; “Métapsychisme et Occultisme”; 296 pp.; bibl. 287-294; 23 cm; pb.; Librairie A.

M. Beaudelot; Paris; 1928; pp. 126, 127, 153, 154.

1028. MEEK, George W.; Organizator; “As Curas Paranormais: Como se Processam”; Anthology;

transl. Syomara Cajado; 364 pp.; illus.; bibl. 280-282, 352-354; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S.

Paulo; Brazil; 1984; pp. 8, 97, 98, 228, 234, 244-254, 324, 327.

1029. MEEK, George W.; “From Enigma to Science”; introd. Kelvin Spencer; 200 pp.; illus.; bibl. 182-194; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Samuel Weiser; New York; 1974; pp. 188, 189.

1030. MEEK, George W.; “O Que nos Espera Depois da Morte?”; transl. Gilberto Campista Guarino;

190 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 41, 42, 55-60, 115, 152,

160.

1031. MEISHU-SAMA; “Alicerce do Paraíso”; without translator; 5 Vol.; 604 pp.; 17 cm; hb.; Funda-

ção Mokiti Okada; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981; 3rd Vol.: pp. 36, 55, 110, 111; 4th Vol.: pp. 108, 109; eds.:

Jpn., Port.

1032. MELLO, Wilson Ferreira de; “Medicina e Espiritismo”; Boletim Médico-Espírita; S. Paulo;

Brazil;Yr. I; N. 1; March, 1984; bibl. 45, 46; pp. 34-46.

1033. MENDES, Eliezer Cerqueira; “Personalidade Hiperconsciente”; 122 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Author’s

Edition; Bahia; Brazil; 1977; pp. 31-39.

1034. MENDES, Eliezer Cerqueira; “Psicotranse: Terapia dos Distúrbios Mentais e Psicossomáticos”;

154 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1980; pp.37-41, 58, 59.

Page 43: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1035. MENZEL, Hedda; “Spontane und Experimentelle Austritte des Astralkörpers”; Esotera; Freiburg;

Alemanha Ocidental; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 23; N. 10; October, 1972; illus.; pp. 877-881.

1036. MERCIER, Mario; “Chamanisme et Chamans: Le Vécu dans L’Expéricence Magique”; 182 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 179, 180; 22.5 cm; pb.; Pierre Belfond; Paris; 1977; pp. 22, 25, 147-169.

1037. MESQUITA, José Marques; “Elucidário de “Evolução em Dois Mundos”; pres. Roque Jacintho;

304 pp.; bibl. 282, 283; alph.; 14 cm; pb.; Edições Culturesp; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1984;

p. 221.

1038. METZGER, D.; “Essai de Spiritisme Scientifique”; 456 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Librairie des Sciences Psychologiques; Paris; 1894; pp. 124-166.

1039. MEUROIS-GIVAUDAN, Anne, et MEUROIS-GIVAUDAN, Daniel; “Récits d’un Voyageur de

l’Astral”; Novel; 284 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Éditions Arista; Paris; 1983;

pp. 1-284.

1040. M. F. R. C.; “Diccionario Rosacruz”; 158 pp.; 19.5 cm; hb.; Editoral Kier; Buenos Aires;

Argentina; 1971; pp. 20-22, 36-38, 47.

1041. MICHAËL, Tara; “O Yoga”; transl. Raul Bezerra Pedreira Filho and Suzana Joffily Cruz; pref.

Jacques Maui; 194 pp.; illus.; bibl. 185-187; 21 cm; pb.; Zahar Editores; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1976;

pp. 50, 51, 94, 95, 102-105.

1042. MICHAELUS (Pseud. for Miguel Timponi); “Magnetismo Espiritual”; 308 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 2nd

ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1967; pp. 278-281.

1043. MICHEL, Aimé; “Deslocar Sem o Corpo”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 9;

May, 1973; pp. 72-85.

1044. MICKAHARIC, Draja; “Spiritual Cleansing: A Handbook of Psychic Protection”; 98 pp.; illus.;

alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Samuel Weiser; York Beach, Maine; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 20-26.

1045. MIGUEL, Alfredo; “Fenômenos Espíritas e Anímicos”; 152 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Edições Feesp; S.

Paulo; Brazil; 1981; pp. 40, 41, 45-63, 90. 1046. MINOR, Elaine; “Gateway to the Unknown”; VIII + 182 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.;

3rd print.; Sanai Publications; Los Angeles, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 62-66.

1047. MIRANDA, Hermínio Correa de; “O Desdobramento e a Rejeição da Morte”; Obreiros do Bem;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; March, 1976; pp. 2, 3.

1048. MIRANDA, Hermínio Correa de; “Diálogo com as Sombras: Teoria e Prática da Doutrinação”;

pref. Francisco Thiesen; 290 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

September, 1979; pp. 40, 51, 101, 108, 116, 132, 147, 170, 176, 183, 198, 200, 247, 263, 273-285.

1049. MIRANDA, Hermínio Correa de; “As Marcas do Cristo”; pres. Francisco Thiesen; 2 Vol.; 538

pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; Vol.

I: pp. 91, 92, 134, 189, 213, 245; Vol. II: pp. 125, 162, 242.

1050. MIRANDA, Hermínio Correa de; “A Memória e o Tempo”; 2 Vol.; 336 pp.; illus.; bibl. 149-153;

21 cm; pb.; Editora Cultural Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1982 / 1984; Vol. I: pp. 33, 56, 68, 77-80, 85,

87, 89-92, 101, 103, 117-120, 132-139, 151, 164-167, 172, 175, 176; Vol. II: pp. 13, 14, 17, 53, 58, 70,

74, 78, 79, 88, 93, 96-102, 104-107, 121, 122, 125.

1051. MIRANDA, Hermínio Correa de; “Reencarnação e Imortalidade”; pref. Gilberto Campista

Guarino; 322 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1976;

pp. 44, 55, 56, 103, 104, 113-116, 126, 127, 133, 176, 177, 187, 203, 204, 214, 241, 265, 295, 310, 311.

1052. MIRANDA, Hermínio Correa de; “Sobrevivência e Comunicabilidade dos Espíritos”; pref.

Francisco Thiesen; 318 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1977; pp.

39-59, 71-73, 77, 78, 160, 161, 175, 181, 182, 190, 191, 196, 197, 200-211, 278.

1053. MIRANDA, Hermínio Correa de; “Uma Revisão dos Ensinos de Swedenborg” (Stella Myers);

Book Review; Reformador; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 79; Vol. 79; N. 8, 9, 10;

August-October, 1961; pp. 179-181, 207-209, 234-236.

1054. MIRCLAIR, Francis de; “Le “Démon” Spirite: Cours Pratique de Médiumnité”; 232 pp.; 18.5 cm;

pb.; Éditions Fulgor; Paris; 1922; pp. 125-133.

1055. MISHLOVE, Jeffrey; “The Roots of Consciousness”; XXXIV + 348 pp.; illus.; bibl. 323-336;

alph.; 27.5 cm; pb.; Random House; New York; May, 1979; pp. XXIX, 126-138.

1056. MISRAKI, Paul; “L’Expérience de L’Après-Vie”; 268 pp.; bibl. 263-267; 21.5 cm; pb.; Éditions

Robert Laffont; Paris; 1974; pp. 21, 51.

Page 44: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1057. MITCHELL, Edgar D.; “O Astronauta do Espaço Interior”; without translator; Interview with

Alan Vaughan; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Special number; 1983; illus.; pp. 24-29.

1058. MITCHELL, Edgard D.; “Psychic Exploration: A Challenge for Science”; Anthology; Editor:

John White; 708 pp.; illus.; alph.; 20 cm; pb.; Paragon Books; New York; 1979;

pp. 348-373.

1059. MITCHELL, Janet Lee; “Out-of-Body Experiences: A Handbook”; pref. Gertrude Schmeidler;

XII + 128 pp.; bibl.; alph.; Mc Farland & Co.; Jefferson, N. C.; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. I-XII, 1-128 (Mini-

library). 1060. MITCHELL, Janet Lee; “Out of the Body Vision”; Psychic Magazine; U. S. A.; March-April,

1973; illus.; pp. 44-47.

1061. MITTL, John; “Astral Projection: Modus Operandi”; 10 pp.; 28 cm; pb.; Health Research;

Mokelumne Hill, Cal.; U. S. A.; 1960; pp. 1-10.

1062. MIYAMOTO, H.; “Aparición de um Encarnado”; Conocimiento; Buenos Aires; Argentina;

Magazine; Monthly; N. 385, 386; Enero, 1970.

1063. MOLINERO (Yogakrisnanda); “O Segredo da Múmia”; introd. Edmundo Cardillo; 168 pp.; 21

cm; pb.; Editora Mandala; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1975; pp. 8, 22-24, 28, 29, 32, 33, 61, 104, 113, 114, 121,

122, 142, 149-151, 154, 159, 164-167.

1064. MONROE, Robert Allan; “Dort, wo Man zu Hause ist”; without translator; Esotera; Freiburg;

West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 23; N. 12; December, 1972; pp. 1063, 1064.

1065. MONROE, Robert Allan; “Journeys Out of the Body”; New Foreword; epil. Stuart W. Twemlow;

280 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.; new ed. updated; Anchor Press; New York; 1977; pp. 1-280; eds.: Eng., Ger.,

It., Port. (Mini-library).

1066. MONS, W. E. R.; “Beyond Mind”; 256 pp.; bibl. 233-247; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Rider & Co.;

London; 1983; pp. 56, 57, 99, 194.

1067. MONTANDON, H. C. Raoul; “De la Bête a L’Homme”; 370 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.; Éditions Victor Attinger; Paris; Juillet, 1943; pp. 229-240.

1068. MONTANDON, H. C. Raoul; “Formes Matérialisées”; 324 pp.; illus.; 22.5 cm; pb.; Éditions

Victor Attinger; Paris; 1946; pp. 15-25.

1069. MONTANDON, H. C. Raoul; “Maisons et Lieux Hantés”; 230 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; La Diffusion

Scientifique; Paris; 1953; pp. 171-194.

1070. MONTANDON, H. C. Raoul; “La Mort Cette Inconnue”; 396 pp.; bibl. 365-393; 23 cm; pb.;

Éditions Victor Attinger; Paris; 1948; pp. 224-287.

1071. MONTANDON, H. C. Raoul; “Les Radiations Humaines”; 460 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; pb.; Librairie

Félix Alcan; Paris; 1927; pp. 9, 10, 47.

1072. MONTEITH, Mary E.; “A Book of True Dreams”; 220 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Heath Cranton;

London; 1929; pp. 47-55, 77, 100, 198, 203.

1073. MONTEITH, Mary E.; “The Fringe of Immortality”; introd. Abraham Wallace; XVI + 204 pp.;

17.5 cm; hb.; John Murray; London; 1920; pp. 6, 15-20, 146, 195.

1074. MONTGOMERY, Ruth; “Strangers Among Us”; 256 pp.; 17.5 cm; pocket; pb.;

2nd print.; Fawcett Crest; New York; June, 1983; pp. 112, 113.

1075. MOODY JR., Raymond A.; “O Outro Lado da Existência”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine;

Monthly; N. 118-A; July, 1982; illus.; pp. 4-9. 1076. MOODY JR., Raymond A.; “Reflections on Life After Life”; 150 pp.; bibl. 147, 148; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Bantam Books; New York; March, 1978; pp. 15-18.

1077. MOODY JR., Raymond A.; “Testemunhas dos que Foram e Voltaram”; Jornal do Brasil; Rio de

Janeiro; Brazil; Daily; Section B; 8, August, 1977; illus.; p. 10.

1078. MOODY JR., Raymond A.; “Vida Depois da Vida”; transl. Rodolfo Azzi; pref. Elisabeth Kübler-

Ross; 154 pp.; 17 cm; pocket; pb.; 3rd ed.; Edibolso; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 33-81, 123, 130,

131; eds.: Eng., Fr., It., Port.

1079. MOORE, Brooke Noel; “The Philosophical Possibilities Beyond Death”; 222pp.; bibl. 206-213;

alph.; Charles C. Thomas; Springfield, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1981.

1080. MOORE, Evelyn Garth; “Try the Spirits”; 132 pp.; bibl. 123-126; Oxford University Press; New

York; 1977.

1081. MOORE, Marcia; “Hypersentience”; XIV + 304 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Bantam Books; New

York; August, 1977; p. 161.

Page 45: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1082. MOORE, Marcia, and DOUGLAS, Mark; “Yoga, Science of the Self”; pref. Shepard Guiandes;

XVI + 318 pp.; illus.; glos. 273-277; bibl. 281-285; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

2nd ed.; Arcane Publications; York Harbor, Maine; U. S. A.; 1969; pp. 91, 101, 213, 217-220, 273,

285.

1083. MOORE, Marcia, and ALLTOUNIAN, Howard Sunny; “Journeys Into the Bright World”; 184

pp.; bibl. 183, 184; 23 cm; pb.; Para Research; Rockport, Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1978; pp. 43, 139-

143, 155.

1084. MORATO, Agnelo; “Ibne: A História de um Jovem que Venceu a Morte”; pref. José Ferreira Carrato; 216 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Edições Correio Fraterno; S. Bernardo do Campo, SP; Brazil;

March, 1984; pp. 145-150.

1085. MOREIRA, Zair de Figueiredo; “Luzes na Penumbra”; 200 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; pb.; Gráfica Mundo

Espírita; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1945; pp. 44-46.

1086. MOREL, Hector V., and MORAL, José Dali; “Diccionario de Parapsicología”; 206 pp.; bibl. 201-

204; 23 cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1977; p. 41.

1087. MORRANNIER, Jeanne; “La Science et l’Esprit”; 220 pp.; 22 cm; pb.; Éditions Fernand Lanore;

Paris; 1983; p. 20.

1088. MORRELL, Edward; “The Twenty-fifth Man”; New Era Publishing Co.; Montclair, N. J.; U. S.

A.; 1924.

1089. MORRIS, Robert L.; “PRF Research on Out-of-Body Experiences 1973”; Theta; Durham, North

Carolina; U. S. A.; Magazine; Quarterly; N. 41; Summer, 1974; pp. 1-3.

1090. MORRIS, Robert L.; “An Experimental Approach to the Survival Problem”; Theta; Durham,

North Carolina; U. S. A.; Magazine; N. 33, 34; Fall, 1971; Winter, 1972; bibl.;

pp. 1-8.

1091. MORRIS, Robert L.; HARARY, Stuart Keith; JANIS, Joseph-Hartwell; John;

& ROLL, William G.; “Studies of Communication During Out-of-Body Experiences”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 72; N. 1; January, 1978; bibl. 20, 21;

pp. 1-21.

1092. MORRIS, J. D.; ROLL, William G.; and MORRIS, Robert L.; Editors; “Research in

Parapsychology 1974”; Anthology; 266 pp.; glos. 229-231; index of names; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The

Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1975; pp. 5, 53-56, 111, 122-133, 190, 191.

1093. MORRIS, J. D.; ROLL, William G.; and MORRIS, Robert L.; Editors; “Research in

Parapsychology 1975”; Anthology; 278 pp.; glos. 243-245; index of names; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The

Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1976; pp. 102-106, 147-150, 229, 244.

1094. MORRIS, J. D.; ROLL, William G.; and MORRIS, Robert L.; Editors; “Research in

Parapsychology 1976”; Anthology; 286 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N.

J.; U. S. A.; 1977; pp. 57-59, 62, 185.

1095. MOSER, Robert E.; “Mental and Astral Projection”; 60 pp.; 21.5 cm; cart.; Esoteric Publications;

Cottonwood, AZ; U. S. A.; 1974; pp. 1-60.

1096. MOSS, Thelma; “The Body Electric”; 256 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; pocket; pb.; Granada Publishing;

London; 1981; pp. 51, 133, 196-198, 209, 215, 244.

1097. MOSS, Thelma; “The Probability of the Impossible”; 410 pp.; illus.; bibl. 389-404; alph.; 20.5

cm; pb.; New American Library; New York; October, 1975; pp. 278-304; eds.: Eng., It. 1098. MOTOYAMA, Hiroshi; “Theories of the Chakras: Bridge to Higher Consciousness”; introd.

Satyananda Saraswati; 294 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; The Theosophical Publishing House;

Wheaton, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 204, 205, 245, 246, 254.

1099. MOUSSEAUX, Gougenot des; “Les Médiateurs et les Moyens de la Magie, le Fantôme Humain

et le Principe Vital”; Plon Éditeurs; 1863.

1100. MOUTIN, L.; Le Magnétisme Humain”; 478 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; Perrin et Cie., Librairies-Éditeurs;

Paris; 1907; pp. 367-400.

1101. MOUTIN, L.; “The Relations Between Magnetism and Spiritism”; The Two Worlds; Manchester;

England; Newspaper; Weekly; Vol. XI; N. 557; July 15, 1898; pp. 463-465.

1102. MULDOON, Sylvan Joseph; “The Case for Astral Projection”; 174 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; 2nd print.;

The Aries Press; Chicago, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1936; pp. 1-174.

1103. MULDOON, Sylvan Joseph, and CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “The Phenomena

of Astral Projection”; 222 pp.; illus.; bibl. 221, 222; 21 cm; pb.; Samuel Weiser; New York; 1974; pp.

1-222; eds.: Eng., Fr., Sp.

Page 46: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1104. MULDOON, Sylvan Joseph; “Psychic Experiences of Famous People”; XVI + 204 pp.; 21 cm;

hb.; dj.; The Aries Press; Chicago, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1947; pp. 168-172.

1105. MULDOON, Sylvan Joseph, and CARRINGTON, Hereward Hubert Levington; “The Projection

of the Astral Body”; 320 pp.; illus.; alph.; 22 cm; pb.; 6th print.; Rider & Co.; London; 1977; pp. 1-

320; eds.: Eng., Fr., Sp., Port., Ger. (Mini-library).

1106. MULFORD, Prentice; “Nossas Forças Mentais”; without translator; 4 Vol.; 830 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.;

Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1984; Vol. I: pp. 16-24, 27-30, 33.

1107. MÜLLER, Karl E.; “Reencarnação Baseada em Fatos”; transl. Harry Meredig; pres. Hernani Guimarães Andrade; prol. Ella Sheridan; 298 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Difusora Cultural; S. Paulo;

Brazil; October, 1978; pp. 76, 81, 99, 108, 110-113, 130-132, 146, 158, 171, 173-177, 180, 181, 185,

200, 232, 235, 239, 240, 243, 252-262, 276, 283, 285, 291, 293.

1108. MUNTAÑOLA, J. Roca; “Viaje al Antiuniverso: El Viaje Astral”; 176 pp.; glos.; 165-171; bibl.

172; 21 cm; cart.; Editorial Alas; Barcelona; Spain; 1974; pp. 1-176 (Mini-library).

1109. MURPHET, Howard; “Sai Baba: Man of Miracles”; Biography; 212 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.;

Samuel Weiser; York Beach, Maine; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 13, 112, 113, 138, 139,

142-144, 151, 172-174.

1110. MURPHY, Joseph; “Energia Cósmica: O Poder Milagroso do Universo”; transl.

A. B. Pinheiro de Lemos; 272 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp.

246-248.

1111. MURPHY, Joseph; “A Magia do Poder Extra-Sensorial”; transl. João Távora; 214 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

8th ed; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; pp. 55-66.

1112. MURPHY, G., and BALLOU, R. O.; “William James on Psychical Research”; 340 pp.; Viking

Press; New York; 1969.

1113. MURPHY, Michael, and WHITE, Rhea Amelia; “The Psychic Side of Sports”; 228 pp.; illus.;

Addison-Wesley; Reading, Mass.; U. S. A.; 1978; pp. 1-3. 1114. MYERS, Frederic William Henry; “Human Personality and his Survival of Bodily Death”; 2 Vol.;

1.426 pp.; glos. XIII-XXII; alph.; 24 cm; hb.; new print.; Longmans, Green, and Co.; London; 1920;

Vol I: pp. XV, XVII, 121-152, 220-297, 369-436; eds.: Eng., It., Sp., Port. (Mini-library).

1115. MYERS, Stella; “Herein Know Thyself”; 178 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; John Wadsworth; Keighley;

Yorkshire; Great Britain; no date; pp. 56-59, 65, 66.

1116. NAILLEN, A. Van der; “Nos Templos do Himalaia”; without translator; 254 pp.; 18.5 cm; 7th

ed.; Empresa Editora O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 83, 84, 87-89, 159.

1117. NAPIER, Alice; “Zeitplan geändertl”; transl. E. M. Körner; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 23; N. 3; March, 1972; pp. 263, 264.

1118. NEBEL, Long John, with TELLER, Sanford M.; “The Psychic World Around Us”; introd.

Jacqueline Susann; 192 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; New American Library; New York; March, 1970; pp.

26, 105-122.

1119. NEECH, W. F.; “O Homem que Conheceu o Espírito do Universo antes de Morrer”; Estudos

Psíquicos; Lisboa; Portugal; Magazine; Monthly; 20th Yr.; February, 1959;

pp. 34-36.

1120. NEFF, Mary K.; “Personal Memoirs of H. P. Blavatsky”; 322 pp.; illus.; bibl. 312; alph.; 20.5 cm;

pb.; 2nd print.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton, Ill.; U. S. A.; 1971; pp. 122, 123.

1121. NEIHARDT, John G.; “Black Elk Speaks”; XVIII + 238 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.;

Washington Square Press; New York; 1972; pp. 204-208.

1122. NEPPE, Vernon M.; “The Psychology of Déjà Vu”; introd. Lewis A. Hurst; 278 pp.; glos. 248-

255; bibl. 256-267; index of names; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Witwatersrand University Press; Johannesburg;

South Africa; 1983; pp. 23, 40, 41, 44.

1123. NEPPE, Vernon M.; “Temporal Lobe Symptomatology in Subjetive Paranormal Experiments”;

The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; Vol. 77; N. 1; January, 1983; bibl. 14,

15; pp.1-29.

1124. NESTLER, Vincenzo; “A Telepatia”; transl. Fernanda Figueira; 182 pp.; illus.; bibl. 165-179;

21.5 cm; pb.; Edições 70; Lisboa; Portugal; September, 1979; pp. 107-110.

1125. NETTO, Aureliano Alves; “Extraordinárias Curas Espirituais”; pref. Celso Martins; 126 pp.; 21

cm; pb.; Editora Eco; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 77-79.

Page 47: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1126. NETTO, Aureliano Alves; “Extraordinários Fenômenos Espíritas”; pref. Celso Martins; 186 pp.;

21 cm; pb.; Editora Cultural Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; April, 1982; pp. 101-103, 119-126, 135-140.

1127. NIELSSON, Haraldur; “Minhas Experiências Espíritas”; transl. Francisco Klörs Werneck; pref.

Richard Hoffmann and Georg Henrich; 120 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Translator’s Edition; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; 1940; pp. 87-90; eds.: Dan., Ger., Fr., Sp., Port.

1128. NIETZKE, Ann; “Para Viver, é Preciso Aceitar a Morte” (Kübler-Ross); Interview; Planeta; S.

Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 74; November, 1978; illus.; pp. 21-24.

1129. NIKTO (Pseud.); “En la Frontera del Outro Mundo”; 64 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Editorial Constancia; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1958; pp. 23-26.

1130. NOBRE, José de Freitas; “Homenagem a José de Anchieta”; 128 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Congresso

Nacional; Brasília; Brazil; 1980; pp. 111, 113, 117.

1131. NOBRE, José de Freitas; “A Perseguição Policial Contra Eurípedes Barsanulfo”; 94 pp.; illus.; 21

cm; pb.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981; pp. 11, 15, 16.

1132. NOËL, Daniel C.; “Carlos Castaneda: Ombres et Lumières”; transl. and pref. Vincent Bardet and

Zéno Bianu; 254 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Albin Michel; Paris; 1981; pp. 66-69, 85.

1133. NOGUEIRA, Tânia; “Quarta Dimensão: A Porta para o Incompreendido”; Planeta; S. Paulo;

Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 133; October, 1983; illus.; pp. 34-41.

1134. NORRIS, Benjamin Franklin; “The Octopus”; Novel; introd. Kenneth S. Lynn; XXVIII + 448 pp.;

illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Houghton Mifflin Co.; Boston, Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1958; pp. 262-269.

1135. NORTHAGE, Ivy; “The Mechanics of Mediumship”; 84 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Author’s

Edition; London; 1979; pp. 48-50.

1136. NORVELL, Anthony; “Alfapsiquismo: O Caminho Místico para Uma Vida Perfeita”; transl. A. B.

Pinheiro de Lemos; 252 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp.

195-203.

1137. NORVELL, Anthony; “Amazing Secrets of the Mystic East”; 228 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; A. Thomas and Co.; Northamptonshire; Great Britain; 1981; pp. 216-227; eds.: Eng., Port.

1138. NORVELL, Anthony; “O Poder da Meditação Transcendental”; transl. Aydano Arruda; 220 pp.;

21 cm; pb.; Ibrasa; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1979; pp. 167-173.

1139. NORVELL, Anthony; “O Poder das Forças Ocultas”; transl. Aydano Arruda; 220 pp.; 20.5 cm;

pb.; 2nd ed.; Ibrasa; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1982; pp. 149-161.

1140. NOVELINO, Corina; “Eurípedes: O Homem e a Missão”; 256 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Instituto

de Difusão Espírita; Araras, SP; Brazil; 1979; pp. 87, 135-137, 179.

1141. NOYES JR., Russell; “Depersonalization in the Face of Life-Threatening Danger: A Description”;

Psychiatry – Journal for the Study of Interpersonal Process; Washington,

D. C.; U. S. A.; Vol. 39; N. 1; February, 1976; pp. 19-27.

1142. NOYES JR., Russell; “The Experience of Dying”; Psychiatry – Journal for the Study of

Interpersonal Process; Washington, D. C.; U. S. A.; Vol. 35; N. 2; May, 1972; bibl. 183, 184; pp. 174-

184.

1143. OCTOPUS BOOKS; “The Occult and the Supernatural”; 124 pp.; illus.; alph.; 30 cm; hb.; dj.;

Crescent Books; New York; 1975; pp. 71-73.

1144. O’DONNELL, Elliott; “Ghosts with a Purpose”; 196 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Rider and Co.; London;

1951; pp. 76-78. 1145. OESTERREICH, Trangott Konstantin; “Possession Demoniacal & Other”; introd. Anita Kohsen

Gregory; XXIV + 400 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; The Citadel Press; Secaucus, N. J.;

U. S. A.; 1974; pp. 27, 28; eds.: Ger., Eng., Fr.

1146. OHLHAVER, Hinrich; “Os Mortos Vivem”; transl. Vicente Jascyk; prfr. Wallace Leal V.

Rodrigues; 362 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Casa Editora O Clarim; Matão, SP; Brazil; 1971;

pp. 82-96.

1147. OLCOTT, Henry Steel; “A La Decouverte de L’Occulte”; transl. La Vieuville; introd.

L. V.; 464 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Éditions Adyar; Paris; 1976; pp. 357-374; ed em Eng., Fr., Sp.

1148. OLDFIELD, Josiah; “The Mystery of Death”; 172 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Rider and Co.; London;

1951; p. 167.

1149. OLIVEIRA, Decio Rufino de; “Fenômenos Parapsicológicos e Energia Consciente”; 242 pp.; bibl.

241; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editora Guanabara; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1972; pp. 128, 129.

1150. OPHIEL (Pseud. for Edward C. Peach); “The Art and Practice of Astral Projection”; VI + 122 pp.;

illus.; 21 cm; pb.; 15th ed.; Samuel Weiser; New York; 1977; pp. I-VI, 1-122.

Page 48: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1151. OPHIEL (Pseud. for Edward C. Peach); “The Art and Practice of Caballa Magic”; 152 pp.; illus.;

bibl. 152; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd print.; Samuel Weiser; York Beach; Maine; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 81, 99, 108,

110.

1152. OPHIEL (Pseud. for Edward C. Peach); “The Art and Practice of Clairvoyance”; XIV + 138 pp.;

illus.; 21 cm; pb.; 5th print.; Samuel Weiser; New York; 1975; pp. 59, 113-115.

1153. OSBORN, Arthur W.; “The Cosmic Womb”; XIV + 234 pp.; bibl. 217-226; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; The

Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1969; pp. 24, 25, 74,

92-94. 1154. OSBORN, Arthur W.; “The Expansion of Awareness”; prol. Raynor C. Johnson; introd. Rohit

Mehta; 272 pp.; bibl. 257-267; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd print.; The Theosophical Publishing House;

Wheaton; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1970; pp. 60, 66, 199.

1155. OSBORN, Arthur W.; “The Future is Now”; 254 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd print.; The

Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill; U. S. A.; 1973; pp. 160-164, 167, 168.

1156. OSBORN, Arthur W.; “The Meaning of Personal Existence”; pref. Ian Stevenson; XVIII + 232

pp.; bibl. 215-224; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill; U. S. A.;

1967; pp. 45-53, 178, 179.

1157. OSBORN, Arthur W.; “The Superphysical”; introd. W. H. Maxwell Telling; XVI

+ 350 pp.; bibl. 333-343; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Ivor Nicholson & Watson; London; 1937;

pp. 148-151, 156-160.

1158. OSIS, Karlis; “Assassin’s Shadow Disrupts Experiment”; ASPR Newsletter; New York; Vol. VII;

N. 3; July, 1981; p. 16.

1159. OSIS, Karlis; “Deathbed Observations by Physicians and Nurses”; 114 pp.; illus.; bibl. 102, 103;

21.5 cm; pb.; 4th print.; Parapsychology Foundation; New York; January, 1982;

pp. 1-114.

1160. OSIS, Karlis; “Out-of-the-Body Experiences: A Personal View”; Psi News; Vol. 4.; N. 3; 1981. 1161. OSIS, Karlis; “Out-of-Body Research at the ASPR”; ASPR Newsletter; New York; N. 22;

Summer, 1974; pp. 1-3.

1162. OSIS, Karlis; “Recollections of Death: A Medical Investigation”; Books Reviews; The Journal of

the American Society of Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 77; N. 1; January, 1983; pp. 79-83.

1163. OSIS, Karlis, and HARALDSSON, Erlendur; “At the Hour of Death”; XII + 244 pp.; bibl. 234-

237; alph.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Avon Books; New York; November, 1977; pp. 4, 7, 12, 13, 20, 25, 38, 39, 63,

168, 169, 198, 201; eds.: Eng., Sp., It.

1164. OSIS, Karlis, and MC CORMICK, Donna; “The Authors Reply”; The Journal of the American

Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 75; N. 4; October, 1981; pp. 367, 368.

1165. OSIS, Karlis, and MC CORMICK, Donna; “The Authors Reply to Mr. Isaacs”; The Journal of the

American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 75; N. 2; April, 1981; pp. 194-197.

1166. OSIS, Karlis, and MC CORMICK, Donna; “Current ASPR Research on Out-of-Body

Experiences”; ASPR Newsletter; New York; Vol. VI; N. 4; October, 1980; pp. 21, 22.

1167. OSIS, Karlis, and MC CORMICK, Donna; “Insiders’ Views of the OBE: A Questionnaire Survey

at the ASPR”; Newsletter; The American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 4; 1978; pp.

18, 19.

1168. OSIS, Karlis, and MC CORMICK, Donna; “Kinetic Effects at the Ostensible Location of an Out-of-Body Projection During Perceptual Testing”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical

Research; New York; Vol. 74; N. 3; July, 1980; bibl. 328, 329; pp. 319-329.

1169. OSIS, Karlis, and MITCHELL, Janet Lee; “Physiological Correlates of Reported Out of the Body

Experiences”; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 49; N. 772; June, 1977;

bibl. 535, 536; pp. 525-536.

1170. OSMONT, Anne; “Mes Voyages en Astral”; Omnium Litteraire; Paris.

1171. OSTBY, O. A.; “An Awakening to the Universe”; VIII + 368 pp.; 19 cm; hb.; Author’s Edition;

Minneapolis; Minnesota; U. S. A.; 1927; pp. 2, 6-8, 11, 225-227.

1172. OSTRANDER, Sheila, and SCHROEDER, Lynn; “Psychic Experiences: ESP Investigated”; 250

pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Sterling Publishing Co.; New York; 1977;

pp. 156-159, 223-225, 238-239.

1173. OSTY, Eugène; “La Connaissance Supra-Normale”; VII + 388 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Librairie Félix

Alcan; Paris; 1923; pp. 19-25, 48, 49, 380; eds.: Fr., Eng.

Page 49: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1174. OUSPENSKY, Peter Demianovitch; “Un Nuevo Modelo del Universo”; transl. Armando Cosani

Sologúren; 590 pp.; illus.; alph.; 22.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1980;

pp. 291-330.

1175. OWEN, Alan Robert George; “Psychic Mysteries of the North: Discoveries from the Maritime

Provinces and Beyond”; 244 pp.; bibl. 233-238; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Harper and Row, Publishers;

New York; 1975; pp. 143, 144, 146, 147.

1176. OWEN, G. Vale; “Facts and the Future Life”; 192 pp.; 19 cm; hb.; 4th print.; Hutchinson & Co.;

London; no date; pp. 124-129. 1177. OWEN, Robert Dale; “Footfalls on the Boundary of Another World”; XX + 392 pp.; bibl. XVII-

XX; alph.; 20 cm; hb.; Trübner & Co.; London; 1860; pp. 230-260.

1178. OWEN, Robert Dale; “Região em Litígio Entre Este Mundo e o Outro”; pref.

and transl. Francisco Raimundo Ewerton Quadros; 478 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Federação Espírita Brasi-

leira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1938; pp. 227-232, 391, 392.

1179. OXENHAM, John, and OXENHAM, Erica; “Out of the Body”; VIII + 118 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; 4th

print.; Longmans Green and Co.; London; 1942; pp. I-VIII, 1-118.

1180. PADILHA, Viriato; “O Livro dos Fantasmas”; 294 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Spiker; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

1956; pp. 277-279.

1181. PAIGE, C. A.; “Unusual Experiences”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical

Research; New York; Vol XL; N. 3; July, 1946; pp. 185-187.

1182. PAIM, Isaías; “Curso de Psicopatologia”; 288 pp.; bibl. 281-283; index of names; alph.; 21.5 cm;

pb.; 9th ed.; Editora Pedagógica e Universitária; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1982; pp. 226-229.

1183. PAIXÃO, Paulo, and SILVA, César Santos; “Parapsicologia, Ciência ou Magia?”; 120 pp.; illus.;

glos. 105-115; bibl. 116-119; 21 cm; pb.; Interinvest Editora e Distribuidora; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

1974; pp. 106, 107.

1184. PALMER, John; “A Comunity Mail Survey of Psychic Experiences”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 73; N. 2; April, 1979;

pp. 221-251.

1185. PALMER, John; “Consciousness Localized in Space Outside the Body”; Osteopathic Physician;

Vol. 14; April, 1974; pp. 51-62.

1186. PALMER, John; “ESP and Out-of-Body Experiences: EEG Correlates”; in Research in

Parapsychology 1978; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen; N. J.; U. S. A.; 1979;

pp. 135-138.

1187. PALMER, John; “The Out-of-Body Experience: A Psychological Theory”; Parapsychology

Review; New York; Vol. 9; N. 5; September-October, 1978; pp. 19-22.

1188. PALMER, John; “Some New Directions for Research on Out-of-Body Experiences”; in Research

in Parapsychology 1973; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen; N. J.; U. S. A.; 1974.

1189. PALMER, John, and LIEBERMAN, Ronald; “ESP and Out-of-Body Experiences: A Further

Study”; in Research in Parapsychology 1975; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen; N. J.; U. S. A.; 1976.

1190. PALMER, John, and LIEBERMAN, Ronald; “The Influence of Psychological Set on ESP and

Out-of-Body Experiences”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; Vol. 69; N.

3; July, 1975; bibl. 212, 213; pp. 193-213.

1191. PALMER, John, and VASSAR, Carol; “ESP and Out-of-the-Body Experiences: An Exploratory Study”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 68, 1974; pp.

257-280.

1192. PALMER, John, and VASSAR, Carol; “Toward Experimental Induction of the Out-of-the-Body

Experience”; in Research in Parapsychology 1973; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen; N. J.; U. S. A.;

1974; pp. 38-41.

1193. PANATI, Charles; “Supersenses”; XVI + 342 pp.; illus.; index of names; alph.; 18 cm; pocket;

pb.; Anchor Books; New York; 1976; pp. 167-176.

1194. PANCHADASI, Swami; “The Astral World”; 94 pp.; 15.5 cm; pb.; no publisher;

U. S. A.; no date; pp. 28-35.

1195. PANCHADASI, Swami; “Nuestras Fuerzas Ocultas: Telepatia y Clarividencia”; 254 pp.; 19 cm;

pb.; 2nd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1980; pp. 217-226.

1196. PAPPALARDO, Armando; “Spiritismo”; 238 pp.; illus.; 15 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Ulrico Hoepli;

Milano; Italy; 1901; pp. 178-184.

Page 50: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1197. PAPUS (Pseud. for Gérard Anaclet Vincent Encausse); “ABC Illustré D’Occultisme”; 448 pp.;

illus.; 24 cm; pb.; 9th ed.; Éditions Dangles; Paris; Juin, 1979; pp. 70-82, 113, 193, 319, 418, 423.

1198. PAPUS (Pseud. for Gérard Anaclet Vincent Encausse); “Tratado Elementar de Magia Prática”;

transl. and pref. E. P.; 552 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1978; pp. 479-

489.

1199. PARONELLI, Fede; “Nuovi Orizzonti della Scienza Moderna”; 208 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Fratelli

Bocca, Editori; Milano; Italy; 1942; pp. 157, 161, 186.

1200. PARAPSYCHOLOGY FOUNDATION; “Proceedings of Four Conferences of Parapsychological Studies”; 180 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Parapsychology Foundadion; New York; 1957;

pp. 114-116, 168, 169.

1201. PARKER, Adrian; “States of Mind”; 198 pp.; bibl.; alph.; Taplinger; New York; 1975.

1202. PARRISH-HARRA, Carol W.; “A New Age Handbook for Death and Dying”; introd. Vera

Stanley Alder; XIV + 138 pp.; illus.; bibl. 137, 138; 23 cm; pb.; De Vorss & Co.; Marina del Rey;

Cal.; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 75-80, 102.

1203. PARROT, Ian; “Nad: A Study of Some Unusual Other-World Experiences”

(D. Scott Rogo); Books Reviews; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 46; N.

747; March, 1971; pp. 69-71.

1204. PASCHOAL, Januario De; “Dá Licença...”; 162 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; pb.; Editora Rodemar; Rio de

Janeiro; Brazil; 1962; pp. 21, 22.

1205. PASQUA, Norberto; “Fenômenos Anímicos: Prova da Existência do Espírito”; Unificação; S.

Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XXII; N. 257; August, 1974; p. 7.

1206. PASTORINO, Carlos Torres; “Técnica da Mediunidade”; 214 pp.; illus.; bibl. 205; 23 cm; pb.;

2nd ed.; Sabedoria Livraria Editora; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1973; pp. 146, 179, 180.

1207. PAUL, Walter K.; “Out of the Body Mantras”; Light; London; Magazine; Vol. 88; 1968; pp. 26-

40. 1208. PAULA, João Teixeira de; “Dicionário de Parapsicologia, Metapsíquica e Espiritismo”; pres.

Hernani Guimarães Andrade; 3 Vol.; 480 pp.; illus.; bibl.; 23 cm; hb.; Banco Cultural Brasileiro

Editora; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1970; p. 60.

1209. PAULA, Luiz Gonzaga Scortecci de; “Mensagens Extraterrestres”; pref. Adhemar Eugênio de

Mello; 152 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; João Scortecci & Fumiko Hayashi Editors; S. Paulo; Brazil;

1983; pp. 19, 22, 31, 34, 59, 63, 67, 80-83, 91, 97, 110, 120.

1210. PAVRI, P.; “Teosofia Explicada”; XXIV + 500 pp.; illus.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Editorial Orion; Mexico,

D. F.; 1978; pp. 83, 93, 294-296.

1211. PAYNE, Phoebe D., and BENDIT, L. J.; “The Psychic Sense”; introd. L. A. G. Strong; 228 pp.;

bibl. 225, 226; alph.; 20 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Faber and Faber; London; 1958; pp. 48, 49; eds.: Eng., Fr.

1212. PAZIENTE, Mario; “Curso Preparatório de Eubiose”; pref. João Roque Gomez; 102 pp.; illus.; 21

cm; pb.; Biblioteca Dhâranâ; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1983; pp. 42, 43.

1213. PEARCE-HIGGINS, John D.; “The Study and Practice of Astral Projection” (Robert Crookall);

Books Reviews; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 41; N. 709; September,

1961; pp. 159-161.

1214. PEARCE-HIGGINS, John D., and WHITBY, G. Stanley; “Life, Death and Psychical Research”;

272 pp.; bibl. 270-272; 22 cm; pb.; Rider and Co.; London; 1973; pp. 66-88. 1215. PEARSALL, Ronald; “The Table-Rappers”; 258 pp.; illus.; bibl. 241-243; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Michael Joseph; London; 1972; pp. 195-201.

1216. PEARSON, P. G.; “Hungry Projection”; Fate; Evanston; Ill.; U. S. A.; Magazine; Monthly; Vol.

6; N. 35; February, 1953; p. 67.

1217. PEDRAZZANI, Jean-Michel; “Techniques et Pouvoirs de l’Occultisme”; 224 pp.; glos. 205-212;

22 cm; pb.; Pierre Belfond; Paris; 1976; p. 207; eds.: Fr., Sp.

1218. PEEBLES, J. M.; “Immortality”; 296 pp.; 23 cm; hb.; Colby and Rich, Publishers; Boston; Ill; U.

S. A.; 1882; pp. 227-230.

1219. PELLETIER, Horace; “Force Psychique et Extériorisation de la Sensibilité”; “Le Voile D’Isis”;

Paris; Magazine; Weekly; Troisième Année; N. 76; 8, Juin, 1892; pp. 2-5.

1220. PENSAMENTO; Editor; “Forças Ocultas”; 316 pp.; ilus; 18 cm; hb.; 5th ed.; Editora O

Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1946; pp. 177-180.

1221. PENSAMENTO; Editor; “Magnetismo”; 150 pp.; ilus; 23.5 cm; pb.; 10th ed.; Empresa Editora O

Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1956; pp. 77-80.

Page 51: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1222. PENSAMENTO; Editor; “Método de Hipnotismo”; 218 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.;

3rd ed.; Editora O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1928; pp. 189-192.

1223. PENSAMENTO; Editor; “Primeira Série de Instruções: Círculo Esotérico da Comunhão do

Pensamento”; 512 pp.; illus.; 15.5 cm; hb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date;

pp. 118-120.

1224. PENSAMENTO; Editor; “Dicionário de Ciências Ocultas”; 102 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; 9th ed.; Editora

Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1963; p. 45.

1225. PERALVA, Martins; “Estudando a Mediunidade”; 232 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.; 7th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; pp. 86-91, 96-100.

1226. PEREIRA, Adélia Gregory (Pseud. Hillel); “Desbravamento da Transideral na Era do Aquário”;

pref. João Evangelista Ferraz; 160 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editora CBAG; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

1979; pp. 81-85.

1227. PEREIRA, Yvonne do Amaral; “Devassando o Invisível”; 232 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

3rd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1976; pp. 25-31, 47, 52, 70-72, 75, 78,

79, 84, 86-103, 106, 108-115, 122, 123, 127-143, 147, 150-161, 178-182, 189, 191, 217-232.

1228. PEREIRA, Yvonne do Amaral; “Dramas da Obsessão”; 210 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.; 4th ed.;

Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; pp. 20, 28, 59, 167, 170, 201, 205.

1229. PEREIRA, Yvonne do Amaral; “Memórias de Um Suicida”; 568 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

4th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1973; pp. 9-11.

1230. PEREIRA, Yvonne do Amaral; “Recordações da Mediunidade”; 212 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1976; pp. 16-21, 28-32, 51-56, 64, 65, 75, 114-

127, 130-138, 141-147, 158, 160, 181.

1231. PEREIRA, Yvonne do Amaral; “Ressurreição e Vida”; 314 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 5th ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; pp. 205, 208.

1232. PEREIRA, Yvonne do Amaral; “A Tragédia de Santa Maria”; 268 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 5th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; pp.; 22, 24-26, 29.

1233. PEREIRA, Yvonne do Amaral; “Nas Voragens do Pecado”; Novel; 318 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 4th ed.;

Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; pp. 9-11.

1234. PÉRES, Floriano Moinho; “Elizabeth Taylor: Um Caso de Desdobramento”; Correio Fraterno do

ABC; S. Bernardo do Campo, SP; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XVI; N. 143; November, 1982; p.

5.

1235. PÉRES, Floriano Moinho; “Cientistas: Sair do Corpo não é Sonho nem Loucura”; Jornal Espírita;

S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. VIII; N. 87; September, 1982; illus.; p. 10.

1236. PERKINS, James Scudday; “Experiencing Reincarnation”; X + 192 pp.; illus.; glos. 179-183; bibl.

187-189; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd print.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill.; U. S. A.;

1979; pp. 5-11.

1237. PERMUTT, Cyril; “Beyond the Spectrum: A Survey of Supernormal Photography”; 186 pp.;

illus.; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Patrick Stephens; Cambridge; Great Britain; 1983;

p. 59.

1238. PERRY, Michael Charles; “Psychic Studies: A Christian’s View”; 224 pp.; bibl. 108, 109; index

of names; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; The Aquarian Press; Wellingborough; Northamptonshire; Great Britain;

1984; pp. 59-61; 65, 74, 100-109, 114, 120, 210, 214. 1239. PERSINGER, Michael A.; “The Paranormal”; 248 pp.; MSS Information Corporation; New York;

1974.

1240. PETERSEN, William J.; “Those Curious New Cults in the 80’s”; introd. Jay Kesler; 12 + 308 pp.;

bibl. 306, 307; 17.5 cm; pocket; pb.; ed. rev.; Keats Publishing; New Canaan; Connecticut; U. S. A.;

1982; pp. 286-290.

1241. PETTIWARD, Cynthia; “Dossier Posesión”; transl. Esteban Serra; pref.

G. S. Whitby; 156 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1977; pp. 20, 21, 41-

43.

1242. PIKE, E. Royston; “Dictionnaire des Religions”; transl. Serge Huttin; VIII + 330 pp.; 23.5 cm;

hb.; dj.; Presses Universitaires de France; Paris; 1954; pp. 17, 29, 127, 296, 297.

1243. PIKE, James A., with KENNEDY, Diane; “The Other Side”; X + 398 pp.; bibl.

387-397; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Doubleday & Co.; Garden City; New York; 1968; pp. 28, 29, 394.

1244. PIOBB, Pierre; “L’Année Occultiste et Psychique”; 350 pp.; 17 cm; hb.; Henri Daragon, Éditeur;

Paris; 5, October, 1909; pp. 248-262.

Page 52: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1245. PIRES, José Herculano; “Mediunidade: Vida e Comunicação”; 160 pp.; bibl. 147; index of names;

21 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1978; pp. 14, 115, 117.

1246. PIRES, José Herculano; “Metrô para o Outro Mundo: Ficção Científica Paranormal”; Novel; 136

pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; September, 1981; pp. 44, 56, 58, 61, 74, 93, 123, 124.

1247. PIRES, José Herculano; “Parapsicologia Hoje e Amanhã”; 216 pp.; glos. 215, 216; bibl. 213, 214;

21 cm; pb.; 6th ed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981; pp. 67-69, 126.

1248. PISANI, Isola; “Para Além da Morte”; transl. S. Silva; 300 pp.; bibl. 295-299; 21 cm; pb.;

Publicações Europa-América; Lisboa; Portugal; no date; pp. 126-131, 177, 278, 279. 1249. PLANETA; Editorial; “Dicionário de Ciências Ocultas”; 242 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; pb.; Magazine;

Monthly; N. 14-A; Especial; Editora Três; S. Paulo; Brazil; October, 1973; p. 139.

1250. PLANETA; Editorial; “Dicionário do Fantástico”; 128 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Magazine; Monthly; N.

33-A; Especial; Editora Três; S. Paulo; Brazil; April, 1975; pp. 34, 35.

1251. PLANETA; Editorial; “Dicionário do Inexplicado”; 3 Vol.; 198 pp.; illus.; Installments;

Magazine; Monthly; N. 131-B, 132-A, 133-A; Editora Três; S. Paulo; Brazil; August-October, 1983;

1st Vol.: pp. 14, 22, 40, 47, 48, 65, 66; 2nd Vol.: p. 58; 3rd Vol.: pp. 16-20.

1252. PLANETA; Editorial; “Os Entrantes”; Magazine; Monthly; N. 147 A; Editora Três; S. Paulo;

Brazil; December, 1984; illus.; pp. 36-42.

1253. PLANETA; Editorial; “A Escola de Xamãs”; Magazine; Monthly; N. 109; Editora Três; S. Paulo;

Brazil; October, 1981; illus.; pp. 34-41.

1254. PLANETA; Editorial; “Este Homem se Chama Cesario Hossri”; Magazine; Monthly; N. 41;

Editora Três; S. Paulo; Brazil; January, 1976; illus.; pp. 18-26.

1255. PLANETA; Editorial; “A Fruta Sagrada”; Magazine; Monthly; N. 49; Editora Três; S. Paulo;

Brazil; October, 1976; pp. 26-33.

1256. PLANETA; Editorial; “Ingo Swann: O Homem Que Viaja Fora do Corpo”; Magazine; Monthly;

N. 65; Editora Três; S. Paulo; Brazil; February, 1978; illus.; pp. 28-33. 1257. PLANETA; Editorial; “Manual do Feiticeiro”; 132 pp.; 28 cm; pb.; illus.; installments; Magazine;

Monthly; N. 139-A, 140-A; Editora Três; S. Paulo; Brazil; April-May, 1984; pp. 16, 31, 39.

1258. PLANETA; Editorial; “Sonhos Psíquicos: Sondando o Outro Lado da Vida”; Magazine; Monthly;

N. 128-B; Editora Três; S. Paulo; Brazil; May, 1983; illus.; pp. 50-57.

1259. PLANETA; Editorial; “Thelma Moss: Vamos Sair do Quadrado e Aceitar Todos os Fatos,

Estranhos ou Não”; Magazine; Monthly; N. 37-A; Editora Três; S. Paulo; Brazil; October, 1975; illus.;

pp. 6-17.

1260. PLANETA; Editorial; “A Visão Transcendente”; Magazine; Monthly; N. 141; Editora Três; S.

Paulo; Brazil; June, 1984; illus.; pp. 34-39.

1261. PLATÃO; “A República”; transl. and introd. Maria Helena da Rocha Pereira; LX + 502 pp.; bibl.

LV-LVIII; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Fundação Calouste Gulbenkian; Lisboa; Portugal; September, 1980; pp.

487-500; eds.: Gr., Port., etc.

1262. PLAYFAIR, Guy Lyon; “The Flying Cow”; 320 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Souvenir

Press; London; 1975; pp. 63, 64.

1263. PLAYFAIR, Guy Lyon; “The Indefinite Boundary”; app. Hernani Guimarães Andrade; 320 pp.;

illus.; glos. 291-294; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; Souvenir Press; London; 1976;

pp. 77, 185, 186, 192, 254, 292. 1264. PLUTARCO DE QUERONÉIA; “Oeuvres Morales”; Traités 37-41; “Sur les Délais de la Justice

Divine”; Tome VII; Deuxième Partie; transl. Robert Klaerr, et Yvonne Vernière; XIV + 252 pp.; index

of names; alph.; 20 cm; pb.; Société D’Édition Les Belles Lettres; Paris; 1974; pp. 162-169; eds.: Gr.,

Fr.; private translation in Port.

1265. PLYTOFF, G.; “La Magie”; VIII + 312 pp.; illus.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Librairie J.-B. Bailliére et Fils;

Paris; 1892; pp. 86-88.

1266. PODMORE, Frank; “Apparitions and Thought-Transference: An Examination of the Evidence for

Telepathy”; XVI + 402 pp.; illus.; alph.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Walter Scott; London; 1894; pp. 204-206, 218,

367, 368.

1267. PODMORE, Frank; “Mediums of the 19th Century”; introd. E. J. Dingwall; 720 pp.;

2 Vol.; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; University Books; New York; 1963; Vol. I: pp. XIII, XIV, 47, 66,

88-91.

1268. POINSOT, M.-C.; “Encyclopédie des Sciences Occultes”; 630 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; hb.; Les Éditions

Georges-Anquetil; Paris; 1925; pp. 563, 564.

Page 53: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1269. POINSOT, M.-C.; “La Magie des Campagnes”; 286 pp.; 25 cm; pb.; La Diffusion Scientifique;

Paris; 1950; pp. 148-152.

1270. POLE, Wellesley Tudor; “Private Dowding”; 94 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 7th ed.; Pilgrims Books

Services; Tasburgh Norwich; England; 1984; pp. 65-67, 74, 77, 83-85.

1271. POLIDORO, Osvaldo; “Um Médium de Transportes”; 248 pp.; 15.5 cm; hb.; Livraria Allan

Kardec Editora; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1951; pp. 35-37, 50-54, 86, 99, 129, 137, 145, 164-171, 187.

1272. POODT, Th.; “Les Phénomènes Mystérieux du Psychisme”; 496 pp.; glos. 13-17; 23 cm; hb.;

Édition Algo; Anvers; France; 1926; pp. 14, 262-268; eds.: Fr., Sp. 1273. POORTMAN, J. J.; “Ochêma: De zin van het Hylisch Pluralisme”; 3 Vol.; 746 pp.; Van Gorkum

& Co.; Assen; Netherlands;; 1967; pp. 462-489; eds.: Dut.

1274. POPENOE, Cris; “Books for Inner Development”; 384 pp.; illus.; 28 cm; pb.; Random House;

London; 1976; pp. 30, 31.

1275. PORTELA, Fernando; “Além do Normal”; pres. Luis Pellegrini; 162 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Traço

Editora; Santos, SP; Brazil; 1984; pp. 65, 66, 122-133.

1276. PORTELA, Fernando; “Voar Sem Asas”; Ícaro; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. I; N.

14; October, 1984; illus.; pp. 34, 35.

1277. POSE, Joaquim Miralles; “Waldo Vieira: Viagens por Outros Planos”; Interview; Planeta; S.

Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 144; September, 1984; illus.; pp. 11-15.

1278. POWELL, Arthur Edgard; “The Astral Body”; XIV + 266 pp.; bibl. XI; alph.; 21 cm; The

Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1978; pp. 1-106, 130, 167, 197, 219, 225,

227, 228, 234-250; eds.: Eng., Sp., Port.

1279. POWELL, Arthur Edgard; “O Corpo Mental”; transl. Nair Lacerda; 272 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.;

Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1984; pp. 63, 86, 105, 126, 135, 136, 143-145,

148-153, 216, 237, 261; eds.: Eng., Sp., Port.

1280. POWELL, Arthur Edgard; “O Duplo Etérico”; prfr. J. Gervásio de Figueiredo; 184 pp.; illus.; glos.; 179-181; 19.5 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1973; pp. 10, 36, 52, 68,

76, 78.

1281. POYNTON, John D.; “Astralwanderungen wissenschaftlich bewiesen”; transl. E. M. Körner;

Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 23; N. 2; February, 1972; p. 112.

1282. POYNTON, John D.; “Parapsychology in South Africa”; South African Society for Psychical

Research; Johannesburg; South Africa; 1975; pp. 95-123.

1283. PRADO, Hamilton; “Ainda no Limiar do Mistério da Sobrevivência”; 64 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.;

Author’s Edition; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1969; pp. 1-64.

1284. PRADO, Hamilton; “No Limiar do Mistério da Sobrevivência: Experiência com

o Eu Astral”; 158 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Serviço Social Batuira; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1967; pp. 1-158 (Mini-

library).

1285. PRATT, J. Gaither; “ESP Research Today: A Study of Developments in Parapsychology Since

1960”; 196 pp.; bibl. 175-178, 184-186; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metychen; N. J.; U. S.

A.; 1973; pp. 42-44, 51, 177.

1286. PREL, Carl Du; “La Magie: Science Naturelle”; 2 Vol.; 696 pp.; 2 Parties; transl. Nissa; pref.

Guillaume de Fontenay; illus.; 23 cm; pb.; Librairie Des Sciences Psychiques; Paris; 1908; pp. 82-114.

1287. PRELM, Virginia van; “Experiências de Desdobramento no Sítio Uirapuru”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 68; May, 1978; pp. 24-29.

1288. PRICE, Nancy; “Acquainted with the Night: A Book of Dreams”; 156 pp.; 22 cm; hb.; George

Ronald; Oxford; Great Britain; no date; pp. 51-56.

1289. PRIEUR, Jean; “L’Aura et le Corps Immortel”; 280 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Éditions Robert Laffont;

Paris; Mars, 1979; pp. 18, 23, 28, 73-120, 274 (Mini-library).

1290. PRINCE, Walter Franklin; “Noted Witnesses for Psychic Occurrences”; Anthology; VIII + 336

pp.; 24 cm; hb.; dj.; University Books; New York; 1963; pp. 30-32, 166-168.

1291. PSYCHIC; Editorial; “Interview: Ingo Swann”; Magazine; illus.; bibl. 48, 49; March-April, 1973;

pp. 7-11, 48, 49.

1292. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Astral Caller Becomes Ball of Light”; London; Newspaper; Weekly;

N. 2277; January 24, 1976; p. 8.

1293. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Astral Traveller Convinces Sceptic by Locating

Hidden Birthmark”; London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2179; 9, March, 1974; p. 7.

Page 54: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1294. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Astral Travels Make Him Citizen of Two Worlds”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2040; July 10, 1971; illus.; p. 8.

1295. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Clinically Dead Patients get Preview of After-Life”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2395; April 29, 1978; illus.; p. 1.

1296. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Clinically Dead Woman Meets Parents in Beyond”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2519; September 20, 1980; p. 3.

1297. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Dead Fiancee’s Spirit Return Confirms his Out-of-Body Travels”;

London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2505; June 14, 1980; p. 7. 1298. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Dead Medico Leaves his Body, and Re-enters it”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 1983; June 6, 1970; p. 7.

1299. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Doctors Cite Evidence for Life After Life”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2446; April 21, 1979; illus.; pp. 1, 7.

1300. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Famous Author Often Left His Body for Astral Travels” (William

Gerhardi); London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2356; July 30, 1977; p. 3.

1301. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Film Star Tells of Leaving Her Body” (Gloria Swanson); London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2399; May 27, 1978; p. 1.

1302. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Healer Leaves His Body to Treat Sufferers”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2419; October 14, 1978; illus.; p. 3.

1303. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “He Leaves His Body and Meets Father in Spirit World”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2432; January 13, 1979; pp. 1, 5.

1304. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Hemingway Tells of Out-Body Experience”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2413; September 2, 1978; p. 7.

1305. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “His Astral Trip From France to Sweden is Confirmed”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2347; May 28, 1977; p. 7.

1306. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “How to do-it-Yourself Astral Travel”; London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2003; October 24, 1970; p. 3.

1307. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “In Astral Form She Follows Her Physical Body for Two Days”;

London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2484; illus.; January 12, 1980; p. 7.

1308. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Jeremy Lloyd Astral Travels”; London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2455;

June 23, 1979; illus.; pp. 1, 8.

1309. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Leaving her Body Shows Death is Painless”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2144; July 7, 1973; p. 3.

1310. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Man Lying on Bed was me”; London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2444;

April 7, 1979; illus.; p. 8.

1311. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Medico Confirms Out of Body Trips Occur”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2480; December 15, 1979; p. 8.

1312. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Medico is Dismayed to Find he has Died”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 1079; April 8, 1972; p. 5.

1313. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Medium Describes Her Feelings While Out of the Body”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 101; 28, April, 1934; p. 4.

1314. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Mother, Out of Body, Joins Dead Son at His Funeral”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2337; March 19, 1977; p. 2. 1315. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “My Astral Travels” (David Jacobs); London; Newspaper; Weekly; N.

2067; January 15, 1972; illus.; pp. 1, 4.

1316. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “My Husband Leaves His Body to Talk to Me”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2527; November 15, 1980; p. 2.

1317. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “One in Five Have Astral Trips”; London; Newspaper; Weekly; N.

1434; January 27, 1979; p. 3.

1318. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Out-of-Body Bride Sees her Wedding From Church Steeple”;

London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2249; July 12, 1975; illus.; p. 8.

1319. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Out-of-Body Mystic Heals Dying Boy With Help From Beyond”;

London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2393; April 15, 1978; p. 3.

1320. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Out-of-Body Patient Convinces Doubting Dentist”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2359; August 20, 1977; p. 3.

1321. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Out-of-Body Trips Don’t Prove Survival, Says Scientist”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2526; November 8, 1980; p. 7.

Page 55: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1322. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Out-of-Body Trip Ends Fear of Passing”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2342; April 23, 1977; p. 1.

1323. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Out of Her Body She Sees Her Baby’s Birth”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2334; February 26, 1977; p. 4.

1324. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Out of His Body he Finds There Were Two of Me”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 1969; February 28, 1970; illus.; p. 3.

1325. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Perchance to Dream: of the Future That Comes True”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 1971; March 14, 1970; illus.; p. 8. 1326. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Pinch Mark Proves His Out-of-Body Visit”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2465; September 1, 1979; p. 2.

1327. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Psychic Pays Astral Visits to Planets”; London; Newspaper; Weekly;

N. 2264; October 25; 1975; illus.; p. 1.

1328. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Psychic Projects Himself Into Locked, Sealed Box in Out-of-Body

Test”; London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2524; October 25, 1980; p. 2.

1329. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Satellites Confirm His Astral Trip to Planets”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2393; April 5, 1978; illus.; p. 1.

1330. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Scientist is Exception to Rule Because He Experiences ESP” (Charles

Theodore Tart); London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2134; April 28, 1973; p. 7.

1331. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “They Feel More Solid Out of Theirs Bodies”; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 2039; July 3, 1971; illus.; p. 5.

1332. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “They Have Previews of Spirit World While Clinically Dead”;

London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2331; February 5, 1977; illus.; p. 1.

1333. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “They Try to Prove Soul Exists With Out-of-Body Tests”; London;

Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2204; August 31, 1974; p. 2.

1334. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “Tortured Convict Met Future Wife During His Out-of-Body Trip”; London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 1530; December 6, 1980; p. 5.

1335. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “TV Features Out-of-Body Visits By People Who are Medically

Dead”; London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2441; March 17, 1979; illus.; p. 1.

1336. PSYCHIC NEWS; Editor; “While Asleep He Helped Those Prematurely Born Into Beyond”;

London; Newspaper; Weekly; N. 2411; August 19, 1978; illus.; p. 7.

1337. PUHARICH, Andrija Karl; “Beyond Telepathy”; XVIII + 340 pp.; illus.; index of names; bibl.

299-305; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Anchor Press; New York; 1973; pp. 60-86, 187-190; eds.: Eng., Fr.

1338. PUHARICH, Andrija Karl; “The Sacred Mushroom: Key to the Door of Eternity”; 262 pp.; illus.;

21 cm; hb.; dj.; Doubleday & Co.; New York; 1959; pp. 39, 59-65, 168, 169, 198, 199.

1339. PUHLMANN, Maria Augusta Ferreira; “As Quatro Deusas da Babilônia”; Novel; pres. Nancy

Puhlmann Di Girolamo; 184 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Livraria Allan Kardec Editora; S. Paulo; Brazil;

1984; pp. 13, 38, 74, 140, 180.

1340. PURUCKER, G. de; “Occult Glossary: A Compendium of Oriental and Theosophical Terms”; 10

+ 194 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Theosophical University Press; Pasadena; Cal.;

U. S. A.; 1972; pp. 9, 10, 81, 102.

1341. PURYEAR, Herbert Bruce; “The Edgar Cayce Primer”; XIV + 250 pp.; illus.; alph.; 17.5 cm;

pocket; pb.; Bantam Books; New York; September, 1982; pp. 46, 47, 133. 1342. PUSHKIN, Vaniamin N., y DUBROV, Aleksandr Petrovich; “La Parapsicologia

y las Ciencias Naturales Modernas”; transl. A. Hernández Barrenechea; 368 pp.; illus.; bibl.

351-365; 17 cm; pocket; pb.; Akal Editor; Madrid; Spain; 1980; pp. 271-273, 277, 300, 301; eds.: Rus.,

Eng., Sp.

1343. QUEIROZ, Lauro Larrea de; “Dinâmica da Morte”; 174 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Horizonte Editora;

Brasília; Brazil; 1979; pp. 113-127.

1344. RACHLEFF, Owen S.; “The Occult Conceit”; XX + 236 pp.; bibl. 225-227; alph.; 20.5 cm; hb.;

dj.; Bell Publishing Co.; New York; 1971; pp. 184-186.

1345. RAJA-AARI, Oreb; “Bases Esenias”; 252 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos

Aires; Argentina; 1980; pp. 182, 183.

1346. RAJNEESH, Bhagwan Shree; “A Psicologia do Esotérico”; transl. Edvaldo Pereira Lima and

Wanda Honório; pref. Ma Satya Bharti; 182 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Parma;

S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 73-85.

Page 56: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1347. RAMACHÁRACA, Yogue (Pseud. for William Walter Atkinson); “Catorze Lições de Filosofia

Yogue”; transl. Francisco Valdomiro Lorenz; 224 pp.; 19 cm; hb.; 8th ed.; Editora Pensamento; S.

Paulo; Brazil; 1957; pp. 148-152.

1348. RAMACHÁRACA, Yogue (Pseud. for William Walter Atkinson); “A Vida Depois da Morte”;

transl. Francisco Valdomiro Lorenz; pref. E. P.; 158 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo;

Brazil; 1981; pp. 34, 35, 66, 67.

1349. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “Além do 1.º Décimo”; transl. Lia

Alverga-Wyler; 180 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 35-57, 144, 145.

1350. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “Capítulos da Vida”; transl. Lia

Alverga-Wyler; 234 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1967;

pp. 125, 158, 172-189.

1351. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “A Caverna dos Antigos”; transl.

Affonso Blacheyre; 216 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date;

pp. 22, 23, 34, 35, 47, 67, 71, 72, 83, 93, 126, 127, 132-138.

1352. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “A Chama Sagrada”; transl. Ruy

Jungmann; 172 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date;

pp. 74-79.

1353. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “Entre os Monges do Tibete”; transl.

Affonso Blacheyre; 272 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 10th ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

no date; pp. 38-47.

1354. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “O Eremita”; transl. Pinheiro de

Lemos; 190 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 54, 88,

128, 145, 159.

1355. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “A Fé Que me Guia”; transl. Luzia Machado da Costa; 170 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date;

pp. 8, 9, 18, 111.

1356. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “Foi Assim!”; transl. Luzia

Machado da Costa; 182 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date;

pp. 123-126.

1357. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “Luz de Vela”; transl. Luzia

Machado da Costa; 168 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date;

pp. 107-109.

1358. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “O Manto Amarelo”; transl. Ruy

Jungmann; 168 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1966; pp. 78, 79; eds.:

Eng., Sp., Port., etc.

1359. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “O Médico de Lhasa”; transl.

Affonso Blacheyre; 216 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 9th ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date;

pp. 89-92.

1360. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “Minha Vida com

o Lama”; transl. Affonso Blacheyre; 196 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; no date; pp. 59, 71, 78. 1361. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “A Sabedoria dos Lamas”; transl.

Affonso Blacheyre; 182 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 17-

21, 35, 39, 40, 60, 66, 72, 73, 93-96, 101, 102, 116, 118, 120, 121, 134, 140-142.

1362. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “O Sábio do Tibete”; transl.

Francisco Manoel da Rocha Filho; 180 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; no date; p. 147.

1363. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “Sol Poente”; transl. Luzia Machado

da Costa; 184 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date;

pp. 58-62.

1364. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “A 3.ª Visão”; transl. Antonio

Neves-Pedro; 254 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

no date; pp. 143-145, 249-251.

1365. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “Três Vidas”; transl. Vera Neves

Pedroso; 188 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 43-67.

Page 57: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1366. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “A Vela N.º 13”; transl. Carlos

Evaristo M. Costa; 228 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date;

pp. 205-210.

1367. RAMPA, Tuesday Lobsang (Pseud. for Cyril Henry Hoskin); “Você e a Eternidade”; transl.

Affonso Blacheyre; 214 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1965; pp.

64-89, 117, 123-133.

1368. RANDALL, John L.; “Parapsychology and the Nature of Life”; 256 pp.; illus.; bibl. 244-252;

alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Souvenir Press; London; 1975; pp. 184, 238, 241. 1369. RANDALL, John L.; “Psychokinesis: A Study of Paranormal Forces Through the Ages”; 256 pp.;

glos. 234-238; bibl. 239-250; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Souvenir Press; London; 1982; pp. 17, 28.

1370. RANDI, James; “Flim, Flam! Psychics, ESP, Unicorns and Other Delusions”; introd. Isaac

Asimov; XVI + 342 pp.; illus.; bibl. 331-334; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; Prometheus Books; Buffalo,

N. Y.; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 63, 145-148.

1371. RANDLES, Jenny, and WHETNALL, Paul; “Alien Contact: Window on Another World”; X +

208 pp.; illus.; bibl. 201, 202; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Hodder and Stoughton; London; 1983; pp. 65,

66, 100-108, 139, 158, 159, 179.

1372. RANIERI, Raphael A.; “João Vermelho no Mundo dos Espíritos”; 188 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.;

Livraria Allan Kardec Editora; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 14-94, 129, 139-174.

1373. RANIERI, Raphael A.; “O Sexo Além da Morte”; 180 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editora Eco; Rio

de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; p. 9.

1374. RANK, Otto; “El Doble”; transl. Floreal Mazía; 142 pp.; alph.; 20 cm; pb.; Ediciones Orión;

Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1976; pp. 51, 73-76, 98-102.

1375. RAWLINGS, Maurice; “Beyond Death’s Door”; 172 pp.; illus.; bibl. 161-164; 21.5 cm; pb.; 5th

print.; Sheldon Press; London; 1983; pp. 61-68.

1376. RÃ, Bô In; “O Livro do Além”; transl. Margarida Monteiro; 126 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 17-20.

1377. READ, Elizabeth; “Wanted: Astral Fliers”; Fate; Evanston; Ill.; U. S. A.; Magazine; Monthly;

November, 1968; pp. 44-50.

1378. REDENTOR, Centro; “Prática do Racionalismo Cristão”; 226 pp.; illus.; 22.5 cm; hb.; 6th ed.;

Centro Redentor; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1972; pp. 82, 83, 88, 89, 93, 95, 212, 214.

1379. REDENTOR, Centro; “A Vida Fora da Matéria”; 428 pp.; illus.; 22.5 cm; hb.;

1st ed.; Centro Espírita Redentor; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1930; pp. 141-174.

1380. RÉGIS, Jaci, and RODRIGUES, José; “Waldo Vieira e Sua Proposta de Trabalho”; Espiritismo e

Unificação; Santos, SP; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XVIII; N. 325; January, 1980; illus.; pp. 1,

5, 6.

1381. REGUSH, June, and REGUSH, Nicholas; “Psi: The Other World Catalogue”; 320 pp.; Putnam;

New York; 1974.

1382. REGUSH, Nicholas M.; “Exploring the Human Aura”; 184 pp.; bibl. 143-177; alph.; 21 cm; hb.;

dj.; Prentice-Hall; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1975; pp. 122-125.

1383. REGUSH, Nicholas M.; “The Human Aura”; 240 pp.; bibl. 235-237; 17.5 cm; pb.; Berkeley

Medallion Book; New York; December, 1974; pp. 93-112.

1384. REIS, Hermínio da Silva, and REIS, Bianca; “Técnica Física do Desenvolvimento da Consciência Humana”; Installment; Copy; 92 pp.; illus.; 31 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Authors’ Edition; Belo Horizonte,

MG; Brazil; no date; pp. 1-92.

1385. RÉNO-BAJOLAIS, J.; “Méthode Racionnelle D’Influence a Distance et de Dédoublement”; 128

pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 7th ed.; Éditions Niclaus; Paris; 1982; pp. 105-124.

1386. REYNER, J. H.; “No Easy Immortality”; 90 pp.; bibl. 87, 88; alph.; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; George Allen

& Unwin; London; 1979; pp. 39, 40, 59, 60.

1387. RHINE, Joseph Banks; “O Alcance do Espírito”; transl. E. Jacy Monteiro; 220 pp.; illus.; bibl.

219, 220; 21 cm; pb.; Bestseller Importadora de Livros; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1965; pp. 59, 60.

1388. RHINE, Joseph Banks; “Telepathy and Other Untestable Hypothesis”; Journal of

Parapshchology; Durham; North Carolina; U. S. A.; Vol. 38; June, 1974; pp. 137-153.

1389. RHINE, Louisa Ella; “Canais Ocultos do Espírito”; transl. E. Jacy Monteiro; pref.

J. B. Rhine; 260 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Bestseller Importadora de Livros; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1966; pp. 23, 24,

27, 28.

Page 58: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1390. RHINE, Louisa Ella; “ESP in Life and Lab”; XII + 276 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; The Macmillan Co.;

New York; 1967; pp. 42, 43.

1391. RIBEIRO, Matias José; “Um Fato Incrível, Mas Verdadeiro”; Shopping News – City News; S.

Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; 7, August, 1983; illus.; p. 14.

1392. RICHARDS, Steve, “Invisibility: Mastering the Art of Vanishing”; 160 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21.5 cm;

pb.; The Aquarian Press; London; 1982; pp. 24, 25, 45, 46, 109, 110, 139; eds.: Eng., Port.

1393. RICHARDS, Steve; “Levitacion”; transl. Rafael Lassaletta; 170 pp.; illus.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Edaf;

Madrid; Spain; 1981; pp. 58-64. 1394. RICHARDS, Steve; “The Traveller’s Guide to the Astral Plane”; 110 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21.5 cm;

pb.; The Aquarian Press; Wellingborough; Northamptonshire; Great Britain; 1983;

pp. 1-110.

1395. RICHARDSON, C.; “46 Berichte von der Schwelle des Todes”; Esotera; Freiburg; West

Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 22; N. 8; August, 1971; pp. 747, 748.

1396. RICHARDSON, William T.; “Out-of-the Body Sensations”; Correspondence; Journal of the

Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 41; N. 710; December; 1961;

pp. 214.

1397. RICHELIEU, Peter; “A Viagem de Uma Alma”; transl. Nair Lacerda; 198 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.;

Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1974; pp. 1-198.

1398. RICHET, Charles Robert; “Traité de Métaspsychique”; 812 pp.; illus.; index of names; alph.; 23.5

cm; hb.; Librairie Félix Alcan; Paris; Janvrier, 1922; pp. 700-714; eds.: Fr., Eng., Sp., Port.

1399. RICHMANN, Gary; “Caso Hermínio-Bianca, Dura Missão Após um Contato de

3.º Grau”; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; N. 94; illus.; July, 1980; pp. 50-54.

1400. RICHMOND, Cora L. V.; “My Experiences While Out of My Body”; 76 pp.; 20 cm; hb.;

Christopher Press; Boston; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1915; pp. 1-76.

1401. RIGONATTI, Eliseu; “O Espiritismo Aplicado”; 82 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981; pp. 11-20.

1402. RIGONATTI, Eliseu; “O Evangelho das Recordações”; 254 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1983; pp. 25, 77, 78, 82, 84, 88, 100, 123, 163-165, 169, 170, 188, 246.

1403. RILAND, George; “The New Steinerbooks Dictionary of the Paranormal”; 8 + 358 pp.; illus.; 21

cm; hb.; Rudolf Steiner Publications; New York; 1980; pp. 17, 29, 271, 343.

1404. RING, Kenneth; “Commentary on “The Reality of Death Experiences: A Personal Perspective”

(Ernst A. Rodin); The Journal of Nervous and Mental Disease; Baltimore; Maryland; U. S. A.; Vol.

168; N. 5; 1980; bibl. 274; pp. 273, 274.

1405. RING, Kenneth; “Further Studies of the Near-Death Experience”; Theta; Durham; North Carolina;

U. S. A.; Magazine; Vol. 7; 1979; pp. 1-3.

1406. RING, Kenneth; “Life at Death: A Scientific Investigation of the Near-Death Experience”; introd.

Raymond Moody; 310 pp.; illus.; bibl. 297-300; alph.; 23.5 cm; pb.; Quill; New York; 1982; pp. 1-

310.

1407. RITCHIE, George Gordon, and SHERRIL, Elisabeth; “Voltar do Amanhã”; pres. Raymond A.

Moody Jr.; transl. Gilberto Campista Guarino; 116 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editorial Nórdica; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; 1981; pp. 33-69, 80, 91, 92 (Mini-library).

1408. RIVERAIN, Jean; “Nuestros Poderes Ocultos”; transl. Eduardo Pons Prades; 144 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1973; pp. 118-120, 124-129.

1409. RIZZINI, Carlos Toledo; “Evolução Para o Terceiro Milênio: Tratado Psíquico Para o Homem

Moderno”; pref. Celso Martins; 296 pp.; bibl. 269, 270; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Edicel; S. Paulo;

Brazil; 1980; pp. 37-39, 68, 71, 81, 87, 89, 156, 157.

1410. RIZZINI, Carlos Toledo; “O Homem e Sua Felicidade”; 248 pp.; illus.; bibl. 229-232; glos. 232-

247; 21 cm; pb.; Edições Correio Fraterno; S. Bernardo do Campo, SP; Brazil; March, 1984; pp. 95,

96.

1411. RIZZINI, Jorge; “Eurípedes Barsanulfo: O Apóstolo da Caridade”; 134 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

Edições Correio Fraterno; S. Bernardo do Campo, SP; Brazil; 1979; pp. 75, 76.

1412. RIZZO, Samuel S.; “Psico-Bio-Física ou Metafísica Científica”; Estudos Psíquicos; Lisboa;

Portugal; Magazine; Monthly; 39th Yr.; N. 3; March, 1978; pp. 70-77.

1413. RIZZO, Samuel S.; “Report on Metapsychical Investigation”; 108 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Livraria

Freitas Bastos; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1965; pp. 10, 11, 75.

Page 59: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1414. ROBERTS, Jane; “Adventures in Consciousness”; XII + 290 pp.; illus.; glos. 280, 281; alph.; 18

cm; pocket; pb.; Bantam Books; New York; July, 1979; pp. 81, 191, 199.

1415. ROBERTS, Jane; “The Afterdeath Journal of an American Philosopher: The World View of

William James”; 242 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Prentice-Hall; Englewood Cliffs; New Jersey; U. S. A.;

1978; pp. 112.

1416. ROBERTS, Jane; “The Coming of Seth”; XVIII + 252 pp.; bibl. 251, 252; 18 cm; pocket; pb.;

Pocket Books; New York; April, 1976; pp. XI, 208, 209, 233, 236.

1417. ROBERTS, Jane; “The Education of Oversoul Seven”; Prentice-Hall; Englewoods Cliffs; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1973.

1418. ROBERTS, Jane; “The Nature of the Psyche”; 258 pp.; alph.; 17.5 cm; pocket; pb.; Bantam

Books; New York; January, 1984; p. 34.

1419. ROBERTS, Jane; “Psychic Politics”; 374 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Prentice-Hall; Englewoods Cliffs;

New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1976; pp. 208-211.

1420. ROBERTS, Jane; “The Seth Material”; XIV + 318 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Prentice-Hall;

Englewoods Cliffs; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1970; pp. 71-78, 97-110.

1421. ROBERTS, Jane; “Seth Speaks”; XXVIII + 516 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Prentice-Hall; Englewoods

Cliffs; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1972; pp. 73, 254, 255, 257.

1422. ROBERTS, Jane; “The ‘Unknown’ Reality: A Seth Book”; 296 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.;

Prentice-Hall; Englewood Cliffs; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1977; pp. 81, 82.

1423. ROCHA, Alberto de Souza; “Letargia e Catalepsia”; Desobsessão; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil;

Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XXXI; N. 373; March, 1979; pp. 1, 5.

1424. ROCHA, Alberto de Souza; “Perispírito e Projeção”; Revista Internacional do Espiritismo;

Matão, SP; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. LVIII; N. 8; September, 1983; pp. 228-230.

1425. ROCHA, Boanerges da (Pseud. for Indalício Hildegardo Mendes); “Importante Experiência de

Desdobramento Voluntário”; Reformador; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 79; N. 7; July, 1961; pp. 157, 158.

1426. ROCHAS, Eugène August Albert D’Aiglun; “The Bordeland of Physics”; without translator; The

Two Worlds; Manchester; England; Newspaper; Weekly; Vol. XI; N. 555; July 1, 1898;

pp. 421-423.

1427. ROCHAS, Eugène August Albert D’Aiglun; “Experiências de Bilocação”; without translator;

Estudos Psíquicos; Lisboa; Portugal; Magazine; Monthly; N. 10; March, 1907; pp. 187-191.

1428. ROCHAS, Eugène August Albert D’Aiglun; “L’Exteriorisation de la Motricité”; VIII + 482 pp.;

illus.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Chamuel, Éditeur; Paris; 1896; pp. 337-346.

1429. ROCHAS, Eugène August Albert D’Aiglun; “L’Exteriorisation de la Sensibilité”; XII + 252 pp.;

illus.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Chamuel; Éditeur; Paris; 1895; pp. 47-73.

1430. ROCHAS, Eugène August Albert D’Aiglun; “Les Vies Successives”; 504 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.;

Librairie Genérale des Sciences Occultes; Paris; 1911; pp. 39-43; eds.: Fr., Port.

1431. RODRIGUES, Antonio Fernandes, and MARTINS, Celso; “Na Rota do Ano 2.000”; pres.

Rodrigues de Camargo; 114 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora e Gráfica ABC do Interior; Conchas, SP; Brazil;

1984; pp. 27-29.

1432. RODRIGUES, Henrique; “Curso Intensivo de Parapsicologia e Psicobiofísica”; 48 pp.; illus.; 27.5

cm; pb.; Centro de Estudos Psicobiofísicos; Belo Horizonte, MG; Brazil; no date; pp. 13, 14, 17, 39, 40.

1433. RODRIGUES, Ubirajara Franco; “Parapsicologia e Justiça”; 170 pp.; glos. 163-169; bibl. 161,

162; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Gráfica Véritas; Três Corações, MG; Brazil; no date; p. 167.

1434. RODRIGUES, Wallace Leal V.; “Entrevista com o Eng. Hernani Guimarães Andrade”; Revista

Internacional do Espiritismo; Matão, SP; Brazil; Monthly; N. 9; October, 1974; illus.; pp. 271-277.

1435. ROGO, D. Scott; “Aspects of Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; Journal of the Society for Psychical

Research; London; Vol. 48; N. 768; June, 1976; pp. 329-335.

1436. ROGO, D. Scott; “An Experience of Phantoms”; 214 pp.; illus.; bibl. 207-209; alph.; 21 cm; hb.;

dj.; Taplinger Publishing Co.; New York; 1974; pp. 90-105, 119-122, 133, 161-180, 185, 186, 201,

202; eds.: Eng., It.

1437. ROGO, D. Scott; “Astral Projection: A Risky Practice?”; Fate; Evanston; Ill.;

U. S. A.; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 26; N. 5; Issue 278; May, 1973; pp. 74-80.

1438. ROGO, D. Scott; “Case Studies in Parapsychology”; Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 15;

N. 5; September-October, 1984; pp. 5-7.

Page 60: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1439. ROGO, D. Scott; “En Busca de lo Desconocido”; transl. Esteban Serra; 180 pp.; 20 cm; pb.;

Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1982; pp. 46-74, 143, 144; eds.: Eng., Sp.

1440. ROGO, D. Scott; “A Experiência Fora do Corpo”; without translator; Planeta; S. Paulo; Brazil;

Magazine; Monthly; N. 73; October, 1978; pp. 24-29.

1441. ROGO, D. Scott; “Astral Projection in Tibetan Buddhist Literature”; International Journal of

Parapsychology; U. S. A.; Vol. 10; N. 3; Autumn, 1968; pp. 277-284.

1442. ROGO, D. Scott; “Exploring Psychic Phenomena”; 168 pp.; bibl. 162, 163; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; The

Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1976; pp. 11, 72-93, 107, 143. 1443. ROGO, D. Scott; “Events On the Threshold of the Afterlife” (Robert Crookall); Books Reviews;

Theta; Durham; North Carolina; U. S. A.; Magazine; N. 38; Winter, 1973;

pp. 5, 6.

1444. ROGO, D. Scott; “Leaving the Body: A Practical Guide to Astral Projection”; introd. Charles

Theodore Tart; XIV + 190 pp.; illus.; bibl. 185; alph.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Prentice-Hall; Englewood Cliffs;

New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1983; pp. I-XIV, 1-190 (Mini-library).

1445. ROGO, D. Scott; “Man Does Survive Death: The Welcoming Silence”; 192

pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; The Citadel Press; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1977; pp. 13-50, 66, 67.

1446. ROGO, D. Scott; “Mind Beyond the Body: The Mystery of ESP Projection”; Anthology; 366 pp.;

illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Penguin Books; New York; 1978; pp. 1-366; eds.: Eng., It.

1447. ROGO, D. Scott; “Miracles: A Parascientific Inquiry Into Wondrous Phenomena”; XII + 334 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 315-321; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; Contemporary Books; Chicago; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1983; pp. 1, 3, 8,

30, 65, 68, 70, 81-109, 202, 265, 299, 301, 305, 308, 313.

1448. ROGO, D. Scott; “NAD: A Study of Some Unusual “Other-World” Experiences”; post-script:

Robert Crookall; 176 pp.; bibl. 173-176; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; University Books; New York; 1970; pp. 18-

35, 39, 50, 58, 63-67, 70, 87, 114, 129-134, 142-144, 148, 157-170.

1449. ROGO, D. Scott; “Out-of-Body Dimensions”; in “Other-Worlds, Other Universes”; Brad Steiger and John White; Editors; Doubleday; Garden City, N. Y.; 1977.

1450. ROGO, D. Scott; “Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; Psychic; U. S. A.; Magazine; March-April,

1973; illus.; pp. 50-55.

1451. ROGO, D. Scott; “Parapsychology: A Century of Inquiry”; 318 pp.; bibl. 305-307; alph.; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Dell Publishing Co.; New York; April, 1976; pp. 274-279.

1452. ROGO, D. Scott; “Parapsychology at the APA”; Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 12; N.

6; November-December, 1981; pp. 6-9.

1453. ROGO, D. Scott; “The Poltergeist Experience”; 302 pp.; alph.; 18.5 cm; pocket; pb.; Penguin

Books; New York; 1979; pp. 241-247.

1454. ROGO, D. Scott; “Psychic Researchers Dismiss Mediumship”; Two Worlds; London; Magazine;

Monthly; 81st Year; N. 3893; June, 1968; pp. 186, 187.

1455. ROGO, D. Scott; “A Psychic Study of “The Music of the Spheres”; NAD; Vol. II; pref. Raymond

Bayless; 176 pp.; bibl. 173-176; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; University Books; Secaucus;

N. J.; U. S. A.; 1972; pp. 9, 17, 24, 27, 46-48, 157-161.

1456. ROGO, D. Scott; “Psychological Models of the Out-of-Body Experience”; Journal of

Parapsychology; U. S. A.; Vol. 46; 1982; pp. 29-45.

1457. ROGO, D. Scott; “Researching the Out-of-Body Experience: The State of the Art”; Anabiosis: The Journal for Near-Death Studies; U. S. A.; Vol. 4; N. 1; Spring, 1984; bibl.

45-49; pp. 21-49.

1458. ROGO, D. Scott; “El Universo Encantado”; transl. Jorge Binaghi; 198 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; Ediciones

Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1981; p. 39.

1459. ROGO, D. Scott; & BAYLESS, Raymond; “Phone Calls From the Dead”; XIV

+ 210 pp.; bibl. 197-201; alph.; 17.5 cm; pocket; pb.; Berkley Publishing Corporation; New York; Fe-

bruary, 1980; pp. 79, 80; eds.: Eng., It.

1460. ROHMER, Sax (Pseud. for Arthur Sarsfield Ward); “Astral Voyages”; Pall Mall Gazette; Great

Britain; September, 1935.

1461. ROLIM, P.; “O Problema Espiritista”; 614 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; Casa do Castelo Editora; Coimbra;

Portugal; 1932; pp. 336-338, 446, 450-455.

1462. ROLL, William G.; Editor; “Research in Parapsychology 1977”; Anthology; VIII

+ 272 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; alph.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1978; pp. 11-14, 28.

Page 61: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1463. ROLL, William G.; Editor; “Research in Parapsychology 1978”; Anthology; VIII

+ 212 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1979; pp. 3, 9, 19, 31,

34, 50-52, 135-138.

1464. ROLL, William G.; Editor; “Research in Parapsychology 1979”; Anthology; VI

+ 232 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1980; pp. 21, 142-145.

1465. ROLL, William G.; & BELOFF, John; Editors; “Research in Parapsychology 1980”; Anthology;

VI + 168 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 11, 14,

105, 106, 125, 132, 138, 142. 1466. ROLL, William G.; BELOFF, John; & WHITE, Rhea Amelia; Editors; “Research in

Parapsychology 1982”; Anthology; XVI + 366 pp.; index of names; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scare-

crow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1983; pp. 6, 8, 18, 20, 28, 130, 131, 225, 229-234.

1467. ROLL, William G.; MORRIS, Robert L.; & MORRIS, J. D.; Editors; “Research in

Parapsychology 1972”; Anthology; 250 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N.

J.; U. S. A.; 1973; pp. 12, 78, 79, 178, 184, 185.

1468. ROLL, William G.; MORRIS, Robert L.; &MORRIS, J. D.; Editors; “Research in Parapsychology

1973”; Anthology; 250 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1974;

pp. 6, 36-41, 107-120.

1469. ROLL, William G.; MORRIS, Robert L.; & WHITE, Rhea Amelia; Editors; “Research in

Parapsychology 1981”; Anthology; 246 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N.

J.; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 42, 73-75, 124, 190, 191.

1470. ROLL, William G.; “Studies of Communication During Out-of-Body Experiences”; The Journal

of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 72;

N. 1; January, 1978; bibl. 20, 21; pp. 3-21.

1471. RORIZ, Julio Cesar de Sá; “Experiências Extracorpóreas”; Presença Espírita; Salvador, BA;

Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 104; October, 1982; pp. 20, 21. 1472. ROSACRUZ; Ordem; “Monografia Oficial”; Temple’s Section; 8.º Grade; 8 pp.;

N. 16; 25.5 cm; pb.; Ordem Rosacruz; Curitiba, PR; Brazil; no date; pp. 1, 2.

1473. ROSACRUZ; Ordem; “Monografia Oficial”; Temple’s Section; 8.º Grade; 6 pp.;

N. 17; 25.5 cm; pb.; Ordem Rosacruz; Curitiba, PR; Brazil; no date; pp. 1, 2.

1474. ROSE, Karen; “In the Land of the Mind”; 266 pp.; bibl. 254-260; Atheneum; New York; 1975.

1475. ROSIN, Zilda Giunchetti; “Perda de Entes Queridos”; 160 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

8th ed.; Instituto Maria; Juiz de Fora, MG; Brazil; no date; pp. 30-32, 35, 42-44, 48, 53, 54, 76, 82, 90,

97, 101, 105, 109, 122, 123, 138, 140, 142-148.

1476. ROSSI, Hélio; “Somatorpor: Menor Resistência ao Afloramento Mediúnico”; Correio Fraterno

do ABC; S. Bernardo do Campo, SP; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XVI; N. 147; March, 1983; p.

5.

1477. ROSSI-PAGNONI, Francesco, et MORONI, Luigi; “Quelques Essais de Médiumnité

Hypnotique”; transl. Francisca Vigné; 124 pp.; 22 cm; pb.; Librairie des Sciences Psychologiques;

Paris; no date; pp. 115, 116.

1478. ROUHIER, Alexandre; “Le Peyotl: Des Plantes Divinatoires”; pref. Em. Perrot; XII + 376 + 34

pp.; illus.; bibl. 71, 72, 365-375; 22 cm; pb.; Guy Trédaniel; Paris; 1975; pp. 5-12, 25-28.

1479. ROURE, Lucien; “Le Merveilleux Spirite”; VIII + 398 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Gabriel Beauchesne; Paris; 1917; pp. 104-107, 111-124.

1480. ROY, Dilip Kumar, and DEVI, Indira; “Peregrinos das Estrelas”; transl. Gilberto Bernardes de

Oliveira; prol. Frederic Spielgelberg; 310 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1976; pp. 150, 204, 219-221.

1481. RPA; Editor; “Enciclopédia de Ciências Ocultas e Parapsicologia”; transl. Clarice Tavares and J.

Santos Tavares; prfr. Elizabete Reis; 4 Vol.; 1.200 pp.; illus.; 31 cm; hb.; RPA Publicações; Lisboa;

Portugal; 1978; Vol. 2: pp. 7-35.

1482. RUSSELL, Edward Wriothesley C.; “Projeto para o Destino: A Revelação da Alma pela Ciência”;

transl. Maio Miranda; 188 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1983;

pp. 112, 113, 135, 142, 188.

1483. RUTLEDGE, Archibald; “Things We Can’t Explain”; The Reader’s Digest; U. S. A.; Magazine;

Monthly; Vol. 41; N. 247; November, 1942; pp. 30-32.

1484. RÝZL, Milan; “Der Tod und was danach Kommt”; transl. Helga Künzel; 230 pp.; 22.5 cm; hb.;

dj.; Ariston Verlag; Austria; 1981; pp. 103-115; eds.: Eng., Ger.

Page 62: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1485. RÝZL, Milan; “Parapsicologia, Fatti e Prospettive”; transl. Jacopo Comin; pref. Ettore Mengoli;

288 pp.; glos. 273-275; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Edizioni Mediterranee; Roma; Italy; January, 1978;

pp. 91, 95, 125, 128, 137, 140-142, 235, 246, 273; eds.: Eng., It.

1486. SABOM, Michael B.; “Recollections of Death: A Medical Investigation”; 302 pp.; bibl. 287-292;

alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Corgi Books; London; 1982; pp. 1-302 (Mini-library).

1487. SABOM, Michael B.; “Near-Death Experiences”; New England Journal of Medicine; Vol. 297;

N. 19; 1977; p. 1071.

1488. SABOM, Michael B., and BLACHER, Richard S.; “The Near-Death Experiences”; The Journal of the American Medical Association; Vol. 244; N. 1; July 4, 1980; pp. 29, 30.

1489. SACHS, Margaret; “The Ufo Encyclopedia”; 408 pp.; illus.; bibl. 401-408; 23.5 cm; pb.; Perigee

Book; New York; 1980; p. 155.

1490. SADHU, Mouni; “Samadhi: The Superconsciousness of the Future”; 182 pp.; bibl. 182; 20 cm;

pb.; Unwin Paperbacks; London; 1971; pp. 171-181.

1491. SADHU, Mouni; “El Tarot”; transl. Hector Vicente Morel; 516 pp.; illus.; bibl. 513, 514; 23 cm;

pb.; 3rd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1978; pp. 330-340.

1492. SAGAN, Carl; “O Romance da Ciência”; transl. Carlos Alberto Medeiros; 346 pp.; bibl. 331-334;

21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Livraria Francisco Alves Editora; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1982; p. 61.

1493. SAHER, P. J.; “Zen-Yoga: A Creative Psychoterapy to Self-Integration”; XXIV

+ XX + 294 pp.; illus.; bibl. 240-256; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Motilal Banarsidass; Delhi; India; 1976;

pp. 26-28, 146.

1494. SAINT-JEAN, Célestin; “Guide du Magnétiseur Spirite”; 160 pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Librairie Spirite;

Paris; 1912; pp. 130-142.

1495. SAISSET, Frédéric; “Qu’est-ce que la Métapsychique?”; 112 pp.; glos. 98-110; 18.5 cm; pb.;

Éditions Niclaus; Paris; 1950; pp. 26, 98, 101-103, 109.

1496. SALLEY, Roy D.; “REM Sleep Phenomena During Out-of-Body Experiences”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 76; N. 2; April,

1982; bibl. 164, 165; pp. 157-165.

1497. SALOMON, Paule; COOPER, Charlie; et MOEBIUS (Pseud. for Jean Giraud); “La

Parapsychologie et Vous”; 152 pp.; illus.; bibl. 149-151; 27 cm; cart.; Albin Michel; Paris; 1980;

pp. 140-142.

1498. SALTER, William Henry; “A Further Report on Sittings with Mrs. Leonard”; Proceedings of the

Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. XXXII; Part. LXXXII; June, 1921; pp. 133-143.

1499. SAMDUP, Lama Kazi Dawa; “O Livro dos Mortos Tibetano” (Bardo Thödol); transl. and introd.

Norberto de Paula Lima and Márcio Pugliesi; 374 pp.; illus.; glos. 367-370; bibl. 371, 372; 21 cm; pb.;

Hemus Livraria Editora; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1980; pp. 201, 250.

1500. SAMUELS, Mike, and SAMUELS, Nancy; “Seeing with the Mind’s Eye”; pref. Don Gerrard; XX

+ 332 pp.; illus.; alph.; 28 cm; cart.; Random House; New York; April, 1979;

pp. 282, 283.

1501. SÁNCHEZ-PÉREZ, J. M.; “El Sexto Sentido: Bases Orgánicas de la Percepción Extrasensorial”;

160 pp.; bibl. 157, 158; 19 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editorial Biblioteca Nueva; Madrid; Spain; 1977; pp. 104,

157, 158.

1502. SANDWITH, George; “Magical Mission”; 256 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Omega Press; Reigate; Surrey; Great Britain; 1954; pp. 11-17.

1503. SANGIRARDI JR.; “O Índio e as Plantas Alucinógenas”; 108 pp.; illus.; bibl. 189, 190; 21 cm;

pb.; Editorial Alhambra; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 65, 181-186.

1504. SAN MARTIN, Paulo B., and PELEGRINI, Bernardo; “A Revolução da Energia”; Brasil

Reporter Dossiê 2; 34 pp.; illus.; 27.5 cm; pb.; Brasil Repórter; Londrina, PR; Brazil; no date; pp. 26,

27, 29.

1505. SANTOS, Izidoro Duarte; “Um Caso de Desdobramento”; Estudos Psíquicos; Lisboa; Portugal;

Magazine; Monthly; 26th Yr.; N. 6; June, 1965; p. 187.

1506. SARA, Dorothy; “ESP: Fact or Fantasy?”; 192 pp.; illus.; bibl. 189-192; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; HC

Publishers; New York; 1970; pp. 134-137.

1507. SARAYDARIAN, H.; “La Ciencia de la Meditacion”; transl. Hector V. Morel; 286 pp.; illus.; 23

cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1979; pp. 163, 164, 178.

1508. SARGANT, William; “A Possessão da Mente”; transl. Klaus Scheel; 244 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

Imago Editora; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1975; pp. 60, 61, 199-202.

Page 63: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1509. SATPREM (Pseud.); “Le Mental des Cellules”; 216 pp.; Éditions Robert Laffont; Paris.

1510. SATPREM (Pseud.); “El Yoga Integral de Sri Aurobindo”; 412 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; pb.; Ediciones

El Caballito; Mexico, D. F.; 1970; pp. 213-221.

1511. SATURNO, Editorial; Editor; “El Libro Infernal: Tratado Completo de las Ciencias Ocultas”; 432

pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editorial Saturno; Mexico, D. F.; no date; pp. 373-375.

1512. SAVA, George; “A Surgeon Remembers”; Faber and Faber; London; 1953.

1513. SCHAPIRO, S. A.; “A Classification Scheme for Out-of-Body Phenomena”; The Journal of

Altered States of Consciousness; Vol. 2; 1976; pp. 259-265. 1514. SCHATZ, Oskar; “Manual de Parapsicologia”; transl. Claudio Gancho; 376 pp.; bibl. 248-255,

345-351; alph.; 22 cm; pb.; Editorial Herder; Barcelona; Spain; 1980; pp. 46, 181-185, 326, 339, 340.

1515. SCHIFF, Jean-Marie; “L’Espace Interieur”; 256 pp.; illus.; bibl. 254, 255; 22 cm; hb.; dj.; Celt;

Paris; 1977; pp. 82, 96, 97, 109-121, 225.

1516. SCHLEICH, Carl Ludwig; “Die Wunder der Seele”; introd. Carl Gustav Jung; 522 pp.; 19.5 cm;

hb.; 5th ed.; S. Fischer Verlag; Berlin; Germany; 1934; pp. 50-52, 59.

1517. SCHMEIDLER, Gertrude R.; “Interpreting Report of Out-of-Body Experiences”; Journal of the

Society for Psychical Research; London; Magazine; Monthly; Vol. 52; N. 794; June, 1983; pp. 102-

104.

1518. SCHMIDT, K. O.; “Erfahrungen bei Jenseits-Wanderungen”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 24; N. 4; April, 1973; pp. 313-315.

1519. SCHNAPER, Nathan; “Comments Germane to the Paper Intitled “The Reality of Death

Experiencies” (Ernst Rodin); The Journal of Nervous and Mental Disease; Baltimore; Maryland; U. S.

A.; Vol. 168; N. 5; 1980; bibl. 270; pp. 268-270.

1520. SCHOPFIELD, Alfred T.; “Modern Spiritism its Science and Religion”; introd. Newell Dwight

Hills; XII + 260 pp.; alph.; 18.5 cm; hb.; P. Blakiston’s Son & Co.; Philadelphia; Pennsylvania; U. S.

A.; 1920; pp. 38, 147, 148. 1521. SCHUBERT, Suely Caldas; “Obsessão / Desobsessão”; pres. Francisco Thiesen; 192 pp.; 18 cm;

pb.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; pp. 35, 133.

1522. SCHUL, Bill; “The Psychic Frontiers of Medicine”; 256 pp.; bibl. 248-250; alph.; 18 cm; pocket;

pb.; Fawcett Publications; Greenwich; Con.; U. S. A.; 1977; pp. 141, 216-219.

1523. SCHUL, Bill, and PETTIT, Ed.; “O Poder Secreto das Pirâmides”; transl. Miécio Araújo Jorge

Honkis; 204 pp.; illus.; bibl. 201-204; 21 cm; pb.; 7th ed.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil;

1981; pp. 45, 153, 154, 156.

1524. SCHUL, Bill, and PETTIT, Ed.; “The Psychic Power of Pyramids”; pref. Hugh

R. Riordan; 256 pp.; illus.; bibl. 250-252; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; Fawcett Gold Medal; New York; 1976; pp.

83-87; eds.: Eng., Port.

1525. SCHUTEL, Cairbar de Souza; “A Vida no Outro Mundo”; 128 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.;

5th ed.; Casa Editora O Clarim; Matão, SP; Brazil; 1978; pp. 21-36.

1526. SCHWARTZ, Emanuel K.; “The Phenomena of Astral Projection” (Muldoon and Carrington);

Books Reviews; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. XLVI;

N. 4; October, 1952; pp. 161-163.

1527. SCHWARTZ, Stephan A.; “The Secret Vaults of Time”; XIV + 370 pp.; illus.; bibl. 353-366;

alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Grosset & Dunlap; New York; 1978; p. 67. 1528. SCOTT, Cyril; “An Outline of Modern Occultism”; VI + 226 pp.; bibl. 225, 226; 18.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1974; pp. 57-67.

1529. SCOTT, Mary; “Kundalini in the Physical World”; 276 pp.; illus.; glos. 253-258; bibl. 259-263;

alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1983; pp. 28, 62-66, 72-74, 129, 220-222, 248.

1530. SCOTT, Mary; “Science & Subtle Bodies: Towards a Clarification of Issues”; Thesis; 50 pp.;

bibl.; College of Psychic Studies; London; 1975.

1531. SCULTHORP, Frederick C.; “Excursions to the Spirit World”; introd. Karl E. Müller; 158 pp.;

18.5 cm; hb.; dj.; The Greater World Association; London; 1973; pp. 1-158; eds.: Eng., Ger. (Mini-

library).

1532. SCULTHORP, Frederick C.; “More About the Spirit World”; introd. A. H. Hillyard; XII + 70 pp.;

18.5 cm; pb.; The Greater World Association Trust; London; 1982; pp. 1-43, 66.

1533. SEABRA, Alberto; “A Alma e o Subconsciente”; 240 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editora O

Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1927; pp. 50-52.

Page 64: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1534. SEABRA, Alberto; “Fenômenos Psíquicos”; 204 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.; Editora

O Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1927; pp. 85-127.

1535. SEABRA, Alberto; “O Problema do Além e do Destino”; 320 pp.; 15.5 cm; hb.; Monteiro Lobato

& Cia. Editores; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1922; pp. 57-76, 86, 98-105, 132-134.

1536. SECH, Alexandre; Co-Authors: Deolindo Amorim, Jorge Andréa, and Altivo Ferreira; “Encontro

com a Cultura Espírita”; pref. José de Freitas Nobre; 206 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Casa Editora O Clarim;

Matão, SP; Brazil; September, 1981; pp. 161-162, 167.

1537. SEGURA, José A.; “O Campo Biopsíquico”; 260 pp.; bibl. 256-259; 21 cm; pb.; Editora do Escritor; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1980; pp. 177, 178.

1538. SEKANEK, Rudolf; “Mutter Silbert, Ein Opfergang”; introd. Gustl Silbert; 294 pp.; illus.; bibl.

281-287; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Otto Reichl Verlag Remagen; Bietigheim; Württemberg; West Germany;

1959; pp. 77-79, 247, 272.

1539. SELDEN, Lois Ann; “Dreams: Secret Messages From Your Mind”; 128 pp.; illus.; bibl. 127, 128;

21 cm; cart.; Dream Research; Tacoma, WA; U. S. A.; September, 1981; p. 126.

1540. SENILLOSA, Felipe; “Évolution de l’Ame et de la Societé”; transl. and pref. Alfred Ebelot; 272

pp.; 17.5 cm; hb.; Chamuel, Éditeur; Paris; 1899; pp. 172, 177-190.

1541. SEPHARIAL (Pseud. for Walter Gorn Old); “A Manual of Occultism”; XII + 356 pp.; illus.; 20

cm; pb.; 3rd print.; Rider and Co.; London; 1975; pp. 326-330; eds.: Eng., Port.

1542. SERRANO, Miguel; “El Circulo Hermetico: De Hermann Hesse a C. G. Jung”; 188 pp.; illus.;

19.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1978; pp. 147, 148, 160.

1543. SHADOWITZ, Albert, and WALSH, Peter; “The Dark Side of Knowledge”; XII

+ 306 pp.; illus.; bibl. 289-296; alph.; 23.5 cm; pb.; Addison-Wesley Publishing Co.; Menlo Park; Cal.;

U. S. A.; 1976; pp. 156-158.

1544. SHAPIN, Betty, and COLY, Lisette; Editors; “Parapsychology’s Second Century”; Anthology; 14

+ 156 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; hb.; Parapsychology Foundation; New York; 1983; pp. 77-98, 153-156.

1545. SHATTOCK, E. H.; “Power Thinking: How to Develop the Energy Potential of Your Mind”; 160

pp.; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Turnstone Press; Wellingborough; Northamptonshire; Great Britain; 1983; pp.

138.

1546. SHAY, Joseph M.; “Out of Body Consciousness”; introd. Paul Twitchell; 108 pp.; 14 cm; pb.;

Lumen Press; St. Louis; Missouri; U. S. A.; 1972; pp. 1-108 (Mini-library).

1547. SHIELS, Dean; “A Cross-Cultural Study of Beliefs in Out-of-the-Body Experiences”; Journal of

the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 49; N. 779; 1978; illus.;

pp. 697-741.

1548. SHEPARD, Leslie A.; Editor; “Encyclopedia of Occultism & Parapsychology”;

2 Vol.; 1.084 pp.; 28 cm; pb.; Avon Books; New York; March, 1980; p. 60.

1549. SHEPHERD, A. P.; “A Scientist of the Invisible” (Rudolf Steiner); Biography; 222 pp.; illus.;

alph.; 19 cm; hb.; dj.; 6th print.; Hodder and Stoughton; London; 1969; pp. 92, 93, 189, 190.

1550. SHERMAN, Harold; “A Vida Não Termina com a Morte”; transl. Almira Botelho Guimarães; 212

pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; pp. 68-88; eds.: Eng., It., Port.

1551. SHERMAN, Harold; “Your Mysterious Powers of ESP”; 240 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; New

American Library; New York; December, 1969; pp. 180-199. 1552. SHERMAN, Loren Albert; “Science of the Soul”; XVIII + 414 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; hb.; The

Sherman Co.; Port Huron; Mich.; U. S. A.; 1895.

1553. SHIRLEY, Ralph; “The Mystery of the Human Double”; 190 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Rider & Co.;

London; 1938; pp. 1-190.

1554. SHIRLEY, Ralph; “Occultists & Mystics of All Ages”; pref. Leslie Shepard;

X + 176 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; pb.; The Citadel Press; Secaucus; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1974; pp. IV, 106,

107.

1555. SIBLEY, Mulford Quickert; “Life After Death?”; 160 pp.; bibl. 154-157; Dillon Press;

Minneapolis; Minnesota; U. S. A.; 1975.

1556. SIDGWICK, Eleanor Mildred; and GURNEY, Edmund; MYERS, Frederic W. H.; and

PODMORE, Frank; “Phantasms of the Living”; 2 Vol. in one; 1.018 pp.; 24 cm; hb.; University

Books; New York; 1962; pp. 151-354.

Page 65: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1557. SIDGWICK, Henry; JOHNSON, Alice; MYERS, Frederic W. H.; PODMORE, Frank; and

SIDGWICK, Eleanor Mildred; “Report on the Census of Hallucinations”; Proceedings of the Society

for Psychical Research; London; 464 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; 1894; pp. 207-263, 278-293.

1558. SIEVERS, Bernhard; “Die Probleme des Okkultismus und anderer Grenzgebiete”; 188 pp.; illus.;

19.5 cm; pb.; Author’s Edition; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1944; pp. 100-105, 112.

1559. SILVA, Aloysio Alfredo; “Gênios ou Ingênuos?”; 164 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Shogun Editora e Arte;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 23, 29, 48, 49, 53-55, 64, 97, 112.

1560. SILVA, Eponina M. Pereira da; “Corpo Astral, Exteriorização e Bilocação”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. X; N. 116; November, 1983; illus.; pp. 1, 4.

1561. SILVA, F. L. de Azevedo; “Fundamentos Científicos do Espiritismo”; Thesis; 128 pp.; 18 cm;

pb.; Edição do 1.º Congresso Brasileiro de Jornalistas Espíritas; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1941; pp. 106-

111.

1562. SILVA, Woodrow Wilson da Matta and (Yapacani); “Umbanda e o Poder da Mediunidade”; 158

pp.; illus.; 23 cm; pb.; 2nd ed. rev.; Livraria Freitas Bastos; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978;

pp. 120-126.

1563. SIMON, V.; “Desdobramento”; Estudos Psíquicos; Lisboa; Portugal; Magazine; Monthly; 25th

Yr.; N. 9; September, 1964; pp. 280-282.

1564. SINCLAIR, Upton; “Radar der Psyche”; transl. Rosemarie Dopner; pref. Albert Einstein; introd.

William Mc Dougall; 292 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Scherz Verlag; Bern; Switzerland; 1973; pp. 73-

78; eds.: Eng., Ger.

1565. SINNETT, Alfred Percy; “O Mundo Oculto”; transl. Mário de Alemquer; 286 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; 2nd

ed.; Livraria Clássica Editora; Lisboa; Portugal; 1922; pp. 80-107.

1566. SLATER, Philip; “The Wayward Gate: Science and the Supernatural”; XVIII

+ 238 pp.; bibl. 235-238; 20.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Beacon Press; Boston; Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1977; pp.

126-128. 1567. SMITH, Adam (Pseud. for George Jerome Waldo Goodman); “Powers of Mind”; VIII + 420 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 403-419; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Ballantine Books; New York; 1978;

pp. 347-350.

1568. SMITH, Alson J.; “Immortality: The Scientific Evidence”; 174 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.;

Signet Mystic Book; New York; 1967; pp. 155, 158.

1569. SMITH, Enid S.; “Interessantes Viagens Astrais”; Estudos Psíquicos; Lisboa; Portugal; Magazine;

Monthly; 25th Yr.; N. 1; January, 1964; pp. 10-12.

1570. SMITH, Paula, and IRWIN, Harvey; “Out-of-Body Experiences, Needs, and the Experimental

Approach: A Laboratory Study”; Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 12;

N. 3; May-June, 1981; bibl. 4; pp. 1-4.

1571. SMITH, Susy; “A Busca da Imortalidade: Você e a Reencarnação”; transl. Affonso Blacheyre;

174 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 93-112.

1572. SMITH, Susy; “The Enigma of Out-of-Body Travel”; 190 pp.; bibl. 179-184; alph.; 21 cm; hb.;

Garrett Publications; New York; 1965; pp. 1-190 (Mini-library).

1573. SMITH, Susy; “More ESP for the Millions”; 156 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Sherbourne Press; Los Angeles;

Cal.; U. S. A.; 1969; pp. 135-142.

1574. SMITH, Susy; “Out-of-Body Experiences for the Millions”; 160 pp.; 21 cm; cart.; Sherbourne Press; Los Angeles; Cal.; U. S. A.; 1968; pp. 1-160.

1575. SMITH, Susy; “O Que é ESP”; transl. Charles Marie Antoine Bovéry; 116 pp.; bibl. 115; 21 cm;

pb.; Edições MM; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1973; pp. 87-100.

1576. SMITH, W. S. Montgomery; “Life and Work in the Spiritual Body”; Hillside Press; London; pp.

14, 64, 87.

1577. SMITH, W. Whately; “A Theory of the Mechanism of Survival: The Fourth Dimension and its

Applications”; 12 + 196 pp.; illus.; alph.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Kegan Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co.; London;

1920; pp. 149-158.

1578. SMYTHE, F. S.; “The Spirit of the Hills”; Hodder and Stoughton; London; 1937; pp. 277, 278.

1579. SNELL, Joy; “The Ministry of Angels”; 190 pp.; 23.5 cm; hb.; The Citadel Press; New York;

April, 1959; pp. 91-101.

1580. SOBRINHO, J. Dias; “Forças Ocultas, Luz e Caridade”; 182 pp.; bibl. 175; 18.5 cm; hb.; 2nd ed.;

Gráfica Editora Aurora; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1951; p. 102.

Page 66: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1581. SOLLIER, Paul; “Les Phénomènes d’Autoscopie”; 176 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; Félix Alcan,

Éditeur; Paris; 1903; pp. 140-147.

1582. SOMERLOTT, Robert; “Modern Occultism”; 312 pp.; illus.; bibl. 295-301; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.;

dj.; Robert Hale & Co.; London; 1972; pp. 110, 111.

1583. SOTTO, Alain, and OBERTO, Varinia; “A Vida Depois da Morte”; transl. Torquato Fernandes;

198 pp.; illus.; bibl. 196-198; 21 cm; pb.; Publicações Europa-América; Mira-Sintra; Portugal; 1978;

pp. 80-96.

1584. SOUZA, Denizard; “Contribuição Cultural ao Estudo das Alucinações”; 12 pp.; Offprint; XII Congresso Latino-Americano de Psiquiatria; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil; November, 1983; bibl. 12; pp.

11-12.

1585. SOUZA, Leal de; “No Mundo dos Espíritos: Inquérito de “A Noite”; pref. Horacio Cartier; 426

pp.; illus.; 23 cm; pb.; A Noite; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1925; pp. 122-125, 376, 377, 424.

1586. SPALDING, Baird T.; “Life and Teaching of the Masters of the Far East”; 5 Vol.; 846 pp.; 21 cm;

pb.; De Vorss & Co., Publishers; Marina Del Rey; Cal.; U. S. A.; 1964; Vol. I:

pp. 36-40, 48-50; eds.: Eng., Port.

1587. SPARROW, Gregory Scott; “Lucid Dreaming Dawning of the Clear Light”; 70 pp.; illus.; bibl.

69; 21.5 cm; pb.; ed. rev.; Association for Research and Enlightenment Press; Virginia Beach;

Virginia; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 1, 2, 20, 21, 60, 68.

1588. SPENCE, Lewis; “An Encyclopaedia of Occultism”; XXIV + 440 pp.; illus.; 25 cm; pb.; The

Citadel Press; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1977; pp. 41, 42.

1589. SPRAGGETT, Allen; “The Case for Immortality”; 154 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; New American

Library; New York; 1974; pp. 68-93.

1590. SPRAGGETT, Allen; “New Worlds of the Unexplained”; XIV + 192 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.;

New American Library; New York; February, 1976; pp. 86-88.

1591. SPRAGGETT, Allen; “Probing the Unexplained”; 184 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Signet Book; New York; 1973; p. 162.

1592. SPRAGGETT, Allen; “The Unexplained”; pref. James A. Pike; X + 230 pp.; bibl. 230; 21 cm;

hb.; dj.; New American Library; New York; 1967; pp. 183-195.

1593. ST. CLAIR, David; “Lessons in Instant ESP”; 200 pp.; illus.; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; New

American Library; New York; September, 1979; pp. 9, 147-156.

1594. STAFF, V. S.; “Intimations of Immortality” (Robert Crookall); Books Reviews; Journal of the

Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 44; N. 738; December, 1968;

pp. 412-414.

1595. STANKÉ, Alain; “Lobsang Rampa: O Enigma”; transl. M. de Campos; 178 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

Publicações Europa-América; Mira-Sintra; Portugal; no date; pp. 36, 37, 55-61, 67, 68, 110, 112, 162,

171, 174-176.

1596. STARKE, D.; “Le Spiritisme”; 116 pp.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Éditions Nilsson; Paris;

no date; pp. 73-84.

1597. STEAD, Estelle W.; “My Father: Personal and Spiritual Reminiscences”; Biography; 378 pp.; 18

cm; hb.; Thomas Nelson and Sons; London; no date; pp. 183, 242-248.

1598. STEAD, William Thomas; “Bordeland: A Casebook of True Supernatural Stories”; introd. Leslie

Shepard; XXIV + 344 pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; University Books; New York; 1970; pp. 24-51, 95-107, 132-135, 330-332.

1599. STEAD, William Thomas; “Life Eternal”; pref. Stanley de Brath; 286 pp.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Wright &

Brown; London; 1933; pp. 232-235.

1600. STEBBING, Lionel; “A Dictionary of the Occult Sciences”; 8 + 252 pp.; 22 cm; pb.; Emerson

Press; London; no date; pp. 14, 15, 158.

1601. STEIGER, Brad (Pseud. for Eugene E. Olson); “Astral Projection”; 234 pp.; alph.; 23.5 cm; pb.;

Para Research; Rockport; Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1982; pp. 1-234 (Mini-library).

1602. STEIGER, Brad (Pseud. for Eugene E. Olson); “Las Experiencias Psíquicas de Olof Jonsson”;

transl. Antonio Ribera; introd. David Techter; 298 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Ediciones Martínez Roca;

Barcelona; Spain; 1974; pp. 151-158.

1603. STEIGER, Brad (Pseud. for Eugene E. Olson); “Kahuna Magic”; 128 pp.; bibl. 123; alph.; 23.5

cm; pb.; Para Research; Rockport; Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1981; pp. 47-51.

1604. STEIGER, Brad (Pseud. for Eugene E. Olson); “The Mind Travellers”; Award Books; New York;

1969.

Page 67: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1605. STEIGER, Brad (Pseud. for Eugene E. Olson), and WILLIANS, Loring; “Minds Through Space

and Time”; 156 pp.; Award Books; New York; 1971.

1606. STEIGER, Brad (Pseud. for Eugene E. Olson); “In My Soul I Am Free”; Biography; 208 pp.;

alph.; 17.5 cm; pb.; Illuminated Way Press; Menlo Park; Cal.; U. S. A.; no date;

pp. 32, 37, 38, 81-105, 134, 135, 146, 181-184.

1607. STEIGER, Brad (Pseud. for Eugene E. Olson); “Mysteries of Time and Space”; 284 pp.; illus.;

alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Dell Publishing Co.; New York; March, 1976; pp. 236, 237, 245-247.

1608. STEIGER, Brad (Pseud. for Eugene E. Olson); “Sex and Supernatural”; 192 pp.; Lancer Books; New York; 1968.

1609. STEIGER, Brad (Pseud. for Eugene E. Olson); & STEIGER, Francie; “The Star People”; 202 pp.;

alph.; 17.5 cm; pocket; pb.; 3rd print.; Berkley Books; New York; December, 1981; pp. 65, 66, 73, 74,

104-109.

1610. STEINER, Rudolf; “An Outline of Occult Science”; transl. Maud Monges and Henry B. Monges;

prfr. Lisa D. Monges; XXXVI + 388 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 2nd print.; Anthroposophic Press; Spring

Valley, N. Y.; U. S. A.; 1974; pp. 47-60; eds.: Eng., Port.

1611. STEINER, Rudolf; “Come se Adquiere el Conocimiento de los Mundos Superiores?”; transl. Juan

Berlin y Melchor de la Garza and Francisco Schneider; 172 pp.; 20 cm; pb.;

3rd ed.; Editorial Dedalo; Buenos Aires; 1978; pp. 129-145.

1612. STEINOUR, Harold; “Exploring the Unseen World”; 258 pp.; bibl. 244-250; alph.; 20.5 cm; hb.;

dj.; The Citadel Press; New York; 1959; pp. 18, 107-109, 119, 142, 206-209, 235, 237, 240, 241.

1613. STELTER, Alfred; “Curacion Psi”; 318 pp.; bibl. 299-310; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Plaza & Janes;

Barcelona; Spain; 1976; pp. 78-81, 134, 135, 139, 140.

1614. STEVENS, E. W.; “The Watseka Wonder”; 32 pp.; illus.; Chicago; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1878.

1615. STEVENS, William Oliver; “The Mystery of Dreams”; VIII + 280 pp.; alph.; 20.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Dodd, Mead & Co.; New York; 1949; pp. 232-240. 1616. STEVENS, William Oliver; “Psychics and Common Sense”; 256 pp.; bibl. 244-249; alph.; 20.5

cm; hb.; dj.; E. P. Dutton & Co.; New York; 1953; pp. 112-166.

1617. STEVENS, William Oliver; “Unbidden Guests”; XVI + 322 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; George

Allen & Unwin; London; 1951; pp. 232-240.

1618. STEVENSON, Ian; “Cases of the Reincarnation Type”; 4 Vol.; 1.492 pp.; glos. 375-377; bibl.

370-372; alph.; 25 cm; hb.; dj.; University Press of Virginia; Charlottesville; Virginia; U. S. A.;

1980/1983; Vol. III: pp. 12, 15.

1619. STEVENSON, Ian; “Research into the Evidence of Man’s Survival After Death”; The Journal of

Nervous and Mental Disease; Baltimore; Maryland; U. S. A.; Vol. 165; N. 3; 1977; pp. 152-170.

1620. STEVENSON, Ian; “Vinte Casos Sugestivos de Reencarnação”; transl. Agenor Pegado and Sylvia

Pereira da Silva; supervisor Hernani Guimarães Andrade; 520 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Difusão

Cultural; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1970; pp. 7, 456.

1621. STEVENSON, Ian, and GREYSON, Bruce; “Near-Death Experiences”; The Journal of the

American Medical Association; Vol. 242; N. 3; July 20, 1979; bibl. 267; pp. 265-267.

1622. STILL, Alfred; “Nas Fronteiras da Ciência e da Parapsicologia”; transl. Leonidas Gontijo de

Carvalho; 298 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Ibrasa; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1965; pp. 222, 223, 236-238, 249.

1623. STOBART, Mrs. St. Clair; “Torchbearers of Spiritualism”; 232 pp.; illus.; bibl. 230, 231; 21.5 cm; hb.; George Allen & Unwin; London; 1925; pp. 192-198.

1624. STOKES, Douglas M.; “Mind Reach: Scientists Look at Psychic Ability”; The Journal of the

American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 71; N. 4; October; 1977; pp. 437-442.

1625. STOKES, Douglas M.; “Out-of-Body Experience: A Handbook”; Books Reviews;

Parapsychology Review; New York; Vol. 13; N. 3; September-October, 1982; pp. 22-24.

1626. STRAITH-MILLER, Elizabeth; “Huna: An Introduction to its Teachings”; 48 pp.; glos. 47, 48; 23

cm; hb.; Church of St. Michael; U. S. A.; 1966; p. 45.

1627. STRATTON, Frederick John Marrian; “An Out-of-the Body Experience Combined with ESP”;

Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 39; N. 692; June, 1957; pp. 92-97.

1628. STRINGFIELD, Leonard H.; “Situação Alerta: O Novo Cerco dos Ovnis”; pref. Donald E.

Keyhoe; transl. Wilma Freitas Ronald de Carvalho; 248 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editorial Nórdica; Rio

de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; pp. 63, 64.

1629. SUDRE, René; “Les Nouvelles Énigmes de L’Univers”; 398 pp.; 23 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Payot;

Paris; 1951; pp. 322, 377, 378; eds.: Fr., Sp.

Page 68: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1630. SUDRE, René; “Tratado de Parapsicologia”; transl. Constantino Paleólogo; 458 pp.; 21 cm; pb.;

Zahar Editores; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1966; pp. 31, 62, 212, 213, 281, 338, 348-450, 355-358, 362-

366, 371, 375, 381.

1631. SUZUKI, Daisetz Teitaro; “Introduccion al Budismo Zen”; introd. Carl Gustav Jung; transl.

Hector V. Morel; 182 pp.; 19 cm; pb.; 3rd ed.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1979;

pp. 117-124.

1632. SWANN, Ingo; “To Kiss Earth Good-bye”; pref. Gertrude Schmeidler; XX + 218 pp.; illus.; alph.;

24 cm; hb.; dj.; Hawthorn Books; New York; 1975; pp. 65-127 (Mini-library). 1633. SWEDENBORG, Emanuel; “L’Amour Vraiment Conjugal”; without translator; 504 pp.; alph.; 21

cm; pb.; Cercle Swedenborg; Meudon; France; 1974; pp. 354, 355; eds.: Lat., Fr., Port.

1634. SWEDENBORG, Emanuel; “Arcana Coelestia: The Heavenly Arcana”; without translator; pref.

John Faulkner Potts; 12 Vol.; 7.158 pp.; 20.5 cm; hb.; 37th print.; Swedenborg Foundation; New York;

1963; Vol. I: p, 2, 3; Vol. II: pp. 420, 476-484; eds.: Lat., etc.

1635. SWEDENBORG, Emanuel; “O Céu e o Inferno”; transl. and introd. Levindo Castro de La

Fayette; 472 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; Oficinas Gráficas da Casa Cruz; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1920; pp.

33, 34, 46, 47, 49, 94, 97, 102, 105; eds.: Lat., Eng., Fr., Port.

1636. SWEDENBORG, Emanuel; “Divina Providência”; transl. latim-francês J. F. E. Le Boys des

Guays; transl. Fr.-Port. João de Mendonça Lima; 384 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; pb.; Livraria Freitas Bastos;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1969; pp. 36, 271.

1637. SWEDENBORG, Emanuel; “A Nova Jerusalem e a Sua Doutrina Celeste”; transl.

and pref. João de Mendonça Lima; 352 pp.; alph.; 19 cm; pb.; Translator’s Edition; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; 1945; pp. 59, 277, 341.

1638. SWEDENBORG, Emanuel; “La Sagesse des Anges”; without translator; 284 pp.; alph.; 21 cm;

pb.; Cercle Swedenborg; Meudon; France; 1976; pp. 220, 221; eds.: Lat., Fr., Port.

1639. SWEDENBORG, Emanuel; “The Spiritual Diary” (“Diarii Spiritualis”); transl. George Bush, John J. Smithson, and James F. Buss; 5 Vol.; 2.350 pp.; illus.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; Swedenborg Foundation;

New York; 1971; Vol. I: pp. 1, 42, 48, 55, 69, 75, 115, 131, 133, 196, 295; eds.: Lat., Eng.

1640. SWEDENBORG, Emanuel; “A Verdadeira Religião Cristã”; transl. latin-french

J. F. E. le Boys des Guays; transl. french-port. João de Mendonça Lima; 2 Vol.; 976 pp.; alph.; 23 cm;

pb.; Livraria Freitas Bastos; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1964; Vol. I: pp. 85, 99, 104, 172, 201, 234, 308,

311, 315, 317, 490; Vol. II: pp. 280, 284, 333, 334.

1641. TALAMONTI, Leo; “Universo Proibido”; transl. Affonso Blacheyre; 308 pp.; illus.; bibl. 302-

307; 21 cm; pb.; Distribuidora Record; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 47, 129-143, 168-174, 277;

eds.: It., Sp., Port.

1642. TALBOT, Michael; “Mysticism and the New Physics”; 210 pp.; illus.; glos.

185-190; bibl. 191-204; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1981; pp. 162-168.

1643. TAMASSIA, Mário Boari; “Os Mortos Acordam os Vivos”; 120 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.;

Edição Círculo de Claus; Campinas, SP; Brazil; 1975; pp. 3, 19-28, 47, 50-52.

1644. TAMASSIA, Mário Boari; “Para que Serve Sonhar?”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly;

Yr. II; N. 21; March, 1977; illus.; p. 11.

1645. TAMBASCIO, Luz, and CANEDO, Guillermo; “Cuarta Dimension”; 90 pp.; 21.5 cm; pb.;

Altalena Editores; Madrid; Spain; March, 1981; pp. 71, 77-89. 1646. TANIBUR; “L’Extériorisation”; Le Voile D’Isis; Paris; Magazine; Monthly; Treizième Année; N.

50; Décembre, 1909; pp. 167, 168.

1647. TANOUS, Alexander, with ARDMAN, Harvey; “Beyond Coincidence”; XIV

+ 196 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Doubleday & Co.; New York; 1976; pp. 113-122; eds.: Eng., Fr. (Mini-

library).

1648. TANSLEY, David V.; “Le Corps Subtil: Essence et Ombre”; 96 pp.; illus.; bibl. 96; 28 cm; pb.;

Éditions du Seuil; Paris; 1977; pp. 1-96; eds.: Eng., Fr.

1649. TANSLEY, David V.; “Mensajeros de la Luz”; transl. Elisa M. Ferreira; 310 pp.; illus.; bibl. 309;

20.5 cm; pb.; Edaf, Ediciones-Distribuciones; Madrid; Spain; 1979; pp. 301-308.

1650. TARG, Russel; COLE, Phyllis; and PUTHOFF, Harold; “Development of Techniques to Enhance

Man/Machine Communication: A Final Report”; 100 pp.; illus.; Stanford Research Institute; Menlo

Park; Cal.; U. S. A.; June, 1974.

Page 69: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1651. TARG, Russel; & HARARY, Stuart Keith; “The Mind Race: Understanding and Using Psychic

Abilities”; introd. Willis Harman; epil. Larissa Vilenskaya; XX + 294 pp.; illus.; bibl. 265-269; 23.5

cm; hb.; dj.; Villard Books; New York; 1984; pp. 153, 154, 222-224, 232, 233.

1652. TARG, Russel; & PUTHOFF, Harold E.; “Mind-Reach: Scientists Look at Psychic Ability”;

introd. Margareth Mead; pref. Richard Bach; XXVI + 230 pp.; illus.; 20.5 cm; alph.; Dell Publishing

Co.; New York; November, 1978; pp. 189-212.

1653. TART, Charles Theodore; Editor; “Altered States of Consciousness”; Anthology; X + 590 pp.;

bibl. 530-570; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; Doubleday & Co.; New York; 1972; pp. 153-160, 498. 1654. TART, Charles Theodore; “A Further Psychophysiological Study of Out-of-the Body Experiences

in a Gifted Subject”; Proceedings of the Parapsychological Association; Vol. 6; 1969; pp. 43, 44.

1655. TART, Charles Theodore; “The Enigma of Out-of-Body Travel” (Susy Smith); Books Reviews;

Theta; Durham; North Carolina; U. S. A.; Magazine; N. 13; Spring, 1966; pp. 2, 3.

1656. TART, Charles Theodore; “Journeys Out of the Body” (Robert A. Monroe); Books Reviews; The

Last Whole Earth Catalog; Random House; New York; 1971; p. 415.

1657. TART, Charles Theodore; “Lucid Dreams and Out-of-the-Body Experiences” (Celia E. Green);

Books Reviews; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 64; N.

2; April, 1970; pp. 219-226.

1658. TART, Charles Theodore; “On Being Stoned: A Psychological Study of Marijuana Intoxication”;

introd. Walter N. Pahnke; 334 pp.; bibl.; Science and Behavior Books; Palo Alto; Cal.; U. S. A.; 1971.

1659. TART, Charles Theodore; “Out-of-the-Body Experiences” (Celia E. Green); Books Reviews;

Theta; Durham; North Carolina; U. S. A.; N. 25; Spring, 1969; pp. 3, 4.

1660. TART, Charles Theodore; “Psi: Scientific Studies of the Psychic Realm”; XIV

+ 242 pp.; illus.; bibl. 223-234; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; E. P. Dutton; New York; 1977; pp. 177-198.

1661. TART, Charles Theodore; “A Psychophysiological Study of Out-of-the-Body Experiences in a

Selected Subject”; The Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research; New York; Vol. 62; N. 1; January, 1968; bibl. 23-27; pp. 3-27.

1662. TART, Charles Theodore; “A Second Psychophysiological Study of Out-of-the-Body Experiences

in a Gifted Subject”; International Journal of Parapsychology; U. S. A.; 1967; pp. 251-258.

1663. TART, Charles Theodore; “States of Consciousness”; XII + 306 pp.; illus.; bibl.

287-295; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; E. P. Dutton; New York; 1975; pp. 239, 284, 285.

1664. TART, Charles Theodore; “Transpersonal Psychologies”; 502 pp.; illus.; bibl.

475-485; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Harper & Row, Publishers; New York; 1975; pp. 79, 148-151, 331.

1665. TART, Charles Theodore; PUTHOFF, Harold; and TARG, Russel; Editors; “Mind at Large”;

Anthology; XX + 268 pp.; illus.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Praeger Special Studies; New York; 1979; pp. 14,

15.

1666. TAYLOR, John; “Science and the Supernatural”; XII + 180 pp.; bibl. 171-174; alph.; 21 cm; hb.;

dj.; E. P. Dutton; New York; 1980; pp. 152-154.

1667. TAYLOR, John; “Superminds”; 270 pp.; illus.; bibl. 255-258; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Warner

Books; New York; 1975; pp. 215, 217.

1668. TCHOU, Claude; Éditeur; “Les Corps a Prodiges”; Anthology; introd. Marcel Martiny; 320 pp.;

illus.; 24 cm; pb.; Claude Tchou, Éditeur; Paris; 1977; pp. 203-208.

1669. TCHOU, Claude; Éditeur; “Les Extra-Sensoriels”; Anthology; introd. Aimé Michel; 328 pp.; illus.; bibl. 321-325; 24 cm; pb.; Tchou-Laffont; Paris; 1976; pp. 254, 279-302.

1670. TECHTER, David; “Astral Projection”; Fate; Evanston; Ill.; U. S. A.; Magazine; 1961; p. 85.

1671. TEIXEIRA, Cícero Marcos; “Anatomia do Desencarne”; Desobsessão; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil;

Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XXXI; N. 383; January, 1980; pp. 5-8.

1672. TEIXEIRA, Cícero Marcos; “Comunicação de Um Vivo Encarnado”; Desobsessão; Porto Alegre,

Brazil; RS; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. XXXVI; N. 431; April, 1984; pp. 2, 3.

1673. TEIXEIRA, Cícero Marcos; “O Fenômeno da Materialização”; Desobsessão; Porto Alegre, RS;

Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XXXIII; N. 397; March, 1981; pp. 6, 7, 10, 12.

1674. TEUNISSEN, J.; “Zinneschok en Zweefervaring”; (“Sensory Shock and the Experience of

Floating”); Tijdschrift voor Parapsychologie; Netherlands; N. 38; 1970; pp. 61-63.

1675. THALBOURNE, Michael A.; “A Glossary of Terms Used in Parapsychology”; introd. John

Beloff; XVI + 92 pp.; bibl. 89, 90; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; William Heinemann; London; 1982; pp. 4-6, 25,

48, 49, 51.

Page 70: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1676. THIAGO, Arnaldo S.; “Dante Alighieri: O Último Iniciado”; 320 pp.; illus.; bibl. 311, 312; 23.5

cm; pb.; Gráfica Tupy Editora; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1952; pp. 33-36.

1677. THIEBAULT, Jules; “L’Ani Disparu”; 188 pp.; illus.; glos. 177-187; 17 cm; hb.; Imprimerie

Berger-Levrault; Nancy; France; 1917; pp. 12, 13, 179, 180.

1678. THISELTON-DYER, Thomas Firminger; “The Ghost World”; 448 pp.; Ward

& Downey; London; 1898.

1679. THOMAS, Charles Drayton; “Life Beyond Death with Evidence”; 296 pp.; 19 cm; hb.; 5th print.;

W. Collins Sons & Co.; London; October, 1937; pp. 260-278. 1680. THOMAS, Charles Drayton; “The Mental Phenomena of Spiritualism”; L. S. A. Publications;

1930.

1681. THOMAS, Henry, and THOMAS, Dana Lee; “Vidas de Grandes Capitães da Fé”; transl. Lino

Vallandro; 208 pp.; 22 cm; illus.; hb.; 3rd print.; Editora Globo; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil; 1958; pp.

159-167.

1682. THOULESS, Robert Henry; “From Anecdote to Experiment in Psychical Research”; X + 198 pp.;

illus.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1972;

pp. 155, 164; eds.: Eng., Sp.

1683. THOULESS, Robert Henry; “The Mystical Life” (J. H. Michael Whiteman); Books Reviews;

Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 42; N. 715; March, 1963; pp. 25, 26.

1684. THURSTON, Mark A.; “How to Interpret Your Dreams: Practical Techniques Based on the Edgar

Cayce Readings”; XIII + 192 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; pb.; A. R. E. Press; Virginia Beach; Virginia; U. S. A.;

1978; pp. 178, 179.

1685. TINOCO, Carlos Alberto; “Fenómenos de Psicocinesia Espontânea”; 198 pp.; illus.; bibl. 191-

197; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Alfaómega Portugal; Lisboa; no date; pp. 90, 91, 94.

1686. TIRET, Colette, et TIRET, Georges; “Le Monde Invisible vous Parle”; 208 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

Vigot Frères, Éditeurs; Paris; 1954; pp. 130, 131. 1687. TISCHNER, Rudolf; “Introduction a la Parapsychologie”; transl. and pref. L. Lamorlette; 206 pp.;

bibl. 197-202; alph.; 24 cm; pb.; Payot; Paris; 1973; pp. 29, 122, 126, 136, 156, 157; eds.: Fr., Sp.

1688. TOBEN, Bob, and WOLF, Fred Alan; “Space-Time and Beyond”; 176 pp.; illus.; bibl. 163-174;

28 cm; pb.; E. P. Dutton; New York; 1982; pp. 72, 73, 148, 150.

1689. TODD, John, and DEWHURST, Kenneth; “The Double: its Psycho-Pathology and Psycho-

Physiology”; The Journal of Nervous and Mental Disease; New York; Vol. 122;

N. 1; Serial N. 883; July, 1955; bibl. 55; pp. 47-55.

1690. TONDRIAU, Julien; “O Ocultismo”; transl. Maria Luísa Trigueiros; 310 pp.; illus.; glos. 183-296;

bibl. 301-304; 18 cm; pb.; Difusão Européia do Livro; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; p. 218.

1691. TORTEROLI, Angeli; “O Spiritismo no Brasil e em Portugal”; 190 pp.; glos. 57, 58; 17.5 cm; hb.;

Livraria Spírita da Sociedade Acadêmica Deus, Cristo, Caridade; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1896; pp. 56,

57.

1692. TOURINHO, Nazareno; “Curiosidades de Uma Pesquisa Espírita”; pref. Aparecido O. Belvedere;

188 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.; Casa Editora O Clarim; Matão, SP; Brazil; January, 1983; pp. 13-17, 43-53,

55, 62, 63, 69, 81-84, 106, 108, 129, 139, 144, 151, 165, 180.

1693. TOURINHO, Nazareno; “Surpresas de Uma Pesquisa Mediúnica”; 118 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Editora O

Clarim; Matão, SP; Brazil; May, 1981; pp. 34-36, 41, 47-51, 56, 59, 60, 67, 70, 83. 1694. TOYNBEE, Arnold Joseph; KOESTLER, Arthur, y otros; “La Vida Despues de la Muerte”;

transl. Carlos Gardini; 324 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editorial Sudamericana; Buenos Aires; Argentina;

Julio, 1977; p. 269.

1695. TREBILCOCK, Edward O.; “No Earthly Reason”; 158 pp.; bibl. 157; 18.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Regency

Press; London; 1968; pp. 90-94.

1696. TRESPIOLI, Gino; “Spiritismo Moderno”; 354 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm; pb.; Editore Ulrico Hoepli;

Milano; Italy; 1931; pp. 111, 354; eds.: It., Sp.

1697. TRESPIOLI, Gino; “Spiritismo Moderno: I Fenomeni”; 464 pp.; illus.; bibl. 451-464; 18 cm; hb.;

Editore Ulrico Hoepli; Milano; Italy; 1934; p. 44.

1698. TRINE, Rodolfo Waldo; “En Harmonia con el Infinito”; transl. and introd. Federico Climent

Terrer; 188 pp. 18.5 cm; pb.; Editorial Orion; Mexico, D. F.; 1981; pp. 103-111; eds.: Eng., Sp., Port.

1699. TRINTZIUS, René; “Au Seuil du Monde Invisible”; 448 pp.; illus.; bibl. 429, 430; 18 cm; pb.;

Omnium Littéraire; Paris; 1951; pp. 363-371.

Page 71: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1700. THURSTON, Herbert; “Los Fenomenos Fisicos de Misticismo”; transl. Gabriel de Manterola;

prol. Pedro Meseguer; pref. J. H. Crehan; 606 pp.; index of names; 19 cm; pb.; Ediciones Dinor; San

Sebastian; Spain; 1953; pp. 285, 478, 479.

1701. TUBBY, Gertrude Ogden; “Psychics and Mediums: A Manual and Bibliography for Students”;

192 pp.; bibl. 177-188; alph.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Rider and Co.; London; no date; pp. 31,

46-48.

1702. TUCKER, Prentiss; “En la Tierra de los Muertos que Vivem”; without translator; 156 pp.; 17.5

cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1976; pp. 44-52. 1703. TUCKETT, Ivor Ll.; “The Evidence for the Supernatural”; 410 pp.; alph.; 22.5 cm; hb.; Kegan

Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co.; London; 1911; pp. 289-295.

1704. TUMMOLO, Vincenzo; “Sulle Basi Positive Dello Spiritualismo”; 710 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; hb.; Tip.

Soc. Donati e C.; Viterbo; Italy; 1905; pp. 97-105.

1705. TURI, Anna Maria; “A Levitação”; transl. Maria da Graça Tavares; 190 pp.; bibl.

183-188; 21.5 cm; pb.; Edições 70; Lisboa; Portugal; September, 1979; pp. 72-74.

1706. TURNER, Gordon; “Drug-taking Causes Astral Projections”; Psychic News; London; Newspaper;

Weekly; N. 1987; July 4, 1970; p. 7.

1707. TURVEY, Vincent Newton; “The Beginnings of Seership”; pref. William Thomas Stead; 190 pp.;

18 cm; hb.; Psychic Book Club; London; 1954; pp. 1-190 (Mini-library).

1708. TUTTLE, Hudson; “Arcana of Nature”; introd. Emmet Densmore; 472 pp.; illus.; alph.; 20.5 cm;

hb.; Stillman Publishing Co.; New York; 1908; pp. 12-16.

1709. TWEEDALE, Charles L.; “Man’s Survival After Death”; 2 Vol.; 536 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; 5th ed.; The

Psychic Book Club; London; 1947; pp. 192-226.

1710. TWEMLOW, Stuart; GABBARD, Glen O.; and JONES, Fowler C.; “The Out-of-Body

Experiences: A Phenomenological Typology Based on Questionnaire Responses”; American Journal

of Psychiatry; Vol. 139; April, 1982; bibl. 455; pp. 450-455. 1711. TWIGG, Ena, with BROD, Ruth Hagy; “Ena Twigg: Medium”; introd. Mervym Stockwood; 318

pp.; alph.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Hawthorn Books; New York; 1972; pp. 56-58.

1712. TWITCHELL, Paul; “Eckankar: La Clave de los Mundos Secretos”; without translator; prol. Brad

Steiger; 318 pp.; illus.; glos. 279-317; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Illuminated Way Press; Menlo Park; Cal.; U.

S. A.; 1977; pp. 1-318 (Mini-library).

1713. TWITCHELL, Paul; “Eckankar: Compiled Writings”; Vol. I; 196 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; Illuminated

Way Press; San Diego; Cal.; U. S. A.; 1975; pp. 43-46, 75-81.

1714. TWITCHELL, Paul; “The Spiritual Notebook”; 220 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pb.; 5th print.; Illuminated

Way Press; Menlo Park; Cal.; U. S. A.; 1977; pp. 16, 58, 68, 86.

1715. TWITCHELL, Paul; “The Tiger’s Fang”; pref. Brad Steiger; 176 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 6th

print.; Illuminated Way Press; Menlo Park; Cal.; U. S. A.; 1977; pp. 3, 4, 68, 69.

1716. TWITCHELL, Paul; “Un Entendimiento de Eckankar”; transl. Amador Botello

e Sergio Aragon; 16 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Eckankar; Menlo Park; Cal.; U. S. A.; 1976; pp. 5-13.

1717. TYRRELL, George Nuglut Merle; “Apparitions”; pref. H. H. Price; 192 pp.; alph.; 18 cm; pocket;

pb.; ed. rev.; Collier Books; New York; 1970; pp. 165-171; eds.: Eng., Fr., Port.

1718. TYRRELL, George Nuglut Merle; “Au-Delà du Conscient”; transl. and pref. René Sudre; 282 pp.;

18 cm; pocket; pb.; Petite Bibliothèque Payot; Paris; 1970; pp. 8, 191-202. 1719. UCHÔA, Alfredo Moacyr de Mendonça; “O Espiritismo Científico Face às Dimensões Superiores

da Realidade”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. II; N. 19; January, 1977; p. 8.

1720. UCHÔA, Alfredo Moacyr de Mendonça; “Muito Além do Espaço e do Tempo”; pref. M.; 300 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 283-300; 21 cm; pb.; Thesaurus Editora; Brasília; Brazil; 1983; pp. 90, 138, 167.

1721. UNDERWOOD, Peter; “Dictionary of the Occult & Supernatural”; 390 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; pb.;

Fontana / Collins; London; 1979; pp. 36, 37, 111, 118, 123, 124, 206, 249, 265, 360.

1722. UPHOFF, Walter, and UPHOFF, Mary; “New Psychic Frontiers”; pref. Harold Sherman; XVIII +

278 pp.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Colin Smythe – Gerrards Cross; London; 1975; pp. 79-88; eds.: Eng.,

Sp.

1723. USAMI, Herick Athayde; “As Dimensões e os Extraterrestres”; 102 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd

ed.; Gráfica Valci Editora; Brasília; Brazil; August, 1984; pp. 39, 93.

1724. VACHELL, Horace Anneley; “When Sorrows Come”; Cassell and Co., London; 1935; p. 278.

1725. VALÉRIO, Cícero (Pseud. for Sebastião Ladeira Marques); “Fenômenos Parapsicológicos e

Espíritas”; 166 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Editora Piratininga; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 74-79.

Page 72: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1726. VALLE, Sérgio; “Silva Mello e os Seus Mistérios”; 414 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

2nd ed.; Editora Lake; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1959; pp. 199, 268, 342, 346-348, 392.

1727. VALLEE, Jacques; “Messengers of Deception: Ufo Contacts and Cults”; XII + 274 pp.; illus.;

bibl. 265-268; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Bantam Books; New York; December, 1980;

pp. 62, 63.

1728. VANGUARDA; Editorial; “Um Curioso Fenômeno de Desdobramento”; Section “Nas Fronteiras

do Outro Mundo”; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Newspaper; Daily; Yr. X; N. 6.539; 21, October, 1932; p. 2.

1729. VARENNE, Jean; “El Yoga y la Tradicion Hindu”; transl. Adolfo Martin; 298 pp.; illus.; glos. 285-294; bibl. 279-281; 18 cm; pb.; Plaza & Janes, Editors; Barcelona; Spain; Deciembre, 1978; p.

182.

1730. VASCONCELLOS, Marilusa Moreira; “Confidências de Um Inconfidente”; pres. Ruy Cintra

Paiva; Novel; 380 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Edicel; S. Paulo; Brazil; June, 1982; pp. 164, 245, 267, 298-

300.

1731. VASCONCELLOS, Marilusa Moreira; “A Moça da Ilha”; Novel; 272 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora

Cultura Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; October, 1983; pp. 9, 18, 19, 52, 57, 74, 154-157, 161.

1732. VASILIEV, Leonid Leonidovich; “Os Misteriosos Fenômenos da Psique Humana”; transl. José

Paulo do Rio Branco; 154 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Paz e Terra; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1970; pp. 32,

33, 94, 95; eds.: Rus., Sp., Eng., Port.

1733. VEJA; Editorial; “Vida Após a Morte”; Section “Medicina”; Magazine; Weekly;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 21, July, 1976; illus.; pp. 52, 54.

1734. VELHO, A. A. Martins; “O Espiritismo Contemporâneo”; 324 pp.; 18 cm; hb.;

2nd ed.; Livraria Clássica Editora; Lisboa; Portugal; 1926; pp. 44-56.

1735. VERNEUIL, Philippe; “Manuel de Développement et d’Utilisation des Pouvoirs Paranormaux”;

204 pp.; illus.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Guy Le Prat, Éditeur; Paris; 1984; pp. 55, 78, 79, 95, 99, 189-199.

1736. VESME, Cesare Baudi Conte di; “Storia Dello Spiritismo”; 2 Vol.; 954 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Roux Frassati e Co. Editori; Torino; Italy; 1896; 2nd Vol.; pp. 436-441.

1737. VESME, Cesare Baudi Conte di; “L’Uomo Primitivo: Storia Dello Spiritualismo Sperimentale”;

248 pp.; 23 cm; hb.; Spartaco Giovene; Milano; Italy; Marzo, 1945; pp. 91-93.

1738. VETT, Carl; Editor; “Le Compte Rendu Officiel du Premier Congrès International des Recherches

Psychiques”; 554 pp.; illus.; 22.5 cm; hb.; K. P. I. F.; Copenhague; Dinamarca; 1922; pp. 124-138,

379-395.

1739. VIEIRA, Anníbal J.; “Especulações no Abstrato”; 286 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; Editora Espiritualista; Rio

de Janeiro; Brazil; 1973; pp. 158-161.

1740. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Acoplamentos Áuricos”; Aurora; Duque de Caxias, RJ; Brazil; Magazine;

Monthly; Yr. IV; N. 9; August, 1982; illus.; p. 31.

1741. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Animais: Detectores da Consciência Projetada”; Aurora; Duque de Caxias, RJ;

Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. V; N. 13; September, 1983; illus.; bibl.; p. 20.

1742. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Autoconsciência Extrafísica”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr.

IX; N. 108; June, 1984; p. 5.

1743. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Bilocações de Natuzza Evolo”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr.

IX; N. 112; October, 1984; p. 6.

1744. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Carta Aberta aos Espíritas”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. XI; N. 113; August, 1983; p. 6.

1745. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Catalepsia Projetiva”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. IX; N.

107; May, 1984; p. 4.

1746. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Coração e Projeção Consciente”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper;

Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 99; June, 1982; illus.; bibl.; p. 6.

1747. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Cristo Espera Por Ti”; Novel; 332 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Edição Cec;

Uberaba, MG; Brazil; 1965; pp. 31, 32, 68, 170.

1748. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Experimento do Vôo pela Vontade”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil;

Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 106; January, 1983; illus.; bibl.; p. 5.

1749. VIEIRA, Waldo; “O Fenômeno da Autobilocação”; Aurora; Duque de Caxias, RJ; Brazil;

Magazine; Monthly; Yr. IV; N. 10; November, 1982; illus.; bibl.; p. 16.

1750. VIEIRA, Waldo; “O Fenômeno da Bilocação Física”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil;

Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 101; August, 1982; p. 3.

Page 73: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1751. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Hipnagogia”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. IX;

N. 109; July, 1984; p. 5.

1752. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Maturidade Extrafísica”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. IX; N.

105; March, 1984; p. 4.

1753. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Mini-library”; Boletim de Projeciologia 4; in Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil;

Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 99; September, 1983; p. 7.

1754. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Muletas Psicofísicas Projetivas”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly;

Yr. IX; N. 103; January, 1984; p. 4. 1755. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Pesquisas Estatísticas Sobre a Projeção Consciente”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo;

Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 102; September, 1982; bibl.; p. 5.

1756. VIEIRA, Waldo; “A Projecão Consciente e a Pessoa Mutilada”; Folha Espírita;

S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 105; December, 1982; bibl.; p. 5.

1757. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Projeção Consciente e Corpo Humano”; Folha Espírita;

S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 107; February; 1983; bibl.; p. 3.

1758. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Projeção Consciente e Formas-Pensamentos”; Folha Espírita;

S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 104; November, 1982; bibl.; p. 3.

1759. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Projeção Consciente Humana”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr.

IX; N. 110; August, 1984; p. 6.

1760. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Projeção Desobsessiva”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. IX; N.

111; September, 1984; p. 6.

1761. VIEIRA, Waldo; “A Projeção do Inconsciente”; Aurora; Duque de Caxias, RJ; Brazil; Magazine;

Monthly; Yr. V; N. 12; May, 1983; illus.; bibl.; p. 22.

1762. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Projeções da Consciência: Diário de Experiências Fora do Corpo Físico”; 232

pp.; glos. 14-16; alph.; 21 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Livraria Allan Kardec Editora;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1982; pp. 1-232. 1763. VIEIRA, Waldo; “O Projetor e os Desencarnantes”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper;

Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 100; July, 1982; illus.; bibl.; p. 5.

1764. VIEIRA, Waldo; “O Recesso nas Projeções Conscientes”; Folha Espírita;

S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 108; March, 1983; bibl.; p. 6.

1765. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Soma e Psicossoma”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly;

Yr. IX; N. 103; October, 1982; bibl.; p. 5.

1766. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Sonho e Projeção Consciente”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper;

Monthly; Yr. VIII; N. 96; March, 1982; bibl.; p. 5.

1767. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Técnica da Auto-hipnose Projetiva”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil;

Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 115; January, 1985; p. 2.

1768. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Técnica da Hetero-hipnose Projetiva”; Jornal Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil;

Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 114; December, 1984; p. 8.

1769. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Técnica da Projeção Consciente Assistida”; Folha Espírita;

S. Paulo; Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 97; April, 1982; bibl.; p. 5.

1770. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Técnica da Projeção Consciente Através do Sonho”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo;

Brazil; Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 98; May, 1982; p. 3.

1771. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Técnica da Projeção Consciente pelo Corpo Mental”; Aurora; Duque de Caxias, RJ; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. IV; N. 8; April, 1982; bibl.; p. 13.

1772. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Técnica da Projeção Consciente pelo Dióxido de Carbono”; Jornal Espírita; S.

Paulo; Brazil; Monthly; Yr. IX; N. 113; November, 1984; p. 8.

1773. VIEIRA, Waldo; “Utilidades da Projeção Consciente”; Folha Espírita; S. Paulo; Brazil;

Newspaper; Monthly; Yr. VIII; N. 95; February, 1981; p. 5.

1774. VIETEN, Günter C.; “Sie standen an der Schwelle der Ewigkeit”; Die Andere Welt; Freiburg;

West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 19; N. 10; October, 1968; pp. 946, 947.

1775. VIOLETA-ODETE; “Guia da Mediunidade”; 192 pp.; 18.5 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Empresa Editora O

Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1945; pp. 111-115.

1776. VISHNUDEVANANDA; “El Libro de Yoga”; transl. Sivayiotir Mayananda; introd. Marcus

Bach; 440 pp.; illus.; glos.; 429-435; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 5th ed.; Alianza Editorial; Madrid; Spain;

1981; pp. 29, 300-302.

1777. VIVANTE, Leone; “Studi Sulle Precognizioni”; 220 pp.; bibl. 9-17; 19 cm; pb.; Vallecchi

Editore; Firenze; Italy; 1937; p. 122.

Page 74: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1778. VOLTERRI, Roberto; “Psicotrónica”; transl. Juan Giner; 218 pp.; illus.; glos.

201-213; bibl. 215-217; 21.5 cm; pb.; Ediciones Martínez Roca; Barcelona; Spain; 1981;

pp. 13, 91, 98, 216, 217.

1779. VYVYAN, John; “The Case Against Jones: A Study of Psychical Phenomena”; 220 pp.; James

Clarke; London; 1966.

1780. WACHTMEISTER, Constance, and others; “Reminiscências de H. P. Blavatsky e de “A Doutrina

Secreta”; Biography; transl. Edilson Alkmim Cunha; 140 pp.; illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1980; pp. 105-107. 1781. WALKER, Benjamin; “Beyond the Body: The Human Double and the Astral Planes”; VIII + 224

pp.; bibl. 195-206; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1977; pp. 1-224 (Mini-

library).

1782. WALKER, Benjamin; “Body Magic”; 480 pp.; alph.; 20 cm; pb.; Granada Publishing; London;

1979; pp. 26-30.

1783. WALKER, Benjamin; “Encyclopedia of Esoteric Man”; X + 344 pp.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Routledge

& Kegan Paul; London; 1977; p. 11.

1784. WALKER, Benjamin; “Encyclopedia of Metaphysical Medicine”; X + 324 pp.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.;

Routledge & Kegan Paul; London; 1978; pp. 41, 96.

1785. WALKER, Benjamin; “The Encyclopedia of the Occult, the Esoteric, and the Supernatural”; XII +

344 pp.; bibl. 13, 14; 23.5 cm; pb.; Stein and Pay; New York; 1980; pp. 11-14.

1786. WALKER, Benjamin; “Masks of the Soul: The Facts Behind Reincarnation”; 160 pp.; bibl. 145-

156; alph.; 22 cm; pb.; The Aquarian Press; London; 1981; pp. 32, 52, 90, 91, 108.

1787. WALLACE, Abraham; “Astral Travelling from New Zealand Resulting in Telekinetic Phenomena

in London”; Light; London; Magazine; Vol. XLIV; 1924; p. 697.

1788. WALLACE, Alfred Russel; “Les Miracles et le Moderne Spiritualisme”; transl.

M. Mangin; VIII + 382 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; hb.; Librairie des Sciences Psychologiques; Paris; no date; pp. 102, 326, 329, 348.

1789. WALLACE, Amy, and HENKIN, Bill; “The Psychic Healing Book”; XVI + 206 pp.; bibl. 203-

205; 21.5 cm; pb.; Turnstone Press; Great Britain; 1981; pp. 198, 199.

1790. WALLACE, Mary Bruce; “The Coming Light”; Watkins; London; 1924; p. 19.

1791. WALLIS, Claudia; “Eles Voltaram da Morte e Contam o que Viram”; Manchete; Rio de Janeiro;

Brazil; Magazine; Weekly; Yr. 30; N. 1.557; 20, February, 1982; illus.; pp. 20-22.

1792. WAMBACH, Helen; “Life Before Life”; 214 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Bantam Books; New York;

March, 1979; pp. 15, 16; eds.: Eng., Fr.

1793. WAMBACH, Helen; “Recordando Vidas Passadas: Depoimentos de Pessoas Hipnotizadas”;

transl. Octavio Mendes Cajado; 168 pp.; illus.; 20 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1981; pp. 46-49, 118, 133.

1794. WANG, Solon; “The Multiple Planes of the Cosmos and Life”; Treatise; transl.

T. M. Yang, and K. H. Liu; XIV + 938 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; The Society for Psychic Studies;

Taipei; Taiwan; 1979; pp. 55, 56, 156-159, 165-179, 193-195, 198, 210-214, 241,

559-561; eds.: Ch., Eng.

1795. WANTUIL, Zêus; “Licantropia”; Reformador; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Magazine; Monthly; Yr.

96; January-March, 1978; N. 1.786: pp. 34, 35, 37; N. 1.787: pp. 51, 52; N. 1.788: pp. 103, 104. 1796. WARCOLLIER, René; “La Télépathie: Recherches Expérimentales”; pref. Charles Robert Richet;

364 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; hb.; Librairie Félix Alcan; Paris; 1921; pp. 79, 96-99.

1797. WARD, Brian; “El Sexto Sentido”; without translator; 96 pp.; illus.; glos. 90-92; bibl. 89, 90;

alph.; 20 cm; cart.; Instituto Parramón Ediciones; Barcelona; Spain; 1978; pp. 34-36, 92.

1798. WARD, J. S. M.; “A Subaltern in Spirit Land”; 2 Vol.; 164 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; hb.; Psychic Book

Club; London; no date; pp. 9, 10, 20.

1799. WATKINS, Susan K.; “Conversations with Seth”; Vol. One; introd. Jane Roberts; 290 pp.; illus.;

alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Prentice-Hall; Englewood Cliffs; New Jersey; U. S. A.; 1980; pp. 17-19, 41, 51,

52.

1800. WATSON, Lyall; “The Romeo Error: A Meditation on Life and Death”; 256 pp.; bibl. 224-240;

alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Dell Publishing Co.; New York; May, 1976; pp. 129-145, 153, 159, 177,

178, 219.

1801. WATSON, Lyall; “Supernature: A Natural History of the Supernatural”; 348 pp.; bibl. 317-335;

alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Coronet Books; London; 1974; pp. 305-307; eds.: Eng., It., Port.

Page 75: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1802. WATTS, Alan W.; “The Joyous Cosmology”; introd. Timothy Leary & Richard Alpert; XX + 104

pp.; illus.; 20 cm; pb.; Vintage Books; New York; 1965; pp. 17, 83, 84, 100.

1803. WAUTHY, Léon; “Science et Spiritisme”; 398 pp.; illus.; 23 cm; pb.; Librairie des Sciences

Psychiques; Paris; 1923; 162-188.

1804. WEBB, James; “The Occult Underground”; 388 pp.; illus.; alph.; 20.5 cm; hb.; Open Court

Publishing; La Salle; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1974; pp. 40, 99, 174, 188.

1805. WEBB, James; “There Came Back”; 188 pp.; bibl. 181; Hawthorn Books; New York; 1974.

1806. WEBB, Richard; “Voices from Another World”; X + 278 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Manor Books; New York; 1972; pp. 77-85.

1807. WEDECK, Harry E., and BASKIN, Wade; “Dictionary of Spiritualism”; VIII

+ 390 pp.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Peter Owen; London; 1971; p. 35.

1808. WEED, Joseph J.; “Psychic Energy”; 216 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Parker Publishing Co.; West Nyack, N.

Y.; U. S. A.; June, 1978; pp. 195-210.

1809. WEIL, Pierre; “Fronteiras da Evolução e da Morte”; 132 pp.; illus.; bibl. 129-131; 21 cm; pb.;

Editora Vozes; Petrópolis, RJ; Brazil; 1979; pp. 94-122.

1810. WEIL, Pierre; “A Revolução Silenciosa”; Autobiography; 234 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora

Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1982; pp. 67, 143-152, 229, 230.

1811. WEISS, Adolfo; “Ciencias del Mañana”; 286 pp.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires;

Argentina; 1946; pp. 82-85, 100-112.

1812. WENDT, Victor K.; “Ein Astral-Erlebnis”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine;

Monthly; Yr. 21; N. 11; November, 1970; pp. 1002, 1003.

1813. WEOR, Samael Aun (Pseud. for Kattan Umaña Tamires); “Aos Pés do Mestre”;

without translator; 36 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Gnose; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil; no date; pp. 13-

18.

1814. WEOR, Samael Aun (Pseud. for Kattan Umaña Tamires); “Desfazendo Mistérios”; without translator; pref. Luis Alberto Renderos; 138 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Gnose; Porto Alegre, RS;

Brazil; October, 1976; pp. 96-102.

1815. WEOR, Samael Aun (Pseud. for Kattan Umãna Tamires); “O Livro Amarelo Kundalini Yoga”;

without translator; 58 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Sol Nascente Publicações; S. Paulo; Brazil; no date; pp. 42, 43.

1816. WEOR, Samael Aun (Pseud. for Kattan Umãna Tamires); “Logos Mantran Teurgia”; without

translator; introd. Virgílio Campos Novais; 86 pp.; illus.; 10.5 cm; pb.; Associação Gnóstica de Estu-

dos Antropológicos e Ciências; Belo Horizonte, MG; Brazil; no date; pp. 39-47.

1817. WEOR, Samael Aun (Pseud. for Kattan Umaña Tamires); “O Mistério do Áureo Florescer”;

transl., pref. and prfr. Pedro Carvalho Barbosa; 162 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Rex Collectio Editores; Santos,

SP; Brazil; 1981; pp. 63-66; eds.: Eng., Sp., Port.

1818. WEOR, Samael Aun (Pseud. for Kattan Umaña Tamires); “Mistérios da Vida e da Morte”;

without translator; 148 pp.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Sol Nascente Publicações; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1976; pp. 105-

111.

1819. WEOR, Samael Aun (Pseud. for Kattan Umaña Tamires); “Noções Fundamentais de

Endocrinologia e Criminologia”; transl. Pedro Carvalho Barbosa and Romulo Caixeta Leite; 130 pp.;

21.5 cm; pb.; Rex Collectio Editores; Santos, SP; Brazil; no date; pp. 78, 79.

1820. WEOR, Samael Aun (Pseud. for Kattan Umaña Tamires); “A Noite dos Séculos” without translator; 164 pp.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Gnose; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil; May, 1981; pp. 130,

131.

1821. WEOR, Samael Aun (Pseud. for Kattan Umaña Tamires); “Teurgia e Magia Prática”; without

translator; 180 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Gnose; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil; November, 1978;

pp. 42-47.

1822. WEREIDE, Thorstein; “Norway’s Human Doubles”; Tomorrow; U. S. A.; Magazine; Vol. 3; N. 2;

Winter, 1955; pp. 23-29.

1823. WERNER, Edward Theodore Chalmers; “The Chinese Idea of the Second Self”; 50 pp.; The

Changai Times; China; 1932.

1824. WEST, D. J.; “The Double: Its Psycho-Pathology and Psycho-Physiology”; Journal of the Society

for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 38; N. 699; June, 1956; pp. 274, 275.

1825. WHEATLEY, James M. O., and EDGE, Hoyt L.; Editors; “Philosophical Dimensions of

Parapsychology”; Anthology; XXX + 484 pp.; illus.; bibl. 464-478; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Charles C.

Thomas, Publisher; Springfield; Ill; U. S. A.; 1976; p. 354.

Page 76: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1826. WHEELER, David R.; “Journey to the Other Side”; 184 pp.; 17.5 cm; pocket; pb.; Ace Books;

New York; 1977; pp. 1-184 (Mini-library).

1827. WHITE, John Warren; Editor and introd.; “La Experiencia Mística y los Estados de Conciencia”;

Anthology; transl. David Rosenbaum; 318 pp.; 20 cm; pb.; 2nd ed.; Editorial Kairós; Barcelona; Spain;

June, 1982; pp. 9, 10, 28.

1828. WHITE, John Warren; Editor; “Frontiers of Consciousness”; 416 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pb.; pocket;

Avon Books; New York; July, 1975; pp. 183, 361, 374, 386-389.

1829. WHITE, John Warren, and KRIPPNER, Stanley Curtiss; Editors; “Future Science: Life Energies and the Physics of Paranormal Phenomena”; Anthology; 598 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Doubleday

& Co.; New York; 1977; pp. 124, 218, 220, 297, 301, 312, 328.

1830. WHITE, John Warren; Editor; “The Highest State of Consciousness”; Anthology; XXIV + 492

pp.; bibl. 472-480; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Anchor Books; New York; 1972; p. 465.

1831. WHITE, John Warren; Editor; “Kundalini Evolution and Enlightenment”; Anthology; 480 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 463-466; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Anchor Books; New York; 1979; p. 369.

1832. WHITE, John Warren; “A Practical Guide to Death & Dying”; XIV + 172 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.;

The Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill.; U.S.A.; 1980; pp. 10-12, 124-134, 142, 148.

1833. WHITE, Rhea Amelia; “An Analysis of ESP Phenomena in the Saints”; Parapsychology Review;

New York; Vol. 13; N. 1; January-February, 1982; pp. 15-18.

1834. WHITE, Rhea Amelia; “Surveys in Parapsychology”; pref. Montague Ullman; XII + 484 pp.;

illus.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1976;

pp. 450-452.

1835. WHITE, Rhea Amelia, and DALE, Laura A.; “Parapsychology: Sources of Information”; XII +

304 pp.; bibl.; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; The Scarecrow Press; Metuchen, N. J.; U. S. A.; 1973; pp. 83-86.

1836. WHITE, Ruth, and SWAINSON, Mary; “Sete Viagens Interiores”; transl. Maio Miranda; 238 pp.;

illus.; 19.5 cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1978; pp. 28, 30, 56. 1837. WHITEMAN, Joseph Hilary Michael; “Lucid Dreams” (Celia E. Green); Books Reviews; Journal

of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 45; N. 739; March, 1969; pp. 21-25.

1838. WHITEMAN, Joseph Hilary Michael; “Out-of-the-Body Experiences” (Celia

E. Green); Books Reviews; Journal of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 45;

N. 742; December, 1969; pp. 172-178.

1839. WHITEMAN, Joseph Hilary Michael; “Philosophy of Space and Times and the Inner Constitution

of Nature: A Phenomenological Study”; 436 pp.; illus.; 22 cm; Humanities P.; New York; 1967.

1840. WHITEMAN, Joseph Hilary Michael; “The Mystical Life”; introd. H. H. Price; XX

+ 250 pp.; 23 cm; hb.; Faber & Faber; London; 1961; pp. 45-82, 143-222.

1841. WHITEMAN, Joseph Hilary Michael; “Out-of-the-Body Explorations”; Theta; Durham; North

Carolina; U.S.A.; Magazine; N. 5; Spring, 1964; p. 3.

1842. WHITEMAN, Joseph Hilary Michael; “The Process of Separation and Return in Experiences

Fully “Out of the Body”; Proceedings of the Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 50; Part

185; May, 1956; pp. 240-274.

1843. WHITMORE, Clara Helen; “Jo: The Indian Friend”; 52 pp.; The Christopher Publishing House;

Boston; Massachusetts; U. S. A.; 1925.

1844. WICKLAND, Carl A.; “30 Years Among the Dead”; 390 pp.; illus.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Newcastle Publishing Co.; Hollywood; Cal.; U. S. A.; March, 1974; p. 356; eds.: Eng., Sp.

1845. WILBER, Ken; “The Spectrum of Consciousness”; 376 pp.; illus.; bibl. 344-367; alph.; 21 cm;

pb.; The Theosophical Publishing House; Wheaton; Ill.; U. S. A.; 1979; pp. 120, 270, 275.

1846. WILEY, Constance; “A Star of Hope”; The C. W. Daniel Co.; London; 1938;

pp. 56, 75.

1847. WILFING, Jutta; “Wenn Jemand Seiner Doppelganger Sieht”; Die Andere Welt; Freiburg; West

Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 19; N. 6; June, 1968; illus.; pp. 516-522.

1848. WILKERSON, Ralph; “Beyond and Back”; XIV + 240 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Bantam Books;

New York; February, 1978; pp. VII, 1, 39-54.

1849. WILLIAMSON, John W.; “A New Look at Astral Projection”; Yoga Today; Vol. 3; N. 7;

September, 1978; p. 18.

1850. WILLMANN, Laerte; “Ida e Volta: Morte e Renascimento” (Robert A. Monroe); Section

“Livros”; O Globo; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; Newspaper; Daily; 24, June, 1979; p. 7.

Page 77: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1851. WILSON, Colin; Editor; “Homens de Mistério: Uma Celebração do Oculto”; Anthology; transl.

Maria Amália de Sotto-Mayor; 240 pp.; illus.; bibl. 237; 21 cm; pb.; Editora Ulisseia; Lisboa;

Portugal; no date; pp. 21, 113.

1852. WILSON, Colin; “Lord of the Underworld: Jung and the Twentieth Century”; Biography; 160 pp.;

bibl. 157; alph.; 21.5 cm; hb.; dj.; The Aquarian Press; Wellingborough; Northamptonshire; Great

Britain; 1984; pp. 7, 8, 15.

1853. WILSON, Colin; “Mysteries”; 668 pp.; bibl. 643-652; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.;

G. P. Putnam’s Sons; New York; 1978; pp. 155-161, 218, 337, 372-379, 476, 477, 539, 611. 1854. WILSON, Colin; “The Occult”; 606 pp.; alph.; 20.5 cm; pb.; Vintage Books; New York;

February, 1973; pp. 56, 217-219, 338, 452, 503, 543-548; eds.: Eng., Port.

1855. WILSON, Colin; “Poltergeist! A Study in Destructive Haunting”; 382 pp.; bibl.

365-369; alph.; 21.5 cm; pb.; Perigee Book; New York; 1983; pp. 196, 244, 246, 273, 274,

336-339, 361.

1856. WILSON, Colin; “The Psychic Detectives”; 288 pp.; index of names; bibl. 280-283; 18 cm;

pocket; pb.; Pan Books; London; 1984; pp. 125, 126, 136, 137, 160, 161, 178.

1857. WILSON, Colin; “Strange Powers”; 148 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; hb.; dj.; Random House; New York;

1975; pp. 27-72.

1858. WILSON, Colin, and GRANT, John; “The Directory of Possibilities”; 256 pp.; illus.; bibl. 223-

225; alph.; 23.5 cm; hb.; dj.; Webb & Bower; Exeter; England; 1981; pp. 34, 47, 50-53, 58, 98, 124,

128, 129, 139, 142-144, 153.

1859. WILSON, Robert Anton; “Cosmic Trigger the Final Secret of the Illuminati”; introd. Timothy

Leary; XXX + 290 pp.; illus.; alph.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Pocket Books; New York; March, 1978; pp.

86, 136, 215.

1860. WINGFIELD, Kate; “Guidance From Beyond”; pref. Helen; introd. E. Marshall Hall; 192 pp.;

Philip Allan & Co.; London; 1923. 1861. WINGFIELD, Kate; “More Guidance From Beyond”; Philip Allan & Co.; London; 1925; pp. 12,

13.

1862. WINNER, Anna Kennedy; “Idéias Básicas da Sabedoria Oculta”; transl. J. Martins; 138 pp.; 19.5

cm; pb.; Editora Pensamento; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1977; pp. 90, 91.

1863. WOLMAN, Benjamin B.; DALE, Laura A.; SCHMEIDLER, Gertrude R.; and ULLMAN,

Montague; Editors; “Handbook of Parapsychology”; introd. Howard M. Zimmerman; XXIV + 968 pp.;

illus.; bibl. 907-920; glos. 921-936; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Van Nostrand Reinhold Co.; New York;

1977; pp. 67, 68, 418, 600, 607, 608, 616, 659, 717, 718, 749, 750, 772, 790-792, 796, 917, 918, 922,

925, 929, 936; eds.: Eng., It.

1864. WOODS, James Hanghton; “The Yoga-System of Patañjali”; XLII + 382 pp.; glos. 366-381; 24.5

cm; pb.; Motilal Banarsidass; Delhi; India; 1977; pp. 261, 266, 267; eds.: sanskrit, Eng.

1865. WORLD ALMANAC; Editor; “Weltalmanach des Übersinnlichen”; transl. Sepp Leeb; 560 pp.;

illus.; index of names; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Wilhelm Heyne Verlag; München; West Germany; 1982;

pp. 359-363.

1866. WORN, Fernando; “A Quem Deus Revela”; Desobsessão; Porto Alegre, RS; Brazil; Magazine;

Monthly; Yr. XXXIV; N. 411; May, 1982; p. 14.

1867. WUNDERLI, Erich; “Die Einzige Realität”; Esotera; Freiburg; West Germany; Magazine; Monthly; Yr. 24; N. 10; October, 1973; illus.; pp. 917-922.

1868. WYLD, George; “The Evidence of Anaesthetics”; Bordeland; London; Magazine; Monthly; Vol.

I; N. III; January, 1894; pp. 256-259.

1869. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Ação e Reação”; 274 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 6th ed.; Federação Espírita

Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978; pp. 6, 17, 107, 172, 177, 178, 192, 193, 214, 225.

1870. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Ave, Cristo”; Novel; 376 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 7th ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1982; pp. 90, 172.

1871. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “O Caminho Oculto”; 52 pp.; 22 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1983; pp. 15, 41.

1872. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Cartas e Crônicas”; 182 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; pp. 36, 38, 56, 58, 66-68, 123, 126.

1873. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “O Consolador”; 234 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 8th ed.; Federação Espírita

Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; pp. 43, 189.

Page 78: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1874. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Entre a Terra e o Céu”; 266 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 6th ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978; pp. 32, 33, 49, 50, 54, 76, 77, 84, 86-89, 91, 94-105,

148-159, 173-175, 220, 241-245.

1875. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Instruções Psicofônicas”; pres. Arnaldo Rocha; 296 pp.; 18 cm;

pb.; 3rd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1974; pp. 219-222.

1876. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Libertação”; 264 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 8th ed.; Federação Espírita

Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1980; pp. 80-82, 134, 168, 169, 185, 205-207, 237.

1877. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Luz Acima”; 214 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978; pp. 99-101, 208.

1878. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Os Mensageiros”; 266 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 11st ed.; Federação Espírita

Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978; pp. 90, 195-203, 266.

1879. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Missionários da Luz”; 348 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 12nd ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; pp. 64, 65, 80, 81, 86, 94, 115, 118, 123, 147, 190,

191, 230, 231, 272, 291.

1880. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “No Mundo Maior”; 254 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 7th ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1977; pp. 18, 24, 78, 89, 114-122, 145, 184,

192-195, 200, 240.

1881. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Nos Domínios da Mediunidade”; 286 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 8th ed.;

Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1976; pp. 31, 97-105, 111, 192, 252, 266-269,

273.

1882. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Nosso Lar”; 282 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 20th ed.; Federação Espírita

Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1978; pp. 182, 263-266.

1883. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Obreiros da Vida Eterna”; 304 pp.; 18 cm; pb.;

9th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1975; pp. 19, 138, 152, 194, 209-212,

236, 253, 254, 287-290. 1884. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Palavras do Coração”; pres. Ruth de Castro Mattos; 96 pp.; illus.;

21 cm; pb.; Cultura Espírita União; S. Paulo; Brazil; 1982; pp. 35, 37, 85-87.

1885. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Pontos e Contos”; 266 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 5th ed.; Federação Espírita

Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1979; pp. 37, 101, 153.

1886. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “E A Vida Continua”; 244 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 9th ed.; Federação

Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; pp. 238-240.

1887. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Voltei”; 176 pp.; 18 cm; hb.; dj.; Federação Espírita Brasileira;

Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1949; pp. 20-23.

1888. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido; “Vozes do Grande Além”; introd. Arnaldo Rocha; 282 pp.; 18 cm;

pb.; 2nd ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1974; pp. 31-33, 192.

1889. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido, and CUNHA, Heigorina; “Cidade do Além”; 80 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm;

pb.; 3rd ed.; Instituto de Difusão Espírita; Araras, SP; Brazil; 1983; pp. 25-27, 29.

1890. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido, and VIEIRA, Waldo; “Evolução em Dois Mundos”; 220 pp.; 18

cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1977; pp. 29, 129-134, 159, 209.

1891. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido, and VIEIRA, Waldo; “Mecanismos da Mediunidade”; 188 pp.; 18

cm; pb.; 4th ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1973; pp. 13, 15, 16, 108, 123,

145, 149-155, 163, 165. 1892. XAVIER, Francisco Cândido, and VIEIRA, Waldo; “Sexo e Destino”; 358 pp.; 18 cm; pb.; 8th

ed.; Federação Espírita Brasileira; Rio de Janeiro; Brazil; 1981; pp. 50, 117-119, 124-127, 168, 307-

309.

1893. YETERIAN, Dixie; “Casebook of a Psychic Detective”; 198 pp.; alph.; 23 cm; hb.; dj.; Stein and

Day Publishers; New York; 1982; pp. 17, 18, 45.

1894. YOGANANDA, Paramahansa (Pseud. for Mukunda Lal Ghosh); “Autobiografia de Um Iogue

Contemporâneo”; transl. Adelaide Petters Lessa Pantas; 458 pp.; illus.; 21 cm; pb.; Summus Editorial;

S. Paulo; Brazil; 1976; pp. 34-37, 144-146, 184, 205, 245, 263, 264, 285, 289, 305.

1895. YOUNG, Samuel H.; “Psychic Children”; 160 pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; Pocket Books; New York;

May, 1978; pp. 95-97.

1896. YRAM (Pseud. for Marcel Louis Fohan); “La Evolución en los Mundos Superiores”; 190 pp.; 20

cm; pb.; Editorial Kier; Buenos Aires; 1959; pp. 62-69.

Page 79: International Bibliography of Projectiology · INTERNATIONAL BIBLIOGRAPHY OF PROJECTIOLOGY 1. ABBOT, A. E.: ħEncyclopaedia of the Occult SciencesĨ; 452 pp.; 20 cm; hb.; Emerson

1897. YRAM (Pseud. for Marcel Louis Fohan); “Practical Astral Projection”; without translator; 254

pp.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 4th print.; Samuel Weiser; New York; 1979; pp. 1-254; eds.: Fr., Eng., Sp.

(Mini-library).

1898. ZAIN, C. C. (Pseud. for Elbert Benjamin); “The Next Life”; Serial N. 173-182; 332 pp.; illus.; 17

cm; pb.; reed.; The Church of Light; Los Angeles; Cal.; U. S. A.; April, 1964;

pp. 20, 195.

1899. ZANIAH (Pseud. for José Dali Moral); “Diccionario Esoterico”; 580 pp.; 23cm; pb.; Editorial

Kier; Buenos Aires; Argentina; 1979; p. 368. 1900. Z. H. Y.; “Magnetisme & Spiritisme: Concordance”; 52 pp.; illus.; 19 cm; pb.; Bibliothèque

Chacornac; Paris; no date; pp. 33-35, 44.

1901. ZINGAROPOLI, Francesco; “Morte Aparente e Sobrevivência da Alma”; introd. Domenico

Antonio Tieri; transl. Francisco Klörs Werneck; 60 pp.; illus.; 17.5 cm; pb.; Translator’s Edition; Rio

de Janeiro; Brazil; no date; pp. 32, 33, 47-56.

1902. ZOLAR (Pseud.); “Enciclopedia del Saber Antiguo y Prohibido”; transl. Francisco Torres Oliver;

464 pp.; illus.; 18 cm; pocket; pb.; 3rd ed.; Alianza Editorial; Madrid; Spain; 1982; pp. 133-140.

1903. ZOPPI, Vitório, and MAZZONI, Lutalto; “A Tremenda Renovação do Mundo”; 168 pp.; 18 cm;

pb.; Authors’ Edition; Indaiatuba, SP; Brazil; no date; pp. 78, 98.

1904. ZORAB, George; Compiled by; “Bibliography of Parapsychology”; 128 pp.; alph.; 19 cm; hb.; dj.;

Parapsychology Foundation; New York; 1957; pp. 22, 27, 28.

1905. ZORAB, George; “Ochêma” (J. J. Poortman); Books Reviews; Journal of the Society for

Psychical Research; London; Vol. 44; N. 737; September, 1968; pp. 352-355.

1906. ZORAB, George; “Zinneschok en Sweefervaring” (J. Teunissen); Books Reviews; Journal of the

Society for Psychical Research; London; Vol. 46; N. 750; December, 1971;

pp. 235, 236.

1907. ZYMONIDAS, Alessandro; “The Problems of Mediumship”; XXVI + 252 pp.; illus.; 18.5 cm; hb.; Kegan Paul, Trench, Trübner & Co.; London; 1920; pp. 181-188.